| Metamath Proof Explorer Most Recent Proofs |
||
| Mirrors > Home > MPE Home > Th. List > Recent | ILE Most Recent Other > MM 100 | |
The original proofs of theorems with recently shortened proofs can often be found by appending "OLD" to the theorem name, for example 19.43OLD for 19.43. The "OLD" versions are usually deleted after a year.
Other links Email: Norm Megill. Mailing list: Metamath Google Group Updated 7-Dec-2021 . Contributing: How can I contribute to Metamath? Syndication: RSS feed (courtesy of Dan Getz) Related wikis: Ghilbert site; Ghilbert Google Group.
Recent news items (7-Aug-2021) Version 0.198 of the metamath program fixes a bug in "write source ... /rewrap" that prevented end-of-sentence punctuation from appearing in column 79, causing some rewrapped lines to be shorter than necessary. Because this affects about 2000 lines in set.mm, you should use version 0.198 or later for rewrapping before submitting to GitHub.
(7-May-2021) Mario Carneiro has written a Metamath verifier in Lean.
(5-May-2021) Marnix Klooster has written a Metamath verifier in Zig.
(24-Mar-2021) Metamath was mentioned in a couple of articles about OpenAI: Researchers find that large language models struggle with math and What Is GPT-F?.
(26-Dec-2020) Version 0.194 of the metamath program adds the keyword "htmlexturl" to the $t comment to specify external versions of theorem pages. This keyward has been added to set.mm, and you must update your local copy of set.mm for "verify markup" to pass with the new program version.
(19-Dec-2020) Aleksandr A. Adamov has translated the Wikipedia Metamath page into Russian.
(19-Nov-2020) Eric Schmidt's checkmm.cpp was used as a test case for C'est, "a non-standard version of the C++20 standard library, with enhanced support for compile-time evaluation." See C++20 Compile-time Metamath Proof Verification using C'est.
(10-Nov-2020) Filip Cernatescu has updated the XPuzzle (Android app) to version 1.2. XPuzzle is a puzzle with math formulas derived from the Metamath system. At the bottom of the web page is a link to the Google Play Store, where the app can be found.
(7-Nov-2020) Richard Penner created a cross-reference guide between Frege's logic notation and the notation used by set.mm.
(4-Sep-2020) Version 0.192 of the metamath program adds the qualifier '/extract' to 'write source'. See 'help write source' and also this Google Group post.
(23-Aug-2020) Version 0.188 of the metamath program adds keywords Conclusion, Fact, Introduction, Paragraph, Scolia, Scolion, Subsection, and Table to bibliographic references. See 'help write bibliography' for the complete current list.
| Color key: |
| Date | Label | Description |
|---|---|---|
| Theorem | ||
| 9-May-2026 | goldratmolem2 47334 | Lemma 2 for determining the value of golden ratio. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 9-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹 = (2 · (cos‘(π / 5))) ⇒ ⊢ -1 = ((((𝐹↑5) / 2) − (5 · ((𝐹↑3) / 2))) + (5 · (𝐹 / 2))) | ||
| 9-May-2026 | goldracos5teq 47333 | Lemma 1 for determining the value of golden ratio. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 9-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹 = (2 · (cos‘(π / 5))) ⇒ ⊢ (cos‘π) = (((;16 · ((𝐹 / 2)↑5)) − (;20 · ((𝐹 / 2)↑3))) + (5 · (𝐹 / 2))) | ||
| 9-May-2026 | cos5teq 47328 | Five-times-angle formula for cosine, substitution helper. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 9-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℂ ∧ 𝐵 = (5 · 𝐴) ∧ 𝐶 = (cos‘𝐴)) → (cos‘𝐵) = (((;16 · (𝐶↑5)) − (;20 · (𝐶↑3))) + (5 · 𝐶))) | ||
| 9-May-2026 | quantgodel 47302 | There can be no formula asserting its own non-universality, in parallel to bj-babygodel 36868; proof path is shorter but relying on a property of specialization which provability predicates do not have. For a matching proof, see quantgodelALT 47303. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 9-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 ↔ ¬ ∀𝑥𝜑) ⇒ ⊢ ⊥ | ||
| 9-May-2026 | funopsn 7101 | If a function is an ordered pair then it is a singleton of an ordered pair. (Contributed by AV, 20-Sep-2020.) (Proof shortened by AV, 15-Jul-2021.) (Proof shortened by Eric Schmidt, 9-May-2026.) A function is a class of ordered pairs, so the fact that an ordered pair may sometimes be itself a function is an "accident" depending on the specific encoding of ordered pairs as classes (in set.mm, the Kuratowski encoding). A more meaningful statement is funsng 6549, as relsnopg 5759 is to relop 5805. (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ 𝑋 ∈ V & ⊢ 𝑌 ∈ V ⇒ ⊢ ((Fun 𝐹 ∧ 𝐹 = 〈𝑋, 𝑌〉) → ∃𝑎(𝑋 = {𝑎} ∧ 𝐹 = {〈𝑎, 𝑎〉})) | ||
| 9-May-2026 | iunopeqop 5475 | Implication of an ordered pair being equal to an indexed union of singletons of ordered pairs. (Contributed by AV, 20-Sep-2020.) Remove antecedent. (Revised by Eric Schmidt, 9-May-2026.) (Avoid depending on this detail.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 ∈ V & ⊢ 𝐶 ∈ V & ⊢ 𝐷 ∈ V ⇒ ⊢ (∪ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 {〈𝑥, 𝐵〉} = 〈𝐶, 𝐷〉 → ∃𝑧 𝐴 = {𝑧}) | ||
| 7-May-2026 | quantgodelALT 47303 | There can be no formula asserting its own non-universality; follows the steps of bj-babygodel 36868. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 7-May-2026.) (New usage is discouraged.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 ↔ ¬ ∀𝑥𝜑) ⇒ ⊢ ⊥ | ||
| 2-May-2026 | copsexgw 5443 | Version of copsexg 5445 with a disjoint variable condition, which does not require ax-13 2376. (Contributed by GG, 26-Jan-2024.) Shorten proof and remove dependency on ax-10 2147. (Revised by Eric Schmidt, 2-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 = 〈𝑥, 𝑦〉 → (𝜑 ↔ ∃𝑥∃𝑦(𝐴 = 〈𝑥, 𝑦〉 ∧ 𝜑))) | ||
| 1-May-2026 | vprc 5255 | The universal class is not a member of itself (and thus is not a set). Proposition 5.21 of [TakeutiZaring] p. 21; our proof, however, does not depend on the Axiom of Regularity. (Contributed by NM, 23-Aug-1993.) (Proof shortened by BJ, 1-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ ¬ V ∈ V | ||
| 1-May-2026 | nvel 5254 | The universal class does not belong to any class. (Contributed by FL, 31-Dec-2006.) Prove it without using vprc 5255, which is then proved as an instance of it. (Revised by BJ, 1-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ ¬ V ∈ 𝐴 | ||
| 27-Apr-2026 | qdiffALT 37642 | Alternate proof of qdiff 37641. This is a proof from irrdiff 37640 using excluded middle in a variety of places. (Contributed by Jim Kingdon, 27-Apr-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℝ → (𝐴 ∈ ℚ ↔ ∃𝑞 ∈ ℚ ∃𝑟 ∈ ℚ (𝑞 ≠ 𝑟 ∧ (abs‘(𝐴 − 𝑞)) = (abs‘(𝐴 − 𝑟))))) | ||
| 25-Apr-2026 | unidif0 5301 | The removal of the empty set from a class does not affect its union. (Contributed by NM, 22-Mar-2004.) (Proof shortened by Eric Schmidt, 25-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∪ (𝐴 ∖ {∅}) = ∪ 𝐴 | ||
| 25-Apr-2026 | vnex 5252 | The universal class does not exist as a set. (Contributed by NM, 4-Jul-2005.) (Proof shortened by BJ, 25-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ¬ ∃𝑥 𝑥 = V | ||
| 25-Apr-2026 | vneqv 5251 | The universal class is not equal to any setvar. (Contributed by NM, 4-Jul-2005.) Extract from vnex 5252 and shorten proof. (Revised by BJ, 25-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ¬ 𝑥 = V | ||
| 24-Apr-2026 | qdiff 37641 | The rationals are exactly those reals for which there exist two distinct rationals that are the same distance from the original number. Similar to irrdiff 37640 but here proved with a proof which would also work in constructive mathematics. From an online post by Ingo Blechschmidt. For a proof using irrdiff 37640, see qdiffALT 37642. (Contributed by Jim Kingdon, 24-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℝ → (𝐴 ∈ ℚ ↔ ∃𝑞 ∈ ℚ ∃𝑟 ∈ ℚ (𝑞 ≠ 𝑟 ∧ (abs‘(𝐴 − 𝑞)) = (abs‘(𝐴 − 𝑟))))) | ||
| 22-Apr-2026 | sucprcreg 9520 | A class is equal to its successor iff it is a proper class (assuming the Axiom of Regularity). (Contributed by NM, 9-Jul-2004.) (Proof shortened by BJ, 16-Apr-2019.) (Proof shortened by SN, 22-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (¬ 𝐴 ∈ V ↔ suc 𝐴 = 𝐴) | ||
| 22-Apr-2026 | nelaneq 9516 | A class is not an element of and equal to a class at the same time. Variant of elneq 9515 analogously to elnotel 9531 and en2lp 9527. (Proposed by BJ, 18-Jun-2022.) (Contributed by AV, 18-Jun-2022.) (Proof shortened by TM, 31-Dec-2025.) (Proof shortened by SN, 22-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ¬ (𝐴 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ 𝐴 = 𝐵) | ||
| 20-Apr-2026 | cos5t 47327 | Five-times-angle formula for cosine, in pure cosine form. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℂ → (cos‘(5 · 𝐴)) = (((;16 · ((cos‘𝐴)↑5)) − (;20 · ((cos‘𝐴)↑3))) + (5 · (cos‘𝐴)))) | ||
| 19-Apr-2026 | trun 5203 | The union of transitive classes is transitive. (Contributed by Eric Schmidt, 19-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((Tr 𝐴 ∧ Tr 𝐵) → Tr (𝐴 ∪ 𝐵)) | ||
| 17-Apr-2026 | sin5t 47326 | Five-times-angle formula for sine, in pure sine form. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 17-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℂ → (sin‘(5 · 𝐴)) = (((;16 · ((sin‘𝐴)↑5)) − (;20 · ((sin‘𝐴)↑3))) + (5 · (sin‘𝐴)))) | ||
| 17-Apr-2026 | sin5tlem5 47325 | Lemma 5 for quintupled angle sine calculation: sine of triple-angle and double-angle sum, as a polynomial in sine straight. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 17-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ ℂ ∧ 𝑀 ∈ ℂ ∧ (𝑁↑2) = (1 − (𝑀↑2))) → ((((3 · 𝑀) − (4 · (𝑀↑3))) · (1 − (2 · (𝑀↑2)))) + (((4 · (𝑁↑3)) − (3 · 𝑁)) · (2 · (𝑀 · 𝑁)))) = (((;16 · (𝑀↑5)) − (;20 · (𝑀↑3))) + (5 · 𝑀))) | ||
| 17-Apr-2026 | sin5tlem4 47324 | Lemma 4 for quintupled angle sine calculation: expanding lemma 3 result to difference of polynomials. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 17-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ ℂ ∧ 𝑀 ∈ ℂ ∧ (𝑁↑2) = (1 − (𝑀↑2))) → (((4 · (𝑁↑3)) − (3 · 𝑁)) · (2 · (𝑀 · 𝑁))) = ((((8 · (𝑀↑5)) − (;16 · (𝑀↑3))) + (8 · 𝑀)) − ((6 · 𝑀) − (6 · (𝑀↑3))))) | ||
| 16-Apr-2026 | goldrarp 47332 | The golden ratio is a positive real. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 16-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹 = (2 · (cos‘(π / 5))) ⇒ ⊢ 𝐹 ∈ ℝ+ | ||
| 16-Apr-2026 | goldrapos 47331 | Golden ratio is positive. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 16-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹 = (2 · (cos‘(π / 5))) ⇒ ⊢ 0 < 𝐹 | ||
| 16-Apr-2026 | sin5tlem3 47323 | Lemma 3 for quintupled angle sine calculation, multiplicating triple angle cosine by double angle sine. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 16-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ ℂ ∧ 𝑀 ∈ ℂ ∧ (𝑁↑2) = (1 − (𝑀↑2))) → (((4 · (𝑁↑3)) − (3 · 𝑁)) · (2 · (𝑀 · 𝑁))) = (((4 · ((1 − (2 · (𝑀↑2))) + (𝑀↑4))) − (3 · (1 − (𝑀↑2)))) · (2 · 𝑀))) | ||
| 16-Apr-2026 | sin5tlem2 47322 | Lemma 2 for quintupled angle sine calculation, multiplicating triple angle cosine by cosine straight and converting into sine. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 16-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ ℂ ∧ 𝑀 ∈ ℂ ∧ (𝑁↑2) = (1 − (𝑀↑2))) → (((4 · (𝑁↑3)) − (3 · 𝑁)) · 𝑁) = ((4 · ((1 − (2 · (𝑀↑2))) + (𝑀↑4))) − (3 · (1 − (𝑀↑2))))) | ||
| 13-Apr-2026 | wl-dfclel 37831 | The defining characterization of class membership. Unlike the forms on which it is based, it is unrestricted. Proven in Tarski's FOL, from the axiom of (set) extensionality (ax-ext 2708), the definitions df-clel 2811 and df-cleq . (Contributed by BJ, 27-Jun-2019.) Base on wl-dfclel.just 37829. (Revised by Wolf Lammen, 13-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝐵 ↔ ∃𝑥(𝑥 = 𝐴 ∧ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐵)) | ||
| 13-Apr-2026 | mh-infprim3bi 36730 | An axiom of infinity in primitive symbols not requiring ax-reg 9507. This version of the axiom was designed by Stefan O'Rear for his zf2.nql program, see https://github.com/sorear/metamath-turing-machines 9507. It directly implies ax-inf 9559, but deriving ax-inf2 9562 requires ax-ext 2708 and ax-rep 5212, see mh-inf3sn 36724. (Contributed by Matthew House, 13-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑦(𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 ∧ ∀𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 {𝑧} ∈ 𝑦) ↔ ¬ ∀𝑦 ¬ ¬ (𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ ∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ ∀𝑧 ¬ ¬ (𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ ∀𝑦 ¬ ((𝑦 ∈ 𝑧 → 𝑦 = 𝑥) → ¬ (𝑦 = 𝑥 → 𝑦 ∈ 𝑧)))))) | ||
| 13-Apr-2026 | mh-infprim2bi 36729 | Shortest possible axiom of infinity in primitive symbols not requiring ax-reg 9507. Deriving ax-inf 9559 or ax-inf2 9562 from this axiom requires ax-ext 2708 and ax-rep 5212, see mh-inf3sn 36724 and inf0 9542. (Contributed by Matthew House, 13-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥(∅ ∈ 𝑥 ∧ ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 {𝑦} ∈ 𝑥) ↔ ¬ ∀𝑥 ¬ ∀𝑦∀𝑧(∀𝑤(𝑤 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ (𝑤 ∈ 𝑥 → ¬ 𝑤 = 𝑧)) → 𝑦 ∈ 𝑥)) | ||
| 13-Apr-2026 | mh-infprim1bi 36728 | Shortest possible axiom of infinity in primitive symbols. Deriving ax-inf 9559 or ax-inf2 9562 from this axiom requires ax-ext 2708, ax-rep 5212, and ax-reg 9507, see inf3 9556 and inf0 9542. (Contributed by Matthew House, 13-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥(𝑥 ≠ ∅ ∧ 𝑥 ⊆ ∪ 𝑥) ↔ ¬ ∀𝑥 ¬ ∀𝑦 ¬ ∀𝑧((𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 → 𝑦 ∈ 𝑧) → ¬ 𝑧 ∈ 𝑥)) | ||
| 13-Apr-2026 | mh-regprimbi 36727 | Shortest possible version of ax-reg 9507 in primitive symbols. The equivalence is nontrivial, but it still follows solely from the axioms of predicate calculus. (Contributed by Matthew House, 13-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((∃𝑦 𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 → ∃𝑦(𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ 𝑧 ∈ 𝑥))) ↔ ¬ ∀𝑦 ¬ ∀𝑧((𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 → 𝑧 ∈ 𝑦) → ¬ 𝑧 ∈ 𝑥)) | ||
| 13-Apr-2026 | mh-unprimbi 36726 | Shortest possible version of ax-un 7689 in primitive symbols. (Contributed by Matthew House, 13-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑦∀𝑧(∃𝑤(𝑧 ∈ 𝑤 ∧ 𝑤 ∈ 𝑥) → 𝑧 ∈ 𝑦) ↔ ¬ ∀𝑦 ¬ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑥 → ∀𝑤(𝑤 ∈ 𝑧 → 𝑤 ∈ 𝑦))) | ||
| 13-Apr-2026 | mh-prprimbi 36725 | Shortest possible version of ax-pr 5375 in primitive symbols. (Contributed by Matthew House, 13-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑧∀𝑤((𝑤 = 𝑥 ∨ 𝑤 = 𝑦) → 𝑤 ∈ 𝑧) ↔ ¬ ∀𝑧(𝑥 ∈ 𝑧 → ¬ 𝑦 ∈ 𝑧)) | ||
| 13-Apr-2026 | mh-inf3sn 36724 | Version of inf3 9556 for the set of Zermelo ordinals ∅, {∅}, {{∅}}, {{{∅}}}, etc., where the successor of 𝑦 is {𝑦}. Unlike inf3 9556, the proof does not require ax-reg 9507, since the singleton properties snnz 4720 and sneqr 4783 are sufficient to guarantee that all elements of the sequence are distinct. (Contributed by Matthew House, 13-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑥(∅ ∈ 𝑥 ∧ ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 {𝑦} ∈ 𝑥) ⇒ ⊢ ω ∈ V | ||
| 13-Apr-2026 | mh-inf3f1 36723 | A variant of inf3 9556. If 𝐹 is a one-to-one function from 𝐴 into itself, and there exists an element 𝐵 not in its range, then (rec(𝐹, 𝐵) ↾ ω) is an infinite sequence of distinct elements from 𝐴. If 𝐴 is a set, we can use this theorem to prove ω ∈ V via f1dmex 7910. (Contributed by Matthew House, 13-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝐴–1-1→𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ (𝐴 ∖ ran 𝐹)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (rec(𝐹, 𝐵) ↾ ω):ω–1-1→𝐴) | ||
| 12-Apr-2026 | nalset 5249 | No set contains all sets. Theorem 41 of [Suppes] p. 30. (Contributed by NM, 23-Aug-1993.) Extract exnelv 5248. (Revised by Matthew House, 12-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ¬ ∃𝑥∀𝑦 𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 | ||
| 12-Apr-2026 | exnelv 5248 | For any set 𝑥, there is a set not contained in 𝑥. The proof is based on Russell's paradox. (Contributed by NM, 23-Aug-1993.) Remove use of ax-12 2185 and ax-13 2376. (Revised by BJ, 31-May-2019.) Extract from nalset 5249. (Revised by Matthew House, 12-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦 ¬ 𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 | ||
| 11-Apr-2026 | indsum 15791 | Finite sum of a product with the indicator function / Cartesian product with the indicator function. Note: this theorem cannot be efficiently shortened using sumss2 15688, unless there are some additional auxiliary theorems like (if(𝑥 ∈ 𝐴, 1, 0) · 𝐵) = if(𝑥 ∈ 𝐴, 𝐵, 0). (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 14-Aug-2017.) (Proof shortened by AV, 11-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑂 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ⊆ 𝑂) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 ∈ 𝑂) → 𝐵 ∈ ℂ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → Σ𝑥 ∈ 𝑂 ((((𝟭‘𝑂)‘𝐴)‘𝑥) · 𝐵) = Σ𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝐵) | ||
| 11-Apr-2026 | indval0 12163 | The indicator function generator does not generate a (meaningful) indicator function for a class which is not a subset of the domain. (Contributed by AV, 11-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (¬ 𝐴 ⊆ 𝑂 → ((𝟭‘𝑂)‘𝐴) = ∅) | ||
| 10-Apr-2026 | ppivalnn 48095 | Value of the prime-counting function pi for positive integers, according to Ján Mináč, see statement in [Ribenboim], p. 181. (Contributed by AV, 10-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ ℕ → (π‘𝑁) = Σ𝑘 ∈ (2...𝑁)(⌊‘((((!‘(𝑘 − 1)) + 1) / 𝑘) − (⌊‘((!‘(𝑘 − 1)) / 𝑘))))) | ||
| 10-Apr-2026 | ppivalnnprm 48088 | Value of a term of the prime-counting function pi for positive integers, according to Ján Mináč, for a prime number. (Contributed by AV, 10-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑃 ∈ ℙ → (⌊‘((((!‘(𝑃 − 1)) + 1) / 𝑃) − (⌊‘((!‘(𝑃 − 1)) / 𝑃)))) = 1) | ||
| 10-Apr-2026 | flmrecm1 47791 | The floor of an integer minus the reciprocal of a positive integer is the integer minus 1. (Contributed by AV, 10-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑀 ∈ ℤ ∧ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ) → (⌊‘(𝑀 − (1 / 𝑁))) = (𝑀 − 1)) | ||
| 10-Apr-2026 | nnge2recfl0 47790 | The floor of the reciprocal of an integer greater than 1 is 0. (Contributed by AV, 10-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘2) → (⌊‘(1 / 𝑁)) = 0) | ||
| 10-Apr-2026 | prmssuz2 16666 | The primes are integers greater than 1. (Contributed by AV, 10-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ℙ ⊆ (ℤ≥‘2) | ||
| 10-Apr-2026 | indsumhash 15792 | The finite sum of the indicator function is the number of elements of the corresponding subset. (Contributed by AV, 10-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 1 = ((𝟭‘𝑂)‘𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑂 ∈ Fin ∧ 𝐴 ⊆ 𝑂) → Σ𝑘 ∈ 𝑂 ( 1 ‘𝑘) = (♯‘𝐴)) | ||
| 10-Apr-2026 | fsumconst1 15753 | The sum of 1 over a finite set equals the size of the set. (Contributed by AV, 10-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ Fin → Σ𝑘 ∈ 𝐴 1 = (♯‘𝐴)) | ||
| 10-Apr-2026 | nnge2recico01 13460 | The reciprocal of an integer greater than 1 is in the right open interval between 0 and 1. (Contributed by AV, 10-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘2) → (1 / 𝑁) ∈ (0[,)1)) | ||
| 10-Apr-2026 | fvindre 12167 | The range of the indicator function is a subset of ℝ. (Contributed by AV, 10-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (((𝑂 ∈ Fin ∧ 𝐴 ⊆ 𝑂) ∧ 𝑋 ∈ 𝑂) → (((𝟭‘𝑂)‘𝐴)‘𝑋) ∈ ℝ) | ||
| 9-Apr-2026 | rediv11d 42895 | One-to-one relationship for division. (Contributed by SN, 9-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 /ℝ 𝐶) = (𝐵 /ℝ 𝐶) ↔ 𝐴 = 𝐵)) | ||
| 9-Apr-2026 | redivdird 42894 | Distribution of division over addition. (Contributed by SN, 9-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 + 𝐵) /ℝ 𝐶) = ((𝐴 /ℝ 𝐶) + (𝐵 /ℝ 𝐶))) | ||
| 9-Apr-2026 | rediv23d 42893 | A "commutative"/associative law for division. (Contributed by SN, 9-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 · 𝐵) /ℝ 𝐶) = ((𝐴 /ℝ 𝐶) · 𝐵)) | ||
| 9-Apr-2026 | redivrec2d 42892 | Relationship between division and reciprocal. (Contributed by SN, 9-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 /ℝ 𝐵) = ((1 /ℝ 𝐵) · 𝐴)) | ||
| 8-Apr-2026 | ppivalnnnprm 48091 | Value of a term of the prime-counting function pi for positive integers, according to Ján Miná&ccaron, for a non-prime number greater than 1. (Contributed by AV, 8-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘2) ∧ 𝑁 ∉ ℙ) → (⌊‘((((!‘(𝑁 − 1)) + 1) / 𝑁) − (⌊‘((!‘(𝑁 − 1)) / 𝑁)))) = 0) | ||
| 8-Apr-2026 | ppivalnn4 48090 | Value of the term of the prime-counting function pi for positive integers, according to Ján Mináč, for 4. (Contributed by AV, 8-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (⌊‘((((!‘(4 − 1)) + 1) / 4) − (⌊‘((!‘(4 − 1)) / 4)))) = 0 | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | nprmdvdsfacm1 48087 | A non-prime integer greater than 5 divides the factorial of the integer decreased by 1 (see remark in [Ribenboim] p. 181). Note: not valid for 𝑁 = 4, but for 𝑁 = 1! (Contributed by AV, 7-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘6) ∧ 𝑁 ∉ ℙ) → 𝑁 ∥ (!‘(𝑁 − 1))) | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | nprmdvdsfacm1lem4 48086 | Lemma 4 for nprmdvdsfacm1 48087. (Contributed by AV, 7-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘6) ∧ 𝐴 ∈ (2..^𝑁) ∧ 𝑁 = (𝐴↑2)) → 𝑁 ∥ (!‘(𝑁 − 1))) | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | nprmdvdsfacm1lem3 48085 | Lemma 3 for nprmdvdsfacm1 48087. (Contributed by AV, 7-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘6) ∧ 𝐴 ∈ (2..^𝑁) ∧ 𝑁 = (𝐴↑2)) → (2 · 𝐴) < (𝑁 − 1)) | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | nprmdvdsfacm1lem2 48084 | Lemma 2 for nprmdvdsfacm1 48087. (Contributed by AV, 7-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘6) ∧ 𝐴 ∈ (2..^𝑁) ∧ 𝑁 = (𝐴↑2)) → 3 ≤ 𝐴) | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | nprmdvdsfacm1lem1 48083 | Lemma 1 for nprmdvdsfacm1 48087. (Contributed by AV, 7-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘6) ∧ 𝐴 ∈ (2..^𝑁) ∧ 𝑁 = (𝐴↑2)) → 𝑁 ∥ (𝐴 · (2 · 𝐴))) | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | 2timesltsqm1 47827 | Two times an integer greater than 2 is less than the square of the integer minus 1. (Contributed by AV, 7-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ (ℤ≥‘3) → (2 · 𝐴) < ((𝐴↑2) − 1)) | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | wl-dfcleq 37830 |
The defining characterization of class equality. This version of
df-cleq 2728 has no restrictions, unlike the forms on
which it is based.
It is proved in Tarski's FOL from the axiom of extensionality
(ax-ext 2708), the definition of class equality (df-cleq 2728), and the
definition of class membership (df-clel 2811).
Its forward implication is known as "class extensionality". (Contributed by NM, 15-Sep-1993.) (Revised by BJ, 24-Jun-2019.) Base on wl-dfcleq.just 37826. (Revised by Wolf Lammen, 7-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 = 𝐵 ↔ ∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ↔ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐵)) | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | wl-dfclel.just 37829 | Add a hypothesis to wl-dfclel.basic 37828, that permits alpha-renaming. (Contributed by Wolf Lammen, 7-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥(𝑥 = 𝐴 ∧ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐵) ↔ ∃𝑦(𝑦 = 𝐴 ∧ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝐵 ↔ ∃𝑥(𝑥 = 𝐴 ∧ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐵)) | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | wl-dfcleq.just 37826 |
The hypotheses added to this version of df-cleq 2728 address the following:
1. Equality of classes is an equivalence relation, as expected of equality. 2. Equality of classes obeys the Law of Indiscernibles (Leibniz's Law), and is compatible with class membership. 3. Alpha-renaming is explicitly permitted. (Contributed by Wolf Lammen, 7-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ↔ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐵) ↔ ∀𝑦(𝑦 ∈ 𝐴 ↔ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵)) & ⊢ 𝐴 = 𝐴 & ⊢ (𝐴 = 𝐵 → (𝐵 = 𝐶 → 𝐶 = 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝐴 = 𝐵 → (𝐴 ∈ 𝐶 → 𝐵 ∈ 𝐶)) & ⊢ (𝐴 = 𝐵 → (𝐶 ∈ 𝐴 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝐵)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐴 = 𝐵 ↔ ∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ↔ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐵)) | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | elALTtco 36663 | Derivation of el 5390 from ax-tco 36654. Use el 5390 instead. (Contributed by Matthew House, 7-Apr-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦 𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | axnulregtco 36662 | Derivation of ax-nul 5241 from ax-reg 9507 and ax-tco 36654. Use ax-nul 5241 instead. (Contributed by Matthew House, 7-Apr-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑥∀𝑦 ¬ 𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | axtco1 36655 | Strong form of the Axiom of Transitive Containment. See ax-tco 36654 for more information. In particular, this theorem generalizes the statement of ax-tco 36654, allowing it to be written with only three variables, since 𝑥 need not be distinct from both 𝑧 and 𝑤. (Contributed by Matthew House, 7-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦(𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ∀𝑤(𝑤 ∈ 𝑧 → 𝑤 ∈ 𝑦))) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | nprmmul2 47988 | Special factorization of a non-prime integer greater than 3. (Contributed by AV, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘4) → (𝑁 ∉ ℙ ↔ ∃𝑎 ∈ (2..^𝑁)∃𝑏 ∈ (2..^𝑁)(𝑎 ≤ 𝑏 ∧ 𝑁 = (𝑎 · 𝑏)))) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | muldvdsfacm1 47835 | The product of two different positive integers less than a third integer divides the factorial of the third integer decreased by 1. By assumption, the third integer must be greater than 3. (Contributed by AV, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ (1..^𝐵) ∧ 𝐵 ∈ (1..^𝑁)) → (𝐴 · 𝐵) ∥ (!‘(𝑁 − 1))) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | muldvdsfacgt 47834 | The product of two different positive integers divides the factorial of the bigger integer. (Contributed by AV, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ (1..^𝐵) → (𝐴 · 𝐵) ∥ (!‘𝐵)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | facnn0dvdsfac 47833 | The factorial of a nonnegative integer divides the factorial of an integer which is greater than or equal to the first integer. (Contributed by AV, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑀 ∈ (0...𝑁) → (!‘𝑀) ∥ (!‘𝑁)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | 2timesltsq 47826 | Two times an integer greater than 2 is less than the square of the integer. (Contributed by AV, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ (ℤ≥‘3) → (2 · 𝐴) < (𝐴↑2)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttc0el 36717 | A transitive closure contains ∅ as an element iff it is nonempty, assuming Regularity and Transitive Containment. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ≠ ∅ ↔ ∅ ∈ TC+ 𝐴) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | dfttc3g 36716 | The transitive closure of a set 𝐴 is (TC‘𝐴), assuming Transitive Containment. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → TC+ 𝐴 = (TC‘𝐴)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcexbi 36715 | A class is a set iff its transitive closure is a set, assuming Transitive Containment. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ V ↔ TC+ 𝐴 ∈ V) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcexg 36714 | The transitive closure of a set is a set, assuming Transitive Containment. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → TC+ 𝐴 ∈ V) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | elttcirr 36713 | Irreflexivity of 𝐴 ∈ TC+ 𝐵 relationship. This is a consequence of Regularity, but it does not require Transitive Containment. We use the alternative expression dfttc4 36712 to construct a set in which 𝐴 is both ∈-minimal and not ∈-minimal. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ¬ 𝐴 ∈ TC+ 𝐴 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | dfttc4 36712 | An alternative expression for the transitive closure of a class, assuming Regularity. A set 𝑥 is contained in the transitive closure of 𝐴 iff we can construct an ∈-chain from 𝑥 to an element of 𝐴. This weak definition is primarily useful for proving elttcirr 36713. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ TC+ 𝐴 = {𝑥 ∣ ∃𝑦((𝐴 ∩ 𝑦) ≠ ∅ ∧ ∀𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 ((𝑧 ∩ 𝑦) = ∅ → 𝑧 = 𝑥))} | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | dfttc4lem2 36711 | Lemma for dfttc4 36712. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = {𝑥 ∣ ∃𝑦((𝐴 ∩ 𝑦) ≠ ∅ ∧ ∀𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 ((𝑧 ∩ 𝑦) = ∅ → 𝑧 = 𝑥))} ⇒ ⊢ (𝐴 ⊆ 𝐵 ∧ Tr 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | dfttc4lem1 36710 | Lemma for dfttc4 36712. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = {𝑥 ∣ ∃𝑦((𝐴 ∩ 𝑦) ≠ ∅ ∧ ∀𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 ((𝑧 ∩ 𝑦) = ∅ → 𝑧 = 𝑥))} & ⊢ 𝐶 ∈ V & ⊢ 𝐷 ∈ V ⇒ ⊢ (((𝐴 ∩ 𝐶) ≠ ∅ ∧ ∀𝑧 ∈ 𝐶 ((𝑧 ∩ 𝐶) = ∅ → 𝑧 = 𝐷)) → 𝐷 ∈ 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttc0elw 36709 | If a transitive closure is a set, then it contains ∅ as an element iff it is nonempty, assuming Regularity. If we also assume Transitive Containment, then we can remove the TC+ 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 hypothesis, see ttc0el 36717. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (TC+ 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → (𝐴 ≠ ∅ ↔ ∅ ∈ TC+ 𝐴)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcwf3 36708 | The sets whose transitive closures are sets are precisely the well-founded sets, assuming Regularity. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (TC+ 𝐴 ∈ V ↔ 𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcwf2 36707 | If a transitive closure class is a set, then it is well-founded, assuming Regularity. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (TC+ 𝐴 ∈ V ↔ TC+ 𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcwf 36706 | A set is well-founded iff its transitive closure is well-founded. As a corollary, the transitive closure of any well-founded set is a set. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On) ↔ TC+ 𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | dfttc3gw 36705 | If the transitive closure of 𝐴 is a set, then its value is (TC‘𝐴). If we assume Transitive Containment, then we can weaken the hypothesis to 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉, see dfttc3g 36716. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (TC+ 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → TC+ 𝐴 = (TC‘𝐴)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcsntrsucg 36704 | The singleton transitive closure of a transitive set is its successor. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ Tr 𝐴) → TC+ {𝐴} = suc 𝐴) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcsnexbig 36703 | The transitive closure of a set is a set iff its singleton transitive closure is a set. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → (TC+ 𝐴 ∈ V ↔ TC+ {𝐴} ∈ V)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcsnexg 36702 | If the transitive closure of a class is a set, then its singleton transitive closure is a set. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (TC+ 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → TC+ {𝐴} ∈ V) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcsng 36701 | Relationship between TC+ {𝐴} and TC+ 𝐴: the former contains the additional element 𝐴. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → TC+ {𝐴} = (TC+ 𝐴 ∪ {𝐴})) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcsnmin 36700 | The singleton transitive closure is the minimal transitive class containing 𝐴 as an element. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ Tr 𝐵) → TC+ {𝐴} ⊆ 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcsnidg 36699 | The singleton transitive closure contains its argument 𝐴 as an element. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → 𝐴 ∈ TC+ {𝐴}) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcsnssg 36698 | The transitive closure is contained in the singleton transitive closure. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → TC+ 𝐴 ⊆ TC+ {𝐴}) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcpwss 36697 | The transitive closure of a power class is contained in the power class of the transitive closure. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ TC+ 𝒫 𝐴 ⊆ 𝒫 TC+ 𝐴 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttciun 36696 | Distribute indexed union through a transitive closure. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ TC+ ∪ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝐵 = ∪ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 TC+ 𝐵 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcuni 36695 | Distribute union of a class through a transitive closure. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ TC+ ∪ 𝐴 = ∪ TC+ 𝐴 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcun 36694 | Distribute union of two classes through a transitive closure. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ TC+ (𝐴 ∪ 𝐵) = (TC+ 𝐴 ∪ TC+ 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttciunun 36693 | Relationship between TC+ 𝐴 and ∪ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴TC+ 𝑥: we can decompose TC+ 𝐴 into the elements of ∪ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴TC+ 𝑥 plus the elements of 𝐴 itself. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ TC+ 𝐴 = (∪ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 TC+ 𝑥 ∪ 𝐴) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcuniun 36692 | Relationship between TC+ 𝐴 and TC+ ∪ 𝐴: we can decompose TC+ 𝐴 into the elements of TC+ ∪ 𝐴 plus the elements of 𝐴 itself. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ TC+ 𝐴 = (TC+ ∪ 𝐴 ∪ 𝐴) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | csbttc 36691 | Distribute proper substitution through a transitive closure. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ⦋𝐴 / 𝑥⦌TC+ 𝐵 = TC+ ⦋𝐴 / 𝑥⦌𝐵 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttc00 36690 | A class has an empty transitive closure iff it is the empty set. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 = ∅ ↔ TC+ 𝐴 = ∅) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttc0 36689 | The transitive closure of the empty set is the empty set. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ TC+ ∅ = ∅ | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | dfttc2g 36688 | A shorter expression for the transitive closure of a set. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → TC+ 𝐴 = ∪ (rec((𝑥 ∈ V ↦ ∪ 𝑥), 𝐴) “ ω)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | elttctr 36687 | Transitivity of 𝐴 ∈ TC+ 𝐵 relationship. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ TC+ 𝐵 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ TC+ 𝐶) → 𝐴 ∈ TC+ 𝐶) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ssttctr 36686 | Transitivity of 𝐴 ⊆ TC+ 𝐵 relationship. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ⊆ TC+ 𝐵 ∧ 𝐵 ⊆ TC+ 𝐶) → 𝐴 ⊆ TC+ 𝐶) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcidm 36685 | The transitive closure operation is idempotent. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ TC+ TC+ 𝐴 = TC+ 𝐴 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttctrid 36684 | The transitive closure of a transitive class is the class itself. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (Tr 𝐴 → TC+ 𝐴 = 𝐴) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcel2 36683 | Elements turn into subclasses upon taking transitive closures. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝐵 → TC+ 𝐴 ⊆ TC+ 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcel 36682 | A transitive closure contains the transitive closures of all its elements. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ TC+ 𝐵 → TC+ 𝐴 ⊆ TC+ 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcss2 36681 | The subclass relationship is inherited by transitive closures. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ⊆ 𝐵 → TC+ 𝐴 ⊆ TC+ 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcss 36680 | A transitive closure contains the transitive closures of all its subclasses. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ⊆ TC+ 𝐵 → TC+ 𝐴 ⊆ TC+ 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcexrg 36679 | If the transitive closure of a class is a set, then the class is a set. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (TC+ 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → 𝐴 ∈ V) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcmin 36678 | The transitive closure of 𝐴 is a subclass of every transitive class containing 𝐴. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ⊆ 𝐵 ∧ Tr 𝐵) → TC+ 𝐴 ⊆ 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttctr3 36677 | The transitive closure of a class is transitive. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∪ TC+ 𝐴 ⊆ TC+ 𝐴 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttctr2 36676 | The transitive closure of a class is transitive. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ TC+ 𝐵 → 𝐴 ⊆ TC+ 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttctr 36675 | The transitive closure of a class is transitive. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ Tr TC+ 𝐴 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcid 36674 | The transitive closure contains its argument as a subclass. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐴 ⊆ TC+ 𝐴 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | nfttc 36673 | Bound-variable hypothesis builder for transitive closure. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥𝐴 ⇒ ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥TC+ 𝐴 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttceqd 36672 | Equality deduction for transitive closure. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 = 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → TC+ 𝐴 = TC+ 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttceqi 36671 | Equality inference for transitive closure. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐴 = 𝐵 ⇒ ⊢ TC+ 𝐴 = TC+ 𝐵 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttceq 36670 | Equality theorem for transitive closure. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 = 𝐵 → TC+ 𝐴 = TC+ 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | df-ttc 36669 | Transitive closure of a class. Unlike (TC‘𝐴) (see df-tc 9656), this definition works even if 𝐴 or its transitive closure is a proper class. Note that unless we assume Transitive Containment, the transitive closure of a set may be a proper class. If we only assume Regularity, then the class of sets whose transitive closure is a set is precisely the class of well-founded sets, see ttcwf3 36708. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ TC+ 𝐴 = ∪ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∪ (rec((𝑦 ∈ V ↦ ∪ 𝑦), {𝑥}) “ ω) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | cttc 36668 | Extend class notation with the transitive closure of a class. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| class TC+ 𝐴 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | tr0el 36667 | Every nonempty transitive class contains the empty set ∅ as an element, a consequence of Regularity and Transitive Containment. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ≠ ∅ ∧ Tr 𝐴) → ∅ ∈ 𝐴) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | tr0elw 36666 | Every nonempty transitive set contains the empty set ∅ as an element, a consequence of Regularity. If we assume Transitive Containment, then we can omit the 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 hypothesis, see tr0el 36667. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐴 ≠ ∅ ∧ Tr 𝐴) → ∅ ∈ 𝐴) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | tz9.1tco 36665 | Version of tz9.1 9650 derived from ax-tco 36654. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐴 ∈ V ⇒ ⊢ ∃𝑥(𝐴 ⊆ 𝑥 ∧ Tr 𝑥 ∧ ∀𝑦((𝐴 ⊆ 𝑦 ∧ Tr 𝑦) → 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑦)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | tz9.1ctco 36664 | Version of tz9.1c 9651 derived from ax-tco 36654. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐴 ∈ V ⇒ ⊢ ∩ {𝑥 ∣ (𝐴 ⊆ 𝑥 ∧ Tr 𝑥)} ∈ V | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | axuntco 36661 | Derivation of ax-un 7689 from ax-tco 36654. Use ax-un 7689 instead. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦∀𝑧(∃𝑤(𝑧 ∈ 𝑤 ∧ 𝑤 ∈ 𝑥) → 𝑧 ∈ 𝑦) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | axtcond 36660 | A version of the Axiom of Transitive Containment with no distinct variable conditions. Usage of this theorem is discouraged because it depends on ax-13 2376. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦∀𝑧((𝑧 = 𝑥 ∨ 𝑧 ∈ 𝑦) → ∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝑧 → 𝑥 ∈ 𝑦)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | axtco2g 36659 | Weak form of the Axiom of Transitive Containment using class variables and abbreviations. See ax-tco 36654 for more information. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → ∃𝑥(𝐴 ⊆ 𝑥 ∧ Tr 𝑥)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | axtco1g 36658 | Strong form of the Axiom of Transitive Containment using class variables and abbreviations. See ax-tco 36654 for more information. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → ∃𝑥(𝐴 ∈ 𝑥 ∧ Tr 𝑥)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | axtco1from2 36657 | Strong form axtco1 36655 of the Axiom of Transitive Containment, derived from the weak form axtco2 36656. See ax-tco 36654 for more information. As written, the proof uses ax-pr 5375 via el 5390, but we could alternatively use ax-pow 5307 via elALT2 5311. Use axtco1 36655 instead. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦(𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ∀𝑤(𝑤 ∈ 𝑧 → 𝑤 ∈ 𝑦))) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | axtco2 36656 | Weak form of the Axiom of Transitive Containment. See ax-tco 36654 for more information. In particular, this theorem shows the derivation of the weak form from the strong form. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦∀𝑧((𝑧 = 𝑥 ∨ 𝑧 ∈ 𝑦) → ∀𝑤(𝑤 ∈ 𝑧 → 𝑤 ∈ 𝑦)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ax-tco 36654 |
The Axiom of Transitive Containment of ZF set theory. It was derived as
axtco 36653 above and is therefore redundant if we
assume ax-ext 2708,
ax-rep 5212 and ax-inf2 9562, but we state it as a separate axiom here so
that its uses can be identified more easily. It states that a
transitive set 𝑦 exists that contains a given set
𝑥.
In
particular, the transitive closure of 𝑥 is a set, since it is a
subset of 𝑦, see df-tc 9656.
Traditionally, this statement is not counted as an axiom at all, but as a theorem from Replacement and Infinity. In fact, from the transitive closure of 𝑥 we can construct the set of iterated unions of 𝑥 (and vice versa), and Skolem took the existence of the latter set as a motivation for introducing the Axiom of Replacement. But Transitive Containment is strictly weaker than either of those axioms, so many authors identify it as its own axiom when investigating subsystems of ZF, such as Zermelo set theory or finitist set theory. We follow this separation in order to avoid nonessential usage of the stronger axioms. There are two main versions of this axiom that appear in the literature: the strong form ⊢ ∃𝑦(𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 ∧ Tr 𝑦), see axtco1 36655 and axtco1g 36658, and the weak form ⊢ ∃𝑦(𝑥 ⊆ 𝑦 ∧ Tr 𝑦), see axtco2 36656 and axtco2g 36659. The weak form follows directly from the strong form, see axtco2 36656. But the strong form only follows from the weak form if we allow el 5390 or one of its variants, see axtco1from2 36657. We take the strong form here as the axiom, since it is slightly shorter when expanded to primitive symbols. Yet the weak form turns out to be more suitable for axtcond 36660 for reasons of syntax. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦(𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ∀𝑤(𝑤 ∈ 𝑧 → 𝑤 ∈ 𝑦))) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | axtco 36653 | Axiom of Transitive Containment, derived as a theorem from ax-ext 2708, ax-rep 5212, and ax-inf2 9562. Use ax-tco 36654 instead. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦(𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ∀𝑤(𝑤 ∈ 𝑧 → 𝑤 ∈ 𝑦))) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | el 5390 | Any set is an element of some other set. See elALT 5394 for a shorter proof using more axioms, and see elALT2 5311 for a proof that uses ax-9 2124 and ax-pow 5307 instead of ax-pr 5375. (Contributed by NM, 4-Jan-2002.) (Proof shortened by Andrew Salmon, 25-Jul-2011.) Use ax-pr 5375 instead of ax-9 2124 and ax-pow 5307. (Revised by BTernaryTau, 2-Dec-2024.) (Proof shortened by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦 𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | axprlem1 5365 | Lemma for axpr 5369. There exists a set to which all empty sets belong. (Contributed by Rohan Ridenour, 10-Aug-2023.) (Revised by BJ, 13-Aug-2023.) (Proof shortened by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑥∀𝑦(∀𝑧 ¬ 𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → 𝑦 ∈ 𝑥) | ||
| 5-Apr-2026 | nprmmul1 47987 | Special factorization of a non-prime integer greater than 3. (Contributed by AV, 5-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘4) → (𝑁 ∉ ℙ ↔ ∃𝑎 ∈ (2..^𝑁)∃𝑏 ∈ (2..^𝑁)𝑁 = (𝑎 · 𝑏))) | ||
| 5-Apr-2026 | nndivides2 47832 | Definition of the divides relation for divisors greater than 1. (Contributed by AV, 5-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑀 ∈ (2..^𝑁) ∧ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ) → (𝑀 ∥ 𝑁 ↔ ∃𝑛 ∈ (2..^𝑁)(𝑛 · 𝑀) = 𝑁)) | ||
| 5-Apr-2026 | nnmul2b 47779 | A factor of a product of integers is at least 2 and less then the product iff the second factor is at least 2 and less then the product. (Contributed by AV, 5-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℕ ∧ 𝐵 ∈ ℕ ∧ (𝐴 · 𝐵) = 𝑁) → (𝐴 ∈ (2..^𝑁) ↔ 𝐵 ∈ (2..^𝑁))) | ||
| 5-Apr-2026 | nnmul2 47778 | If one factor of a product of integers is at least 2 and less then the product, so is the second factor. (Contributed by AV, 5-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ (2..^𝑁) ∧ 𝐵 ∈ ℕ ∧ (𝐴 · 𝐵) = 𝑁) → 𝐵 ∈ (2..^𝑁)) | ||
| 5-Apr-2026 | elfzo2nn 47777 | A member of a half-open range of integers starting at 2 is a positive integer. (Contributed by AV, 5-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐾 ∈ (2..^𝑁) → 𝐾 ∈ ℕ) | ||
| 5-Apr-2026 | elfz2nn 47770 | A member of a finite set of sequential integers starting at 2 is a positive integer. (Contributed by AV, 5-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐾 ∈ (2...𝑁) → 𝐾 ∈ ℕ) | ||
| 5-Apr-2026 | bj-alrimdh 36889 | Deduction form of Theorem 19.21 of [Margaris] p. 90, see 19.21 2215 and 19.21h 2294. (Contributed by NM, 10-Feb-1997.) (Proof shortened by Andrew Salmon, 13-May-2011.) State the most general derivable instance. (Revised by BJ, 5-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜓) & ⊢ (𝜒 → ∀𝑥𝜃) & ⊢ (𝜓 → (𝜃 → 𝜏)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜒 → ∀𝑥𝜏)) | ||
| 5-Apr-2026 | bj-alimdh 36888 | General instance of alimdh 1819. (Contributed by NM, 4-Jan-2002.) State the most general derivable instance. (Revised by BJ, 5-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜓) & ⊢ (𝜓 → (𝜒 → 𝜃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜒 → ∀𝑥𝜃)) | ||
| 5-Apr-2026 | zfrep6 5224 | A version of the Axiom of Replacement. Normally 𝜑 would have free variables 𝑥 and 𝑦. Axiom 6 of [Kunen] p. 12. The Separation Scheme ax-sep 5231 cannot be derived from this version and must be stated as a separate axiom in an axiom system (such as Kunen's) that uses this version in place of our ax-rep 5212. (Contributed by NM, 10-Oct-2003.) Shorten proof and reduce axiom dependencies. (Revised by BJ, 5-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑥 ∈ 𝑧 ∃!𝑦𝜑 → ∃𝑤∀𝑥 ∈ 𝑧 ∃𝑦 ∈ 𝑤 𝜑) | ||
| 5-Apr-2026 | replem 5223 | A lemma for variants of the axiom of replacement: if we can form the set of images of the functional relation, then we can also form a set containing all its images. The converse requires the axiom of separation. (Contributed by BJ, 5-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((∀𝑥 ∈ 𝑧 ∃𝑦𝜑 ∧ ∃𝑤∀𝑦(𝑦 ∈ 𝑤 ↔ ∃𝑥 ∈ 𝑧 𝜑)) → ∃𝑤∀𝑥 ∈ 𝑧 ∃𝑦 ∈ 𝑤 𝜑) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | ppi1sum 48094 | Value of the prime-counting function pi for 1, according to Ján Mináč. (Contributed by AV, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (π‘1) = Σ𝑘 ∈ ∅ (⌊‘((((!‘(𝑘 − 1)) + 1) / 𝑘) − (⌊‘((!‘(𝑘 − 1)) / 𝑘)))) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | indprmfz 48093 | An indicator function for prime numbers in a finite interval of integers, according to Ján Mináč. (Contributed by AV, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (2...𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝟭‘𝐼)‘(𝐼 ∩ ℙ)) = (𝑘 ∈ 𝐼 ↦ (⌊‘((((!‘(𝑘 − 1)) + 1) / 𝑘) − (⌊‘((!‘(𝑘 − 1)) / 𝑘))))) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | indprm 48092 | An indicator function for prime numbers, according to Ján Mináč. (Contributed by AV, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝟭‘(ℤ≥‘2))‘ℙ) = (𝑘 ∈ (ℤ≥‘2) ↦ (⌊‘((((!‘(𝑘 − 1)) + 1) / 𝑘) − (⌊‘((!‘(𝑘 − 1)) / 𝑘))))) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | ppivalnnnprmge6 48089 | Value of a term of the prime-counting function pi for positive integers, according to Ján Mináč, for a non-prime number greater than 4. (Contributed by AV, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘6) ∧ 𝑁 ∉ ℙ) → (⌊‘((((!‘(𝑁 − 1)) + 1) / 𝑁) − (⌊‘((!‘(𝑁 − 1)) / 𝑁)))) = 0) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | nprmmul3 47989 | Special factorization of a non-prime integer greater than 3. (Contributed by AV, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘4) → (𝑁 ∉ ℙ ↔ (∃𝑎 ∈ (2..^𝑁)∃𝑏 ∈ (2..^𝑁)(𝑎 < 𝑏 ∧ 𝑁 = (𝑎 · 𝑏)) ∨ ∃𝑎 ∈ (2..^𝑁)𝑁 = (𝑎↑2)))) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | rerecne0d 42888 | The reciprocal of a nonzero number is nonzero. (Contributed by SN, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (1 /ℝ 𝐴) ≠ 0) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-nnf-cbval 37077 | Compared with cbvalv1 2345, this saves ax-12 2185. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → Ⅎ'𝑦𝜓) & ⊢ (𝜑 → Ⅎ'𝑥𝜒) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 = 𝑦) → (𝜓 ↔ 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜓 ↔ ∀𝑦𝜒)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-nnf-cbvali 37076 | Compared with bj-nnf-cbvaliv 37073, replacing the DV condition on 𝑦, 𝜓 with the nonfreeness condition requires ax-11 2163. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → Ⅎ'𝑦𝜓) & ⊢ (𝜑 → Ⅎ'𝑥𝜒) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 = 𝑦) → (𝜓 → 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜓 → ∀𝑦𝜒)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-nnf-cbvaliv 37073 | The only DV conditions are those saying that 𝑦 is a fresh variable used to construct 𝜒. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → Ⅎ'𝑥𝜒) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 = 𝑦) → (𝜓 → 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜓 → ∀𝑦𝜒)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-nnf-spime 37072 | An existential generalization result in deduction form, from ax-1 6-- ax-6 1969, where the only DV condition is on 𝑥, 𝑦, and where 𝑥 should be nonfree in the new proposition 𝜒 (and in the context 𝜑). (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → Ⅎ'𝑥𝜓) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 = 𝑦) → (𝜓 → 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜓 → ∃𝑥𝜒)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-nnf-spim 37071 | A universal specialization result in deduction form, proved from ax-1 6 -- ax-6 1969, where the only DV condition is on 𝑥, 𝑦 and where 𝑥 should be nonfree in the new proposition 𝜒 (and in the context 𝜑). (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → Ⅎ'𝑥𝜒) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 = 𝑦) → (𝜓 → 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜓 → 𝜒)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-hbex 37009 | A more general instance of hbex 2330. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜓) ⇒ ⊢ (∃𝑦𝜑 → ∀𝑥∃𝑦𝜓) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-hbexd 37007 | A more general instance of the deduction form of hbex 2330. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦𝜓) & ⊢ (𝜓 → (𝜒 → ∀𝑥𝜃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∃𝑦𝜒 → ∀𝑥∃𝑦𝜃)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-hbal 36978 | More general instance of hbal 2173. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜓) ⇒ ⊢ (∀𝑦𝜑 → ∀𝑥∀𝑦𝜓) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-hbald 36976 | General statement that hbald 2174 proves . (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦𝜓) & ⊢ (𝜓 → (𝜒 → ∀𝑥𝜃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑦𝜒 → ∀𝑥∀𝑦𝜃)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-spim0 36963 | A universal specialization result in deduction form, proved from ax-1 6 -- ax-6 1969, where the only DV condition is on 𝑥, 𝑦 and where 𝑥 should be nonfree in the new proposition 𝜒 (and in the context 𝜑). (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (∃𝑥𝜒 → 𝜒)) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 = 𝑦) → (𝜓 → 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜓 → 𝜒)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-cbveximdv 36928 | A lemma for alpha-renaming of variables bound by an existential quantifier. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜒 → ∀𝑦𝜒)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥∃𝑦𝜓) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝜓) → (𝜒 → 𝜃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∃𝑥𝜒 → ∃𝑦𝜃)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-cbvalimdv 36927 | A lemma for alpha-renaming of variables bound by a universal quantifier. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (∃𝑥𝜃 → 𝜃)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦∃𝑥𝜓) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝜓) → (𝜒 → 𝜃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜒 → ∀𝑦𝜃)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-cbveximd 36926 | A lemma for alpha-renaming of variables bound by an existential quantifier. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜒 → ∀𝑦𝜒)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (∃𝑥𝜃 → 𝜃)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥∃𝑦𝜓) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝜓) → (𝜒 → 𝜃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∃𝑥𝜒 → ∃𝑦𝜃)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-cbvalimd 36925 | A lemma for alpha-renaming of variables bound by a universal quantifier. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜒 → ∀𝑦𝜒)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (∃𝑥𝜃 → 𝜃)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦∃𝑥𝜓) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝜓) → (𝜒 → 𝜃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜒 → ∀𝑦𝜃)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-cbvalimd0 36922 | A lemma for alpha-renaming of variables bound by a universal quantifier. In applications, 𝑥 = 𝑦 will be substituted for 𝜓 and ax6ev 1971 will prove Hypothesis bj-cbvalimd0.denote. When ax6ev 1971 is not available but only its universal closure is, then bj-cbvalimd 36925 or bj-cbvalimdv 36927 should be used (see bj-cbvalimdlem 36923, bj-cbval 36940). (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜒 → ∀𝑦𝜒)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (∃𝑥𝜃 → 𝜃)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∃𝑥𝜓) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝜓) → (𝜒 → 𝜃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜒 → ∀𝑦𝜃)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-spime 36921 | A lemma for existential generalization. In applications, 𝑥 = 𝑦 will be substituted for 𝜓 and ax6ev 1971 will prove Hypothesis bj-spime.denote. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜒 → ∀𝑥𝜒)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∃𝑥𝜓) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝜓) → (𝜒 → 𝜃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜒 → ∃𝑥𝜃)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-spim 36920 | A lemma for universal specification. In applications, 𝑥 = 𝑦 will be substituted for 𝜓 and ax6ev 1971 will prove Hypothesis bj-spim.denote. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (∃𝑥𝜃 → 𝜃)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∃𝑥𝜓) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝜓) → (𝜒 → 𝜃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜒 → 𝜃)) | ||
| 3-Apr-2026 | bj-spimenfa 36919 | An existential generalization result: if 𝜑 holds and implies 𝜓 for at least one value of 𝑥, and if furthermore 𝑥 is ∀ -weakly nonfree in 𝜑, then 𝜓 holds for at least one value of 𝑥. (Contributed by BJ, 3-Apr-2026.) Proof should not use 19.35 1879. (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ((𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) → (∃𝑥(𝜑 → 𝜓) → (𝜑 → ∃𝑥𝜓))) | ||
| 3-Apr-2026 | bj-spimnfe 36918 | A universal specification result: if 𝜑 is true for all values of 𝑥 and implies 𝜓 for at least one value, and if furthermore 𝑥 is ∃-weakly nonfree in 𝜓, then 𝜓 follows. An intermediate result on the way to prove 19.36i 2239, bj-19.36im 37060, 19.36imv 1947, spimfw 1967... (Contributed by BJ, 3-Apr-2026.) Proof should not use 19.35 1879. (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ((∃𝑥𝜓 → 𝜓) → (∃𝑥(𝜑 → 𝜓) → (∀𝑥𝜑 → 𝜓))) | ||
| 3-Apr-2026 | bj-imim11i 36814 | The propositional function ((. → 𝜑) → 𝜓) is increasing. Its associated inference is wl-syls2 37834. (Contributed by BJ, 3-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝜓) ⇒ ⊢ (((𝜑 → 𝜒) → 𝜃) → ((𝜓 → 𝜒) → 𝜃)) | ||
| 3-Apr-2026 | bj-imim11 36813 | The propositional function ((. → 𝜑) → 𝜓) is increasing. (Contributed by BJ, 3-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝜑 → 𝜓) → (((𝜑 → 𝜒) → 𝜃) → ((𝜓 → 𝜒) → 𝜃))) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | hoicvr 46976 | 𝐼 is a countable set of half-open intervals that covers the whole multidimensional reals. See Definition 1135 (b) of [Fremlin1] p. 29. (Contributed by Glauco Siliprandi, 11-Oct-2020.) Avoid ax-rep 5212 and shorten proof. (Revised by GG, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (𝑗 ∈ ℕ ↦ (𝑥 ∈ 𝑋 ↦ 〈-𝑗, 𝑗〉)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ Fin) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (ℝ ↑m 𝑋) ⊆ ∪ 𝑗 ∈ ℕ X𝑖 ∈ 𝑋 (([,) ∘ (𝐼‘𝑗))‘𝑖)) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | rerecrecd 42891 | A number is equal to the reciprocal of its reciprocal. (Contributed by SN, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (1 /ℝ (1 /ℝ 𝐴)) = 𝐴) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | sn-redividd 42886 | A number divided by itself is 1. (Contributed by SN, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 /ℝ 𝐴) = 1) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | sn-rediv0d 42885 | Division into zero is zero. (Contributed by SN, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (0 /ℝ 𝐴) = 0) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | sn-rediv1d 42884 | A number divided by 1 is itself. (Contributed by SN, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 /ℝ 1) = 𝐴) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | rediveq1d 42883 | Equality in terms of unit ratio. (Contributed by SN, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 /ℝ 𝐵) = 1 ↔ 𝐴 = 𝐵)) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | redivne0bd 42882 | The ratio of nonzero numbers is nonzero. (Contributed by SN, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 ≠ 0 ↔ (𝐴 /ℝ 𝐵) ≠ 0)) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | redivmul2d 42878 | Relationship between division and multiplication. (Contributed by SN, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 /ℝ 𝐶) = 𝐵 ↔ 𝐴 = (𝐶 · 𝐵))) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | padct 32791 | Index a countable set with integers and pad with 𝑍. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 1-Jun-2020.) Avoid ax-rep 5212. (Revised by GG, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ≼ ω ∧ 𝑍 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ ¬ 𝑍 ∈ 𝐴) → ∃𝑓(𝑓:ℕ⟶(𝐴 ∪ {𝑍}) ∧ 𝐴 ⊆ ran 𝑓 ∧ Fun (◡𝑓 ↾ 𝐴))) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | istrkg2ld 28528 | Property of fulfilling the lower dimension 2 axiom. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 20-Nov-2019.) Avoid ax-rep 5212. (Revised by GG, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑃 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ − = (dist‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Itv‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐺 ∈ 𝑉 → (𝐺DimTarskiG≥2 ↔ ∃𝑥 ∈ 𝑃 ∃𝑦 ∈ 𝑃 ∃𝑧 ∈ 𝑃 ¬ (𝑧 ∈ (𝑥𝐼𝑦) ∨ 𝑥 ∈ (𝑧𝐼𝑦) ∨ 𝑦 ∈ (𝑥𝐼𝑧)))) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | smndex1igid 18874 | The composition of the modulo function 𝐼 and a constant function (𝐺‘𝐾) results in (𝐺‘𝐾) itself. (Contributed by AV, 14-Feb-2024.) Avoid ax-rep 5212. (Revised by GG, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑀 = (EndoFMnd‘ℕ0) & ⊢ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ & ⊢ 𝐼 = (𝑥 ∈ ℕ0 ↦ (𝑥 mod 𝑁)) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑛 ∈ (0..^𝑁) ↦ (𝑥 ∈ ℕ0 ↦ 𝑛)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐾 ∈ (0..^𝑁) → (𝐼 ∘ (𝐺‘𝐾)) = (𝐺‘𝐾)) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | smndex1gid 18872 | The composition of a constant function (𝐺‘𝐾) with another endofunction on ℕ0 results in (𝐺‘𝐾) itself. (Contributed by AV, 14-Feb-2024.) Avoid ax-rep 5212. (Revised by GG, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑀 = (EndoFMnd‘ℕ0) & ⊢ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ & ⊢ 𝐼 = (𝑥 ∈ ℕ0 ↦ (𝑥 mod 𝑁)) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑛 ∈ (0..^𝑁) ↦ (𝑥 ∈ ℕ0 ↦ 𝑛)) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐹 ∈ (Base‘𝑀) ∧ 𝐾 ∈ (0..^𝑁)) → ((𝐺‘𝐾) ∘ 𝐹) = (𝐺‘𝐾)) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | smndex1gbas 18870 | The constant functions (𝐺‘𝐾) are endofunctions on ℕ0. (Contributed by AV, 12-Feb-2024.) Avoid ax-rep 5212 and shorten proof. (Revised by GG, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑀 = (EndoFMnd‘ℕ0) & ⊢ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ & ⊢ 𝐼 = (𝑥 ∈ ℕ0 ↦ (𝑥 mod 𝑁)) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑛 ∈ (0..^𝑁) ↦ (𝑥 ∈ ℕ0 ↦ 𝑛)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐾 ∈ (0..^𝑁) → (𝐺‘𝐾) ∈ (Base‘𝑀)) | ||
| 1-Apr-2026 | nowisdomv 30544 | One's wisdom on matters of the universe can be refuted on April Fool's day. (Contributed by Prof. Loof Lirpa, 1-Apr-2026.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ¬ 𝑊〈“ I 5”〉dom V | ||
| 28-Mar-2026 | copsex2gd 37452 | Implicit substitution inference for ordered pairs. (Contributed by NM, 28-May-1995.) Use a similar proof to copsex4g 5449 to reduce axiom usage. (Revised by SN, 1-Sep-2024.) Adapt copsex2g 5447 $p to deduction form. (Revised by BJ, 28-Mar-2026.) Do not use copsex2g 5447. (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ (𝑥 = 𝐴 ∧ 𝑦 = 𝐵)) → (𝜓 ↔ 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑊)) → (∃𝑥∃𝑦(〈𝐴, 𝐵〉 = 〈𝑥, 𝑦〉 ∧ 𝜓) ↔ 𝜒)) | ||
| 28-Mar-2026 | cgsex2gd 37451 | Implicit substitution inference for general classes. (Contributed by NM, 26-Jul-1995.) Adapt cgsex2g 3475 to deduction form. (Revised by BJ, 28-Mar-2026.) Do not use cgsex2g 3475. (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ (𝑥 = 𝐴 ∧ 𝑦 = 𝐵)) → 𝜓) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝜓) → (𝜒 ↔ 𝜃)) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑊)) → (∃𝑥∃𝑦(𝜓 ∧ 𝜒) ↔ 𝜃)) | ||
| 28-Mar-2026 | bj-alnnf2 37035 | If a proposition holds, then it holds for all values of a given variable if and only if it does not depend on that variable. (Contributed by BJ, 28-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜑 ↔ Ⅎ'𝑥𝜑)) | ||
| 28-Mar-2026 | bj-alnnf 37034 | In deduction-style proofs, it is equivalent to assert that the context holds for all values of a variable, or that is does not depend on that variable. (Contributed by BJ, 28-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) ↔ (𝜑 → Ⅎ'𝑥𝜑)) | ||
| 28-Mar-2026 | bj-alsyl 36886 | Syllogism under the universal quantifier, in the curried form appearing as Theorem *10.3 of [WhiteheadRussell] p. 145. See alsyl 1895 for the uncurried form. (Contributed by BJ, 28-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑥(𝜑 → 𝜓) → (∀𝑥(𝜓 → 𝜒) → ∀𝑥(𝜑 → 𝜒))) | ||
| 27-Mar-2026 | axnulALT2 35224 | Alternate proof of axnul 5240, proved from propositional calculus, ax-gen 1797, ax-4 1811, ax-6 1969, and ax-rep 5212. (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 27-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑥∀𝑦 ¬ 𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 | ||
| 26-Mar-2026 | axprALT2 35253 | Alternate proof of axpr 5369, proved from predicate calculus, ax-rep 5212, and ax-inf2 9562. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 26-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑧∀𝑤((𝑤 = 𝑥 ∨ 𝑤 = 𝑦) → 𝑤 ∈ 𝑧) | ||
| 21-Mar-2026 | bj-nnfbd0 37045 | If two formulas are equivalent, then nonfreeness of a variable in one of them is equivalent to nonfreeness in the other, deduction form. The antecedent of the conclusion is in the "strong necessity" modality of modal logic (see also bj-nnftht 37040) in order not to require sp 2191 (modal T). See bj-nnfbi 37044. (Contributed by BJ, 21-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜓 ↔ 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ ∀𝑥𝜑) → (Ⅎ'𝑥𝜓 ↔ Ⅎ'𝑥𝜒)) | ||
| 20-Mar-2026 | bj-bisimpr 36818 | Implication from equivalence with a conjunct. Its associated inference is simprbi 497. (Contributed by BJ, 20-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝜑 ↔ (𝜓 ∧ 𝜒)) → (𝜑 → 𝜒)) | ||
| 20-Mar-2026 | bj-bisimpl 36817 | Implication from equivalence with a conjunct. Its associated inference is simplbi 496. (Contributed by BJ, 20-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝜑 ↔ (𝜓 ∧ 𝜒)) → (𝜑 → 𝜓)) | ||
| 19-Mar-2026 | bj-almpig 36885 | A partially quantified form of mpi 20 similar to bj-almpi 36884. (Contributed by BJ, 19-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜒 → 𝜓)) & ⊢ ∀𝑥𝜒 ⇒ ⊢ ∀𝑥(𝜑 → 𝜓) | ||
| 19-Mar-2026 | bj-almpi 36884 | A quantified form of mpi 20. See also barbara 2663, bj-ala1i 36883, bj-almp 36876. (Contributed by BJ, 19-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∀𝑥(𝜑 → (𝜒 → 𝜓)) & ⊢ ∀𝑥𝜒 ⇒ ⊢ ∀𝑥(𝜑 → 𝜓) | ||
| 19-Mar-2026 | bj-alimii 36882 | Inference associated with alimi 1813. Double inference associated with alim 1812. The usual proof of an associated inference (here from alimi 1813 and ax-mp 5) has the same size and same number of steps. (Contributed by BJ, 19-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜓 → 𝜑) & ⊢ ∀𝑥𝜓 ⇒ ⊢ ∀𝑥𝜑 | ||
| 19-Mar-2026 | bj-almp 36876 | A quantified form of ax-mp 5. See also barbara 2663, bj-ala1i 36883, bj-almpi 36884. (Contributed by BJ, 19-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∀𝑥(𝜓 → 𝜑) & ⊢ ∀𝑥𝜓 ⇒ ⊢ ∀𝑥𝜑 | ||
| 17-Mar-2026 | bj-evalf 37386 | The evaluation at a class is a function from the universal class into the universal class. (Contributed by BJ, 17-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ Slot 𝐴:V⟶V | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | sin5tlem1 47321 | Lemma 1 for quintupled angle sine calculation, expanding triple-angle sine times double-angle cosine. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ ℂ → (((3 · 𝑁) − (4 · (𝑁↑3))) · (1 − (2 · (𝑁↑2)))) = (((8 · (𝑁↑5)) − (;10 · (𝑁↑3))) + (3 · 𝑁))) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | cos3t 47320 | Triple-angle formula for cosine, in pure cosine form. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℂ → (cos‘(3 · 𝐴)) = ((4 · ((cos‘𝐴)↑3)) − (3 · (cos‘𝐴)))) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | sin3t 47319 | Triple-angle formula for sine, in pure sine form. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℂ → (sin‘(3 · 𝐴)) = ((3 · (sin‘𝐴)) − (4 · ((sin‘𝐴)↑3)))) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | esplyfvaln 33718 | The last elementary symmetric polynomial is the product of all variables. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑊 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (𝐼 mVar 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (𝐼eSymPoly𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (♯‘𝐼) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (mulGrp‘𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐸‘𝑁) = (𝑀 Σg 𝑉)) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | esplyfval1 33717 | The first elementary symmetric polynomial is the sum of all variables. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑊 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (𝐼 mVar 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (𝐼eSymPoly𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐸‘1) = (𝑊 Σg 𝑉)) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | mplmonprod 33698 | Finite product of monomials. Here the function 𝐺 maps a bag of variables to the corresponding monomial. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑃 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝐴⟶𝐷) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (mulGrp‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑦 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ (𝑧 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if(𝑧 = 𝑦, 1 , 0 ))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑀 Σg (𝐺 ∘ 𝐹)) = (𝐺‘(𝑖 ∈ 𝐼 ↦ (ℂfld Σg (𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ↦ ((𝐹‘𝑥)‘𝑖)))))) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | mplgsum 33697 | Finite commutative sums of polynomials are taken componentwise. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑃 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝐴⟶𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑃 Σg 𝐹) = (𝑦 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ (𝑅 Σg (𝑘 ∈ 𝐴 ↦ ((𝐹‘𝑘)‘𝑦))))) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | psrmonprod 33696 | Finite product of bags of variables in a power series. Here the function 𝐺 maps a bag of variables to the corresponding monomial. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (𝐼 mPwSer 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝐴⟶𝐷) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (mulGrp‘𝑆) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑦 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ (𝑧 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if(𝑧 = 𝑦, 1 , 0 ))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑀 Σg (𝐺 ∘ 𝐹)) = (𝐺‘(𝑖 ∈ 𝐼 ↦ (ℂfld Σg (𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ↦ ((𝐹‘𝑥)‘𝑖)))))) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | psrmonmul2 33695 | The product of two power series monomials adds the exponent vectors together. Here, the function 𝐺 is a monomial builder, which maps a bag of variables with the monic monomial with only those variables. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (𝐼 mPwSer 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐷) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑦 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ (𝑧 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if(𝑧 = 𝑦, 1 , 0 ))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐺‘𝑋) · (𝐺‘𝑌)) = (𝐺‘(𝑋 ∘f + 𝑌))) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | psrmonmul 33694 | The product of two power series monomials adds the exponent vectors together. For example, the product of (𝑥↑2)(𝑦↑2) with (𝑦↑1)(𝑧↑3) is (𝑥↑2)(𝑦↑3)(𝑧↑3), where the exponent vectors 〈2, 2, 0〉 and 〈0, 1, 3〉 are added to give 〈2, 3, 3〉. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (𝐼 mPwSer 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐷) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐷) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑦 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if(𝑦 = 𝑋, 1 , 0 )) · (𝑦 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if(𝑦 = 𝑌, 1 , 0 ))) = (𝑦 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if(𝑦 = (𝑋 ∘f + 𝑌), 1 , 0 ))) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | psrmon 33693 | A monomial is a power series. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (𝐼 mPwSer 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐷) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑦 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if(𝑦 = 𝑋, 1 , 0 )) ∈ 𝐵) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | psrgsum 33692 | Finite commutative sums of power series are taken componentwise. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (𝐼 mPwSer 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝐴⟶𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑆 Σg 𝐹) = (𝑦 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ (𝑅 Σg (𝑘 ∈ 𝐴 ↦ ((𝐹‘𝑘)‘𝑦))))) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | suppgsumssiun 33133 | The support of a function defined as a group sum is a subset of the indexed union of the supports. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑍 = (0g‘𝑀) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 ∈ Mnd) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵) → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ↦ (𝑀 Σg (𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ 𝐶))) supp 𝑍) ⊆ ∪ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ((𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ↦ 𝐶) supp 𝑍)) | ||
| 15-Mar-2026 | goldrasin 47330 | Alternative trigonometric formula for the golden ratio. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 15-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹 = (2 · (cos‘(π / 5))) ⇒ ⊢ 𝐹 = (2 · (sin‘(π · (3 / ;10)))) | ||
| 15-Mar-2026 | goldrarr 47329 | The golden ratio is a real value. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 15-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹 = (2 · (cos‘(π / 5))) ⇒ ⊢ 𝐹 ∈ ℝ | ||
| 14-Mar-2026 | bj-axreprepsep 37382 |
Strong axiom of replacement (universal closure of ax-rep 5212) from the
axioms of separation and replacement as written in the theorem's
hypotheses.
The statement does not require a nonempty universe; most of the proof does not either, except for the use of 19.8a 2189, which could be removed by reworking the proof, since it is applied in a subexpression bound by the variable it introduces. Proof modifications should not introduce steps relying on a nonempty universe, like alrimiv 1929. (Contributed by BJ, 14-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∀𝑥∃𝑠∀𝑦(𝑦 ∈ 𝑠 ↔ (𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 ∧ ∃𝑧𝜑)) & ⊢ ∀𝑠(∀𝑦 ∈ 𝑠 ∃!𝑧𝜑 → ∃𝑡∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑡 ↔ ∃𝑦 ∈ 𝑠 𝜑)) ⇒ ⊢ ∀𝑥(∀𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 ∃*𝑧𝜑 → ∃𝑡∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑡 ↔ ∃𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 𝜑)) | ||
| 14-Mar-2026 | bj-axseprep 37381 |
Axiom of separation (universal closure of ax-sep 5231) from a weak form of
the axiom of replacement requiring that the functional relation in it be
a (total) function and the weak emptyset axiom (existence of an empty
set provided existence of a set), as written in the theorem's
hypotheses.
This result shows that the weak emptyset axiom is not only the result of a cheap way to avoid an axiom redundancy (in this case, the existence axiom extru 1977) by adding it as an antecedent, but also permits to prove nontrivial results that hold in nonnecessarily nonempty universes. This proof is by cases so is not intuitionistic. The statement does not require a nonempty universe; most of the proof does not either, and the parts that do (e.g., near sb8ef 2359 and sbequ12r 2260 and eueq2 3656) could be reworked to avoid it. Proof modifications should not introduce steps relying on a nonempty universe, like alrimiv 1929. (Contributed by BJ, 14-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥⊤ → ∃𝑦∀𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 ⊥) & ⊢ ∀𝑥(∀𝑧 ∈ 𝑥 ∃!𝑡𝜓 → ∃𝑦∀𝑡(𝑡 ∈ 𝑦 ↔ ∃𝑧 ∈ 𝑥 𝜓)) & ⊢ (𝜓 ↔ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑡 = 𝑧) ∨ (¬ 𝜑 ∧ 𝑡 = 𝑎))) ⇒ ⊢ ∀𝑥∃𝑦∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 ↔ (𝑧 ∈ 𝑥 ∧ 𝜑)) | ||
| 14-Mar-2026 | bj-rep 37380 | Version of the axiom of replacement requiring the functional relation in the axiom to be a (total) function from ax-rep 5212 (in the form of axrep6 5221). (Contributed by BJ, 14-Mar-2026.) The proof proves the statement without the DV condition on 𝑥, 𝜑, but the DV condition is added to this statement to show that this weaker version is sufficient. (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∀𝑥(∀𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 ∃!𝑧𝜑 → ∃𝑡∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑡 ↔ ∃𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 𝜑)) | ||
| 14-Mar-2026 | bj-cbvaew 36938 | Exixtentially quantifying over a non-occurring variable is independent from the variable, under a weaker condition than in bj-cbvexvv 36934. (Contributed by BJ, 14-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ((∀𝑥𝜑 → ∀𝑦⊥) → (∃𝑦𝜓 → ∃𝑥𝜓)) | ||
| 14-Mar-2026 | bj-cbveaw 36937 | Universally quantifying over a non-occurring variable is independent from the variable, under a weaker condition than in bj-cbvalvv 36933. (Contributed by BJ, 14-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ((∃𝑥⊤ → ∃𝑦𝜑) → (∀𝑦𝜓 → ∀𝑥𝜓)) | ||
| 14-Mar-2026 | bj-cbvew 36936 | Existentially quantifying over a non-occurring variable is independent from the variable, under a weaker condition than in bj-cbvexvv 36934. If ⊤ is substituted for 𝜑, then the statement reads: "existentially quantifying over a non-occurring variable is independent from the variable as soon as that result is true for the True truth constant. The label "cbvew" means "'change bound variable' theorem, 'exists' quantifier, weak version". (Contributed by BJ, 14-Mar-2026.) This proof is intuitionistic. (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ((∃𝑥⊤ → ∃𝑦𝜑) → (∃𝑥𝜓 → ∃𝑦𝜓)) | ||
| 14-Mar-2026 | bj-cbvaw 36935 | Universally quantifying over a non-occurring variable is independent from the variable, under a weaker condition than in bj-cbvalvv 36933. If ⊥ is substituted for 𝜑, then the statement reads: "universally quantifying over a non-occurring variable is independent from the variable as soon as that result is true for the False truth constant". The label "cbvaw" means "'change bound variable' theorem, 'all' quantifier, weak version". (Contributed by BJ, 14-Mar-2026.) This proof is not intuitionistic (it uses ja 186); an intuitionistically valid statement is obtained by expressing the antecedent as a disjunction (classically equivalent through imor 854). (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ((∀𝑥𝜑 → ∀𝑦⊥) → (∀𝑥𝜓 → ∀𝑦𝜓)) | ||
| 14-Mar-2026 | bj-exextruan 36932 |
An equivalent expression for existential quantification over a
non-occurring variable proved over ax-1 6--
ax-5 1912. The forward
implication can be seen as a strengthening of ax-5 1912
(a conjunct is
added to the consequent of the implication). The reverse implication
can be strengthened when ax-6 1969 is posited (which implies that models
are non-empty), see 19.8v 1985. See bj-alextruim 36931 for a dual statement.
An approximate meaning is: the existential quantification of a proposition over a non-occurring variable holds if and only if the proposition holds and the universe is nonempty. (Contributed by BJ, 14-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 ↔ (∃𝑥⊤ ∧ 𝜑)) | ||
| 14-Mar-2026 | bj-alextruim 36931 |
An equivalent expression for universal quantification over a
non-occurring variable proved over ax-1 6--
ax-5 1912. The forward
implication can be strengthened when ax-6 1969
is posited (which implies
that models are non-empty), see spvw 1983. The reverse implication can be
seen as a strengthening of ax-5 1912 (since the antecedent of the
implication is weakened). See bj-exextruan 36932 for a dual statement.
An approximate meaning is: the universal quantification of a proposition over a non-occurring variable holds if and only if the proposition holds in nonempty universes. (Contributed by BJ, 14-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑥𝜑 ↔ (∃𝑥⊤ → 𝜑)) | ||
| 14-Mar-2026 | bj-exexalal 36871 | A lemma for changing bound variables. Only the forward implication is intuitionistic. (Contributed by BJ, 14-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((∃𝑥𝜑 → ∃𝑦𝜓) ↔ (∀𝑦 ¬ 𝜓 → ∀𝑥 ¬ 𝜑)) | ||
| 11-Mar-2026 | axprglem 5378 | Lemma for axprg 5379. (Contributed by GG, 11-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝐴 → ∃𝑧∀𝑤((𝑤 = 𝐴 ∨ 𝑤 = 𝐵) → 𝑤 ∈ 𝑧)) | ||
| 8-Mar-2026 | bj-axnul 37379 |
Over the base theory ax-1 6-- ax-5 1912, the axiom of separation implies
the weak emptyset axiom.
By "weak emptyset axiom", we mean the axiom asserting existence of an empty set (which can be called "the" empty set when the axiom of extensionality ax-ext 2708 is posited) provided existence of a set (the True truth constant existentially quantified over a fresh variable, extru 1977). This is the conclusion of bj-axnul 37379. Note that the weak emptyset axiom implies ⊢ (∃𝑥⊤ → ∃𝑦⊤) without DV conditions hence also the same statement as the weak emptyset axiom without DV conditions on 𝑥, but only on 𝑦, 𝑧. By "axiom of separation", we mean the universal closure of ax-sep 5231, simulated here by its instance with ⊥ substituted for 𝜑 (and with the variable used to assert existence in the weak emptyset axiom substituted for the containing set) as the hypothesis of bj-axnul 37379. In particular, the axiom of existence extru 1977 and the axiom of separation together imply the emptyset axiom (and conversely, the emptyset axiom implies the axiom of existence). Note: this theorem does not require a disjointness condition on 𝑦, 𝑧, although both axioms should be stated with all variables disjoint. This proof only uses an instance of the axiom of separation with a bounded formula, so is valid in a constructive setting (see the CZF section in the "Intuitionistic Logic Explorer" iset.mm). (Contributed by BJ, 8-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∀𝑥∃𝑦∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 ↔ (𝑧 ∈ 𝑥 ∧ ⊥)) ⇒ ⊢ (∃𝑥⊤ → ∃𝑦∀𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 ⊥) | ||
| 8-Mar-2026 | bj-cbvexvv 36934 | Existentially quantifying over a non-occurring variable is independent of that variable, over ax-1 6-- ax-5 1912 and the existence axiom extru 1977. See bj-cbvew 36936 for a strengthening. (Contributed by BJ, 8-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 → (∃𝑦𝜓 → ∃𝑥𝜓)) | ||
| 8-Mar-2026 | bj-cbvalvv 36933 | Universally quantifying over a non-occurring variable is independent of that variable, over ax-1 6-- ax-5 1912 and the existence axiom extru 1977. See bj-cbvaw 36935 for a strengthening. (Contributed by BJ, 8-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜓 → ∀𝑦𝜓)) | ||
| 8-Mar-2026 | bj-spvew 36930 | Version of 19.8v 1985 and 19.9v 1986 proved from ax-1 6-- ax-5 1912. The antecedent can for instance be proved with the existence axiom extru 1977. (Contributed by BJ, 8-Mar-2026.) This could also be proved from bj-spvw 36929 using duality, but that proof would not be intuitionistic, contrary to the present one. (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 → (𝜓 ↔ ∃𝑥𝜓)) | ||
| 8-Mar-2026 | bj-spvw 36929 | Version of spvw 1983 and 19.3v 1984 proved from ax-1 6-- ax-5 1912. The antecedent can for instance be proved with the existence axiom extru 1977. (Contributed by BJ, 8-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 → (𝜓 ↔ ∀𝑥𝜓)) | ||
| 8-Mar-2026 | bj-axdd2ALT 36914 | Alternate proof of bj-axdd2 36857 (this should replace bj-axdd2 36857 when bj-exalimi 36910 is moved to the main section). (Contributed by BJ, 8-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜓 → ∃𝑥𝜓)) | ||
| 6-Mar-2026 | opex 5416 | An ordered pair of classes is a set. Exercise 7 of [TakeutiZaring] p. 16. (Contributed by NM, 18-Aug-1993.) (Revised by Mario Carneiro, 26-Apr-2015.) Avoid ax-nul 5241. (Revised by GG, 6-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 〈𝐴, 𝐵〉 ∈ V | ||
| 6-Mar-2026 | snexg 5382 | A singleton built on a set is a set. Special case of snex 5381 which is intuitionistically valid. (Contributed by NM, 7-Aug-1994.) (Revised by Mario Carneiro, 19-May-2013.) Extract from snex 5381 and shorten proof. (Revised by BJ, 15-Jan-2025.) (Proof shortened by GG, 6-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → {𝐴} ∈ V) | ||
| 6-Mar-2026 | snex 5381 | A singleton is a set. Theorem 7.12 of [Quine] p. 51, proved using Extensionality, Separation and Pairing. See also snexALT 5325. (Contributed by NM, 7-Aug-1994.) (Revised by Mario Carneiro, 19-May-2013.) Avoid ax-nul 5241 and shorten proof. (Revised by GG, 6-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ {𝐴} ∈ V | ||
| 6-Mar-2026 | prex 5380 | The Axiom of Pairing using class variables. Theorem 7.13 of [Quine] p. 51. By virtue of its definition, an unordered pair remains a set (even though no longer a pair) even when its components are proper classes (see prprc 4711), so we can dispense with hypotheses requiring them to be sets. (Contributed by NM, 15-Jul-1993.) Avoid ax-nul 5241 and shorten proof. (Revised by GG, 6-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ {𝐴, 𝐵} ∈ V | ||
| 6-Mar-2026 | axprg 5379 | Derive The Axiom of Pairing with class variables. (Contributed by GG, 6-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑧∀𝑤((𝑤 = 𝐴 ∨ 𝑤 = 𝐵) → 𝑤 ∈ 𝑧) | ||
| 5-Mar-2026 | mh-setindnd 36719 | A version of mh-setind 36718 with no distinct variable conditions. (Contributed by Matthew House, 5-Mar-2026.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑦(∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 → 𝜑) → ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → ∀𝑦𝜑)) → 𝜑) | ||
| 4-Mar-2026 | regsfromunir1 36722 | Derivation of ax-regs 35270 from unir1 9737. (Contributed by Matthew House, 4-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On) = V ⇒ ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 → ∃𝑦(∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → 𝜑) ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑧 → 𝜑)))) | ||
| 4-Mar-2026 | regsfromsetind 36721 | Derivation of ax-regs 35270 from mh-setind 36718. (Contributed by Matthew House, 4-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑦(∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ 𝜑) → ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → ¬ 𝜑)) → ¬ 𝜑) ⇒ ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 → ∃𝑦(∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → 𝜑) ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑧 → 𝜑)))) | ||
| 4-Mar-2026 | regsfromregtco 36720 | Derivation of ax-regs 35270 from ax-reg 9507 + ax-tco 36654. (Contributed by Matthew House, 4-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑦 𝑦 ∈ 𝑤 → ∃𝑦(𝑦 ∈ 𝑤 ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ 𝑧 ∈ 𝑤))) & ⊢ ∃𝑢(𝑣 ∈ 𝑢 ∧ ∀𝑡(𝑡 ∈ 𝑢 → ∀𝑠(𝑠 ∈ 𝑡 → 𝑠 ∈ 𝑢))) ⇒ ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 → ∃𝑦(∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → 𝜑) ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑧 → 𝜑)))) | ||
| 4-Mar-2026 | mh-setind 36718 | Principle of set induction setind 9668, written with primitive symbols. (Contributed by Matthew House, 4-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑦(∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 → 𝜑) → ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → 𝜑)) → 𝜑) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | eln0s2 28349 | A non-negative surreal integer is a surreal ordinal with a finite birthday. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℕ0s ↔ (𝐴 ∈ Ons ∧ ( bday ‘𝐴) ∈ ω)) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | peano2n0sd 28323 | Peano postulate: the successor of a non-negative surreal integer is a non-negative surreal integer. Deduction form. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℕ0s) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 +s 1s ) ∈ ℕ0s) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | divs1d 28197 | A surreal divided by one is itself. Deduction version. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 /su 1s ) = 𝐴) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | rightnod 27874 | An element of a right set is a surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ( R ‘𝐵)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | rightoldd 27873 | An element of a right set is an element of the old set. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ( R ‘𝐵)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ( O ‘( bday ‘𝐵))) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | leftnod 27872 | An element of a left set is a surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ( L ‘𝐵)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | leftoldd 27871 | An element of a left set is an element of the old set. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ( L ‘𝐵)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ( O ‘( bday ‘𝐵))) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | rightno 27870 | An element of a right set is a surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ( R ‘𝐵) → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | leftno 27869 | An element of a left set is a surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ( L ‘𝐵) → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | rightold 27868 | An element of a right set is an element of the old set. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ( R ‘𝐵) → 𝐴 ∈ ( O ‘( bday ‘𝐵))) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | leftold 27867 | An element of a left set is an element of the old set. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ( L ‘𝐵) → 𝐴 ∈ ( O ‘( bday ‘𝐵))) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | oldmaded 27861 | An element of an old set is an element of a made set. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ( O ‘𝐵)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ( M ‘𝐵)) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | oldmade 27860 | An element of an old set is an element of a made set. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ( O ‘𝐵) → 𝐴 ∈ ( M ‘𝐵)) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | newnod 27840 | An element of a new set is a surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ( N ‘𝐵)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | oldnod 27839 | An element of an old set is a surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ( O ‘𝐵)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | madenod 27838 | An element of a made set is a surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ( M ‘𝐵)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | newno 27837 | An element of a new set is a surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ( N ‘𝐵) → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | oldno 27836 | An element of an old set is a surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ( O ‘𝐵) → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | madeno 27835 | An element of a made set is a surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ( M ‘𝐵) → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | nulsgtsd 27770 | The empty set is greater than any set of surreals. Deduction version. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ⊆ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 <<s ∅) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | nulsltsd 27769 | The empty set is less-than any set of surreals. Deduction version. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ⊆ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ∅ <<s 𝐴) | ||
| 26-Feb-2026 | dfz12s2 28480 | The set of dyadic fractions is the same as the old set of ω. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 26-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ℤs[1/2] = ( O ‘ω) | ||
| 26-Feb-2026 | bdayfin 28479 | A surreal has a finite birthday iff it is a dyadic fraction. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 26-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ No → (𝐴 ∈ ℤs[1/2] ↔ ( bday ‘𝐴) ∈ ω)) | ||
| 26-Feb-2026 | bdayfinlem 28478 | Lemma for bdayfin 28479. Handle the non-negative case. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 26-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ No ∧ 0s ≤s 𝐴 ∧ ( bday ‘𝐴) ∈ ω) → 𝐴 ∈ ℤs[1/2]) | ||
| 26-Feb-2026 | bdayfinbnd 28461 | Given a non-negative integer and a non-negative surreal of lesser or equal birthday, show that the surreal can be expressed as a dyadic fraction with an upper bound on the integer and exponent. This proof follows the proof from Mizar at https://mizar.uwb.edu.pl/version/current/html/surrealn.html. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 26-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ( bday ‘𝑍) ⊆ ( bday ‘𝑁)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 0s ≤s 𝑍) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑍 = 𝑁 ∨ ∃𝑥 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑦 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑝 ∈ ℕ0s (𝑍 = (𝑥 +s (𝑦 /su (2s↑s𝑝))) ∧ 𝑦 <s (2s↑s𝑝) ∧ (𝑥 +s 𝑝) <s 𝑁))) | ||
| 26-Feb-2026 | bdayfinbndlem2 28460 | Lemma for bdayfinbnd 28461. Conduct the induction. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 26-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s → ∀𝑧 ∈ No ((( bday ‘𝑧) ⊆ ( bday ‘𝑁) ∧ 0s ≤s 𝑧) → (𝑧 = 𝑁 ∨ ∃𝑥 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑦 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑝 ∈ ℕ0s (𝑧 = (𝑥 +s (𝑦 /su (2s↑s𝑝))) ∧ 𝑦 <s (2s↑s𝑝) ∧ (𝑥 +s 𝑝) <s 𝑁)))) | ||
| 26-Feb-2026 | bdayfinbndlem1 28459 | Lemma for bdayfinbnd 28461. Show the first half of the inductive step. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 26-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑧 ∈ No ((( bday ‘𝑧) ⊆ ( bday ‘𝑁) ∧ 0s ≤s 𝑧) → (𝑧 = 𝑁 ∨ ∃𝑥 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑦 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑝 ∈ ℕ0s (𝑧 = (𝑥 +s (𝑦 /su (2s↑s𝑝))) ∧ 𝑦 <s (2s↑s𝑝) ∧ (𝑥 +s 𝑝) <s 𝑁)))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑤 ∈ No ((( bday ‘𝑤) ⊆ ( bday ‘(𝑁 +s 1s )) ∧ 0s ≤s 𝑤) → (𝑤 = (𝑁 +s 1s ) ∨ ∃𝑎 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑏 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑞 ∈ ℕ0s (𝑤 = (𝑎 +s (𝑏 /su (2s↑s𝑞))) ∧ 𝑏 <s (2s↑s𝑞) ∧ (𝑎 +s 𝑞) <s (𝑁 +s 1s ))))) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | dfpeters2 39295 |
Alternate definition of PetErs in fully modular form.
This expands the Ers 𝑛 predicate into: (i) a typedness module ( Rels × CoMembErs ), (ii) an equivalence module for the coset relation ≀ (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)) ∈ EqvRels, (iii) the corresponding quotient-carrier (domain quotient) equation dom ≀ (...) / ≀ (...) = 𝑛. This is the equivalence-side counterpart of the modular decomposition dfpetparts2 39293 on the partition side. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ PetErs = ((( Rels × CoMembErs ) ∩ {〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∣ ≀ (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)) ∈ EqvRels }) ∩ {〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∣ (dom ≀ (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)) / ≀ (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛))) = 𝑛}) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | dfpet2parts2 39294 |
Grade stability applied to the decomposed PetParts
modules.
Pet2Parts is obtained by applying the grade-stability operator SucMap ShiftStable (see df-shiftstable 38803) to the modular intersection from dfpetparts2 39293. This makes the two orthogonal stability axes explicit: (E) semantic stability / equilibrium: BlockLiftFix, (G) grade stability: SucMap ShiftStable, assembled on top of typedness and disjoint-span base modules. This is the principled "extra level" that does not arise for Disjs: disjoint relations already bundle their internal map/carrier consistency via QMap and ElDisjs (see dfdisjs6 39263 / dfdisjs7 39264), while the present construction has an additional external grading axis imposed by the canonical successor map SucMap. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 20-Feb-2026.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Pet2Parts = ( SucMap ShiftStable ((( Rels × MembParts ) ∩ {〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∣ (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)) ∈ Disjs }) ∩ BlockLiftFix )) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | dfpetparts2 39293 |
Alternate definition of PetParts as typedness +
disjoint-span +
block-lift equilibrium.
This theorem is the key modularization step. It decomposes PetParts into the intersection of three orthogonal modules: (T) typedness: 〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∈ ( Rels × MembParts ), (D) disjoint-span: (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)) ∈ Disjs, (E) semantic equilibrium: 〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∈ BlockLiftFix, i.e. the carrier 𝑛 is a fixpoint of the induced block-generation operator. Conceptually, (D) provides the disjointness/quotient discipline for the lifted span, while (E) prevents hidden carrier drift (refinement or coarsening of what counts as a block) by enforcing the fixpoint equation. The point of this theorem is that these constraints can be imposed and reused independently by later constructions, while their intersection recovers the intended Parts-based notion. This mirrors the internal packaging of Disjs (see dfdisjs6 39263 / dfdisjs7 39264): for disjoint relations, the "map layer + carrier layer" decomposition is internal via QMap and ElDisjs; for PetParts, the carrier 𝑛 is an external parameter, so the additional carrier stability must be factored explicitly as BlockLiftFix. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 20-Feb-2026.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ PetParts = ((( Rels × MembParts ) ∩ {〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∣ (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)) ∈ Disjs }) ∩ BlockLiftFix ) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | df-peters 39290 |
Define the class of equivalence-side general partition-equivalence
spans.
〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∈ PetErs means: (1) 𝑟 is a set-relation (𝑟 ∈ Rels), and (2) 𝑛 is a carrier recognized on the equivalence side of membership (𝑛 ∈ CoMembErs), and (3) the coset relation of the lifted span, ≀ (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)), is an equivalence relation on its natural quotient with carrier 𝑛 (i.e. ≀ (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)) Ers 𝑛). This packages the equivalence-view of the same lifted construction that underlies PetParts. It is designed to be parallel to PetParts so later proofs can freely choose the partition side (Parts) or the equivalence side (Ers) without rebuilding the bridge each time; the identification is provided by petseq 39297 (using typesafepets 39296 and mpets 39277). The explicit typing (𝑟 ∈ Rels ∧ 𝑛 ∈ CoMembErs ) is included for the same reason as in df-petparts 39289: to make typedness a reusable module. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 19-Feb-2026.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ PetErs = {〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∣ ((𝑟 ∈ Rels ∧ 𝑛 ∈ CoMembErs ) ∧ ≀ (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)) Ers 𝑛)} | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | df-petparts 39289 |
Define the class of partition-side general partition-equivalence spans.
〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∈ PetParts means: (1) 𝑟 is a set-relation (𝑟 ∈ Rels), and (2) 𝑛 is a membership block-carrier (𝑛 ∈ MembParts), and (3) the block-lift span (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)) is a generalized partition on its natural quotient-carrier 𝑛 (i.e. (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)) Parts 𝑛). This is the horizontal feasibility base object on the partition side, expressed in the type-safe Parts language. The explicit typing (𝑟 ∈ Rels ∧ 𝑛 ∈ MembParts ) is included at the definition level so later modular refinements can treat typedness as a first-class component (e.g. intersecting a typedness module with disjointness and equilibrium modules) without repeatedly restating it. In particular, it lets decompositions such as dfpetparts2 39293 be written as clean intersections whose first conjunct is exactly the typedness module ( Rels × MembParts ). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 19-Feb-2026.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ PetParts = {〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∣ ((𝑟 ∈ Rels ∧ 𝑛 ∈ MembParts ) ∧ (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)) Parts 𝑛)} | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | bdayfinbndcbv 28458 | Lemma for bdayfinbnd 28461. Change some bound variables. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑧 ∈ No ((( bday ‘𝑧) ⊆ ( bday ‘𝑁) ∧ 0s ≤s 𝑧) → (𝑧 = 𝑁 ∨ ∃𝑥 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑦 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑝 ∈ ℕ0s (𝑧 = (𝑥 +s (𝑦 /su (2s↑s𝑝))) ∧ 𝑦 <s (2s↑s𝑝) ∧ (𝑥 +s 𝑝) <s 𝑁)))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑤 ∈ No ((( bday ‘𝑤) ⊆ ( bday ‘𝑁) ∧ 0s ≤s 𝑤) → (𝑤 = 𝑁 ∨ ∃𝑎 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑏 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑞 ∈ ℕ0s (𝑤 = (𝑎 +s (𝑏 /su (2s↑s𝑞))) ∧ 𝑏 <s (2s↑s𝑞) ∧ (𝑎 +s 𝑞) <s 𝑁)))) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | bdaypw2bnd 28457 | Birthday bounding rule for non-negative dyadic rationals. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑃 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 <s (2s↑s𝑃)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 +s 𝑃) <s 𝑁) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( bday ‘(𝑋 +s (𝑌 /su (2s↑s𝑃)))) ⊆ ( bday ‘𝑁)) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | onlesd 28262 | Less-than or equal is the same as non-strict birthday comparison over surreal ordinals. Deduction version. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Ons) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ Ons) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 ≤s 𝐵 ↔ ( bday ‘𝐴) ⊆ ( bday ‘𝐵))) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | onltsd 28261 | Less-than is the same as birthday comparison over surreal ordinals. Deduction version. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Ons) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ Ons) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 <s 𝐵 ↔ ( bday ‘𝐴) ∈ ( bday ‘𝐵))) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | onles 28260 | Less-than or equal is the same as non-strict birthday comparison over surreal ordinals. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ Ons ∧ 𝐵 ∈ Ons) → (𝐴 ≤s 𝐵 ↔ ( bday ‘𝐴) ⊆ ( bday ‘𝐵))) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | lestri3d 27723 | Trichotomy law for surreal less-than or equal. Deduction version. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 = 𝐵 ↔ (𝐴 ≤s 𝐵 ∧ 𝐵 ≤s 𝐴))) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | lesloed 27722 | Surreal less-than or equal in terms of less-than. Deduction version. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 ≤s 𝐵 ↔ (𝐴 <s 𝐵 ∨ 𝐴 = 𝐵))) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | ltsnled 27721 | Surreal less-than in terms of less-than or equal. Deduction version. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 <s 𝐵 ↔ ¬ 𝐵 ≤s 𝐴)) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | lesnltd 27720 | Surreal less-than or equal in terms of less-than. Deduction version. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 ≤s 𝐵 ↔ ¬ 𝐵 <s 𝐴)) | ||
| 24-Feb-2026 | addsge01d 28008 | A surreal is less-than or equal to itself plus a non-negative surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 24-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( 0s ≤s 𝐵 ↔ 𝐴 ≤s (𝐴 +s 𝐵))) | ||
| 24-Feb-2026 | funcnvmpt 6949 | Condition for a function in maps-to notation to be single-rooted. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 28-Feb-2017.) (Proof shortened by Peter Mazsa, 24-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥𝜑 & ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥𝐴 & ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥𝐹 & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ↦ 𝐵) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴) → 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (Fun ◡𝐹 ↔ ∀𝑦∃*𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝑦 = 𝐵)) | ||
| 24-Feb-2026 | bian1d 580 | Adding a superfluous conjunct in a biconditional. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 26-Feb-2017.) (Proof shortened by Hongxiu Chen, 29-Jun-2025.) (Proof shortened by Peter Mazsa, 24-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜓 ↔ (𝜒 ∧ 𝜃))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝜒 ∧ 𝜓) ↔ (𝜒 ∧ 𝜃))) | ||
| 23-Feb-2026 | pw2ltdivmuls2d 28449 | Surreal less-than relationship between division and multiplication for powers of two. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 23-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 /su (2s↑s𝑁)) <s 𝐵 ↔ 𝐴 <s (𝐵 ·s (2s↑s𝑁)))) | ||
| 23-Feb-2026 | n0lts1e0 28360 | A non-negative surreal integer is less than one iff it is zero. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 23-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℕ0s → (𝐴 <s 1s ↔ 𝐴 = 0s )) | ||
| 23-Feb-2026 | cutminmax 27928 | If the left set of 𝑋 has a maximum and the right set of 𝑋 has a minimum, then 𝑋 is equal to the cut of the maximum and the minimum. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 23-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐿 ∈ ( L ‘𝑋)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥 ∈ ( L ‘𝑋)𝑥 ≤s 𝐿) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ ( R ‘𝑋)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦 ∈ ( R ‘𝑋)𝑅 ≤s 𝑦) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 = ({𝐿} |s {𝑅})) | ||
| 23-Feb-2026 | sltsbday 27909 | Birthday comparison rule for surreals. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 23-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 = (𝐿 |s 𝑅)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐿 <<s {𝐵}) & ⊢ (𝜑 → {𝐵} <<s 𝑅) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( bday ‘𝐴) ⊆ ( bday ‘𝐵)) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | dfblockliftmap 38781 | Alternate definition of the block lift map. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 29-Jan-2026.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 BlockLiftMap 𝐴) = (𝑚 ∈ dom (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) ↦ [𝑚](𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴))) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | df-blockliftmap 38780 |
Define the block lift map. Given a relation 𝑅 and a carrier/set
𝐴, we form the block relation (𝑅 ⋉
◡ E ) (i.e., "follow
both 𝑅 and element"), restricted to
𝐴
(or, equivalently, "follow
both 𝑅 and elements-of-A", cf. xrnres2 38747). Then map each domain
element 𝑚 to its coset [𝑚] under that restricted
block relation.
For 𝑚 in the domain, which requires (𝑚 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ 𝑚 ≠ ∅ ∧ [𝑚]𝑅 ≠ ∅) (cf. eldmxrncnvepres 38755), the fiber has the product form [𝑚](𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E ) = ([𝑚]𝑅 × 𝑚), so the block relation lifts a block 𝑚 to the rectangular grid "external labels × internal members", see dfblockliftmap2 38782. Contrast: while the adjoined lift, via (𝑅 ∪ ◡ E ), attaches neighbors and members in a single relation (see dfadjliftmap2 38778), the block lift labels each internal member by each external neighbor. For the general case and a two-stage construction (first block lift, then adjoin membership), see the comments to df-adjliftmap 38776. For the equilibrium condition, see df-blockliftfix 38802. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 24-Jan-2026.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 BlockLiftMap 𝐴) = QMap (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | dfadjliftmap 38777 | Alternate (expanded) definition of the adjoined lift map. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 AdjLiftMap 𝐴) = (𝑚 ∈ dom ((𝑅 ∪ ◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴) ↦ [𝑚]((𝑅 ∪ ◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴)) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | df-adjliftmap 38776 |
Define the adjoined lift map. Given a relation 𝑅 and a carrier/set
𝐴, we form the adjoined relation (𝑅 ∪ ◡ E ) (i.e., "follow
𝑅 or follow elements"),
restricted to 𝐴, and map each domain
element 𝑚 to its coset [𝑚] under that restricted
adjoined
relation, see its expanded version dfadjliftmap 38777. Thus, for 𝑚 in
its domain, we have (𝑚 ∪ [𝑚]𝑅), see dfadjliftmap2 38778.
Its key special case is successor: for 𝑅 = I and 𝐴 = dom I, or 𝐴 = V, the adjoined relation is ( I ∪ ◡ E ), and the coset becomes [𝑚]( I ∪ ◡ E ) = (𝑚 ∪ {𝑚}). So ( I AdjLiftMap dom I ) or ( I AdjLiftMap V) (see dfsucmap2 38785 and dfsucmap3 38784) are exactly the successor map 𝑚 ↦ suc 𝑚 (cf. dfsucmap4 38786), which is a prerequisite for accepting the adjoining lift as the right generalization of successor. A maximally generic form would be "( R F LiftMap A )" defined as (𝑚 ∈ dom ((𝑅𝐹◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴) ↦ [𝑚]((𝑅𝐹◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴)) where 𝐹 is an object-level binary operator on relations (used via df-ov 7370). However, ∪ and ⋉ are introduced in set.mm as class constructors (e.g. df-un 3894), not as an object-level binary function symbol 𝐹 that can be passed as a parameter. To make the generic 𝐹-pattern literally usable, we would need to reify union and ⋉ as function-objects, which is additional infrastructure. To avoid introducing operator-as-function objects solely to support 𝐹, we define: AdjLiftMap directly using df-un 3894, and BlockLiftMap directly using the existing ⋉ constructor dfxrn2 38706, so we treat any "generic 𝐹-LiftMap" as optional future generalization, not a dependency. We prefer to avoid defining too many concepts. For this reason, we will not introduce a named "adjoining relation", a named carrier "adjoining lift" "( R AdjLift A )", in place of ran (𝑅 AdjLiftMap 𝐴), which is (dom ((𝑅 ∪ ◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴) / ((𝑅 ∪ ◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴)), cf. dfqs2 8650, or the equilibrium condition "AdjLiftFix" , in place of {〈𝑟, 𝑎〉 ∣ (dom ((𝑅 ∪ ◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴) / ((𝑅 ∪ ◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴)) = 𝑎} (cf. its analog df-blockliftfix 38802). These are definable by simple expansions and/or domain-quotient theorems when needed. A "two-stage" construction is obtained by first forming the block relation (𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E ) and then adjoining elements as "BlockAdj" . Combined, it uses the relation ((𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E ) ∪ ◡ E ), which for 𝑚 in its domain (𝐴 ∖ {∅}) gives (𝑚 ∪ [𝑚](𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E )), yielding "BlockAdjLiftMap" (cf. blockadjliftmap 38779) and "BlockAdjLiftFix". We only introduce these if a downstream theorem actually requires them. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 24-Jan-2026.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 AdjLiftMap 𝐴) = QMap ((𝑅 ∪ ◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | z12bday 28477 | A dyadic fraction has a finite birthday. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 20-Aug-2025.) (Proof shortened by Scott Fenton, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℤs[1/2] → ( bday ‘𝐴) ∈ ω) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | z12bdaylem 28476 | Lemma for z12bday 28477. Handle the non-negative case. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℤs[1/2] ∧ 0s ≤s 𝐴) → ( bday ‘𝐴) ∈ ω) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | z12bdaylem2 28463 | Lemma for z12bday 28477. Show the first half of the equality. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑃 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((2s ·s 𝑀) +s 1s ) <s (2s↑s𝑃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( bday ‘(𝑁 +s (((2s ·s 𝑀) +s 1s ) /su (2s↑s𝑃)))) ⊆ ( bday ‘((𝑁 +s 𝑃) +s 1s ))) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | z12bdaylem1 28462 | Lemma for z12bday 28477. Prove an inequality for birthday ordering. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑃 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((2s ·s 𝑀) +s 1s ) <s (2s↑s𝑃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑁 +s (((2s ·s 𝑀) +s 1s ) /su (2s↑s𝑃))) ≠ (𝑁 +s 𝑃)) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | bdaypw2n0bnd 28456 | Upper bound for the birthday of a proper fraction of a power of two. This is actually a strict equality when 𝐴 is odd, but we do not need this for the rest of our development. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℕ0s ∧ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s ∧ 𝐴 <s (2s↑s𝑁)) → ( bday ‘(𝐴 /su (2s↑s𝑁))) ⊆ suc ( bday ‘𝑁)) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | onsbnd2 28274 | The surreals of a given birthday are bounded below by the negative of that ordinal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ Ons ∧ 𝐵 ∈ ( M ‘( bday ‘𝐴))) → ( -us ‘𝐴) ≤s 𝐵) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | onsbnd 28273 | The surreals of a given birthday are bounded above by that ordinal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ Ons ∧ 𝐵 ∈ ( M ‘( bday ‘𝐴))) → 𝐵 ≤s 𝐴) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | addonbday 28271 | The birthday of the sum of two ordinals is the natural sum of their birthdays. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ Ons ∧ 𝐵 ∈ Ons) → ( bday ‘(𝐴 +s 𝐵)) = (( bday ‘𝐴) +no ( bday ‘𝐵))) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | ons2ind 28267 | Double induction schema for surreal ordinals. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝑥𝑂 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓)) & ⊢ (𝑦 = 𝑦𝑂 → (𝜓 ↔ 𝜒)) & ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝑥𝑂 → (𝜃 ↔ 𝜒)) & ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝐴 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜏)) & ⊢ (𝑦 = 𝐵 → (𝜏 ↔ 𝜂)) & ⊢ ((𝑥 ∈ Ons ∧ 𝑦 ∈ Ons) → ((∀𝑥𝑂 ∈ Ons ∀𝑦𝑂 ∈ Ons ((𝑥𝑂 <s 𝑥 ∧ 𝑦𝑂 <s 𝑦) → 𝜒) ∧ ∀𝑥𝑂 ∈ Ons (𝑥𝑂 <s 𝑥 → 𝜓) ∧ ∀𝑦𝑂 ∈ Ons (𝑦𝑂 <s 𝑦 → 𝜃)) → 𝜑)) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ Ons ∧ 𝐵 ∈ Ons) → 𝜂) | ||
| 21-Feb-2026 | elz12si 28465 | Inference form of membership in the dyadic fractions. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 21-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℤs ∧ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) → (𝐴 /su (2s↑s𝑁)) ∈ ℤs[1/2]) | ||
| 21-Feb-2026 | bdaypw2n0bndlem 28455 | Lemma for bdaypw2n0bnd 28456. Prove the case with a successor. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 21-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℕ0s ∧ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s ∧ 𝐴 <s (2s↑s(𝑁 +s 1s ))) → ( bday ‘(𝐴 /su (2s↑s(𝑁 +s 1s )))) ⊆ suc ( bday ‘(𝑁 +s 1s ))) | ||
| 21-Feb-2026 | pw2divsidd 28448 | Identity law for division over powers of two. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 21-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((2s↑s𝑁) /su (2s↑s𝑁)) = 1s ) | ||
| 21-Feb-2026 | pw2divs0d 28447 | Division into zero is zero for a power of two. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 21-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( 0s /su (2s↑s𝑁)) = 0s ) | ||
| 21-Feb-2026 | zcuts0 28400 | Either the left or right set of a surreal integer is empty. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 21-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℤs → (( L ‘𝐴) = ∅ ∨ ( R ‘𝐴) = ∅)) | ||
| 21-Feb-2026 | negright 28051 | The right set of the negative of a surreal is the set of negatives of its left set. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 21-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ No → ( R ‘( -us ‘𝐴)) = ( -us “ ( L ‘𝐴))) | ||
| 21-Feb-2026 | negleft 28050 | The left set of the negative of a surreal is the set of negatives of its right set. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 21-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ No → ( L ‘( -us ‘𝐴)) = ( -us “ ( R ‘𝐴))) | ||
| 20-Feb-2026 | df-blockliftfix 38802 |
Define the equilibrium / fixed-point condition for "block carriers".
Start with a candidate block-family 𝑎 (a set whose elements you intend to treat as blocks). Combine it with a relation 𝑟 by forming the block-lift span 𝑇 = (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑎)). For a block 𝑢 ∈ 𝑎, the fiber [𝑢]𝑇 is the set of all outputs produced from "external targets" of 𝑟 together with "internal members" of 𝑢; in other words, 𝑇 is the mechanism that generates new blocks from old ones. Now apply the standard quotient construction (dom 𝑇 / 𝑇). This produces the family of all T-blocks (the cosets [𝑥]𝑇 of witnesses 𝑥 in the domain of 𝑇). In general, this operation can change your carrier: starting from 𝑎, it may generate a different block-family (dom 𝑇 / 𝑇). The equation (dom (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑎)) / (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑎))) = 𝑎 says exactly: if you generate blocks from 𝑎 using the lift determined by 𝑟 (cf. df-blockliftmap 38780), you get back the same 𝑎. So 𝑎 is stable under the block-generation operator induced by 𝑟. This is why it is a genuine fixpoint/equilibrium condition: one application of the "make-the-blocks" operator causes no carrier drift, i.e. no hidden refinement/coarsening of what counts as a block. Here, the quotient (dom 𝑇 / 𝑇) is the standard carrier of 𝑇 -blocks; see dfqs2 8650 for the quotient-as-range viewpoint. This is an untyped equilibrium predicate on pairs 〈𝑟, 𝑎〉. No hypothesis 𝑟 ∈ Rels is built into the definition, because the fixpoint equation depends only on those ordered pairs 〈𝑥, 𝑦〉 that belong to 𝑟 and hence can witness an atomic instance 𝑥𝑟𝑦; extra non-ordered-pair "junk" elements in 𝑟 are ignored automatically by the relational membership predicate. When later work needs 𝑟 to be relation-typed (e.g. to intersect with ( Rels × V)-style typedness modules, or to apply Rels-based infrastructure uniformly), the additional typing constraint 𝑟 ∈ Rels should be imposed locally as a separate conjunct (rather than being baked into this equilibrium module). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 25-Jan-2026.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 20-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ BlockLiftFix = {〈𝑟, 𝑎〉 ∣ (dom (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑎)) / (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑎))) = 𝑎} | ||
| 20-Feb-2026 | n0ssoldg 28345 | The non-negative surreal integers are a subset of the old set of ω. To avoid the axiom of infinity, we include it as an antecedent. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 20-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (ω ∈ V → ℕ0s ⊆ ( O ‘ω)) | ||
| 20-Feb-2026 | infinf 10489 | Equivalence between two infiniteness criteria for sets. (Contributed by David Moews, 1-May-2017.) (Proof shortened by Scott Fenton, 20-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝐵 → (¬ 𝐴 ∈ Fin ↔ ω ≼ 𝐴)) | ||
| 20-Feb-2026 | infinfg 10488 | Equivalence between two infiniteness criteria for sets. To avoid the axiom of infinity, we include it as a hypothesis. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 20-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((ω ∈ V ∧ 𝐴 ∈ 𝐵) → (¬ 𝐴 ∈ Fin ↔ ω ≼ 𝐴)) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | pets2eq 39298 | Grade-stable generalized partition-equivalence identification. After applying the same grade-stability operator (SucMap ShiftStable) to both sides, the grade-stable pet classes still coincide. Confirms that the grade/tower infrastructure is orthogonal to the partition-vs-equivalence viewpoint: stability is preserved under the PetParts = PetErs identification. This is the level at which we can freely work on whichever side is more convenient (Parts for block discipline, Ers for equivalence reasoning), without changing the stable notion of "pet". (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Pet2Parts = Pet2Ers | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | petseq 39297 |
Generalized partition-equivalence identification.
The partition-side scheme PetParts and the equivalence-side scheme PetErs define the same class of spans (pairs 〈𝑟, 𝑛〉). This plays the same organizational role for lifted spans that mpets 39277 plays for carriers: mpets 39277 identifies MembParts with CoMembErs at the membership-carrier level, while petseq 39297 identifies the corresponding span-level predicates built from Parts and Ers. Unlike the earlier broad pets 39287, the bridge used here is the type-safe span theorem typesafepets 39296, which restricts to membership block-carriers. Since typedness (𝑟 ∈ Rels and the appropriate carrier condition) is now built directly into PetParts and PetErs, this theorem can be used downstream without repeatedly re-establishing basic typing premises. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ PetParts = PetErs | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | typesafepets 39296 | Type-safe pets 39287 scheme. On a membership block-carrier 𝐴 ∈ MembParts, the lifted span (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) yields a generalized partition of 𝐴 iff its coset relation yields an equivalence relation on the same carrier 𝐴. This is the type-safe replacement for the earlier broad pets 39287: it explicitly restricts to carriers where 𝐴 is already known to be a block-family (by MembParts). That removes the standard type-safety objection ("are you equating a quotient-carrier of blocks with raw witnesses?") by construction. It is the key bridge used to identify the partition-side and equivalence-side pet classes (petseq 39297), in complete parallel with the membership bridge mpets 39277. This theorem is intentionally not the definition of PetParts; it is the bridge used by petseq 39297 after typedness is enforced by the "Pet*" definitions. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ MembParts ∧ 𝑅 ∈ 𝑉) → ((𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) Parts 𝐴 ↔ ≀ (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) Ers 𝐴)) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | df-pet2ers 39292 | Define the class of grade- and blocklift-stable equivalence-side general partition-equivalence spans. The equivalence-side analogue of Pet2Parts: stability of PetErs under one-step grade shift along SucMap. Ensures that the equivalence-side formulation supports the same tower/grade infrastructure as the partition-side formulation. SucMap ShiftStable is the grade axis and does not change the equivalence-vs-partition viewpoint (reinforced by pets2eq 39298). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Pet2Ers = ( SucMap ShiftStable PetErs ) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | df-pet2parts 39291 | Define the class of grade- and blocklift-stable partition-side general partition-equivalence spans. It consists of those 〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∈ PetParts such that 〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 remains in PetParts after shifting one grade along SucMap (via ShiftStable). Concretely: 〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∈ PetParts and there exists a predecessor 𝑚 with suc 𝑚 = 𝑛 such that 〈𝑟, 𝑚〉 ∈ PetParts (encoded by SucMap ∘ PetParts inside ShiftStable). I.e., it introduces the external (tower/grade) stability axis. This is the "4th level" for pet 39286 (see dfpet2parts2 39294): beyond (i) carrier membership partition, (ii) disjointness, and (iii) semantic equilibrium, we require (iv) stability under a canonical grade shift. PetParts already enforces disjointness and the quotient-carrier equation for the lifted span (hence semantic equilibrium via dfpetparts2 39293). Pet2Parts adds the external grade (tower) stability axis via df-shiftstable 38803 with SucMap. This (iv) is why we need explicit second-level Pet2Parts, while Disjs typically does not: Disjs already packages its own internal two-step consistency (carrier + map) by dfdisjs6 39263 / dfdisjs7 39264, whereas pet 39286 has an additional grade axis that must be imposed separately. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Pet2Parts = ( SucMap ShiftStable PetParts ) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | shiftstableeq2 38804 | Equality theorem for shift-stability of two classes. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐹 = 𝐺 → (𝑆 ShiftStable 𝐹) = (𝑆 ShiftStable 𝐺)) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | ecqmap2 38771 | Fiber of QMap equals singleton quotient: a conceptual bridge between "map fibers" and quotients. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ dom 𝑅 → [𝐴] QMap 𝑅 = ({𝐴} / 𝑅)) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | bj-dfsbc 36946 | Proof of df-sbc 3729 when taking bj-df-sb 36944 as definition. (Contributed by BJ, 19-Feb-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ {𝑥 ∣ 𝜑} ↔ [𝐴 / 𝑥]𝜑) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | bj-sbcex 36945 | Proof of sbcex 3738 when taking bj-df-sb 36944 as definition. (Contributed by BJ, 19-Feb-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ([𝐴 / 𝑥]𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ V) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | bj-df-sb 36944 | Proposed definition to replace df-sb 2069 and df-sbc 3729. Proof is therefore unimportant. Contrary to df-sb 2069, this definition makes a substituted formula false when one substitutes a non-existent object for a variable: this is better suited to the "Levy-style" treatment of classes as virtual objects adopted by set.mm. That difference is unimportant since as soon as ax6ev 1971 is posited, all variables "exist". (Contributed by BJ, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ([𝐴 / 𝑥]𝜑 ↔ ∃𝑦(𝑦 = 𝐴 ∧ ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → 𝜑))) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | renod 28485 | A surreal real is a surreal number. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝs) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | reno 28484 | A surreal real is a surreal number. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℝs → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | oldfib 28369 | The old set of an ordinal is finite iff the ordinal is finite. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ On → (𝐴 ∈ ω ↔ ( O ‘𝐴) ∈ Fin)) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | ordfin 9150 | A generalization of onfin 9149 to include the class of all ordinals. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (Ord 𝐴 → (𝐴 ∈ Fin ↔ 𝐴 ∈ ω)) | ||
| 18-Feb-2026 | suceldisj 39139 | Disjointness of successor enforces element-carrier separation: If 𝐵 is the successor of 𝐴 and 𝐵 is element-disjoint as a family, then no element of 𝐴 can itself be a member of 𝐴 (equivalently, every 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 has empty intersection with the carrier 𝐴). Provides a clean bridge between "disjoint family at the next grade" and "no block contains a block of the same family" at the previous grade: MembPart alone does not enforce this, see dfmembpart2 39194 (it gives disjoint blocks and excludes the empty block, but does not prevent 𝑢 ∈ 𝑚 from also being a member of the carrier 𝑚). This lemma is used to justify when grade-stability (via successor-shift) supplies the extra separation axioms needed in roof/root-style carrier reasoning. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 18-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ ElDisj 𝐵 ∧ suc 𝐴 = 𝐵) → ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 (𝑥 ∩ 𝐴) = ∅) | ||
| 18-Feb-2026 | wl-eujustlem1 37913 | Version of cbvexvw 2039 with references to ax-6 1969 listed as antecedents. (Contributed by Wolf Lammen, 18-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝑦 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓)) ⇒ ⊢ ((∀𝑦∃𝑥 𝑥 = 𝑦 ∧ ∀𝑥∃𝑦 𝑥 = 𝑦) → (∃𝑥𝜑 ↔ ∃𝑦𝜓)) | ||
| 18-Feb-2026 | noinfepregs 35277 | There are no infinite descending ∈-chains, proven using ax-regs 35270. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 18-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑥 ∈ ω (𝐹‘suc 𝑥) ∉ (𝐹‘𝑥) | ||
| 18-Feb-2026 | noinfepfnregs 35276 | There are no infinite descending ∈-chains, proven using ax-regs 35270. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 18-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐹 Fn ω → ∃𝑥 ∈ ω (𝐹‘suc 𝑥) ∉ (𝐹‘𝑥)) | ||
| 18-Feb-2026 | fineqvinfep 35269 | A counterexample demonstrating that tz9.1 9650 does not hold when all sets are finite and an infinite descending ∈-chain exists. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 18-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐴 = {(𝐹‘∅)} ⇒ ⊢ ((Fin = V ∧ 𝐹:ω–1-1→V ∧ ∀𝑥 ∈ ω (𝐹‘suc 𝑥) ∈ (𝐹‘𝑥)) → ¬ ∃𝑦(𝐴 ⊆ 𝑦 ∧ Tr 𝑦)) | ||
| 18-Feb-2026 | 1reno 28489 | Surreal one is a surreal real. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 18-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 1s ∈ ℝs | ||
| 16-Feb-2026 | dfdisjs7 39264 | Alternate definition of the class of disjoints (via carrier disjointness + unique representatives). Ideology-free normal form of dfdisjs6 39263: "blocks cover their elements" (∃*) and "each block has a unique generator" (∃!), expressed entirely at the quotient-carrier level. Same class as dfdisjs6 39263, but presented in fully expanded ∃* / ∃! form over the quotient-carrier (dom 𝑟 / 𝑟). Makes explicit (a) element-disjointness of the quotient-carrier and (b) unique representative existence for each block. These are exactly the two conditions that rule out type-confusions (blocks vs witnesses) and ensure canonical decomposition. This is the form that best supports analogy arguments with df-petparts 39289 and with successor-style uniqueness patterns. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 16-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Disjs = {𝑟 ∈ Rels ∣ (∀𝑥∃*𝑢 ∈ (dom 𝑟 / 𝑟)𝑥 ∈ 𝑢 ∧ ∀𝑢 ∈ (dom 𝑟 / 𝑟)∃!𝑡 ∈ dom 𝑟 𝑢 = [𝑡]𝑟)} | ||
| 16-Feb-2026 | dfdisjs6 39263 | Alternate definition of the class of disjoints (via quotient-map stability). Disjs is the class of relations 𝑟 whose quotient-map QMap 𝑟 is again disjoint and whose induced quotient-carrier is element-disjoint. This is the definitional "stability-by-decomposition" packaging of disjointness: it builds Disjs from two internal layers (i) a carrier-layer constraint and (ii) a map-layer closure constraint. This is deliberately different from "u R x" style definitions: it makes the carrier of blocks and the uniqueness-of-representatives discipline first-class and reusable (via QMap) rather than implicit. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 16-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Disjs = {𝑟 ∈ Rels ∣ (ran QMap 𝑟 ∈ ElDisjs ∧ QMap 𝑟 ∈ Disjs )} | ||
| 16-Feb-2026 | eldisjs7 39262 |
Elementhood in the class of disjoints. 𝑅 ∈ Disjs iff:
𝑅 ∈ Rels, and every 𝑥 belongs to at most one block 𝑢 in the quotient-carrier (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅) (element-disjointness at the carrier), and every block 𝑢 in the quotient-carrier has a unique representative 𝑡 ∈ dom 𝑅 such that 𝑢 = [𝑡]𝑅. Provides the "fully expanded" quantifier characterization of the same decomposition as eldisjs6 39261, but without explicitly mentioning QMap. This is the "E*/E!"" view that is closest in spirit to suc11reg 9540-style injectivity and to the "unique generator per block" narrative. It is also the right contrast-point to older one-line criteria like dfdisjs4 39117 (the "u R x" style), because it makes the carrier and representation discipline explicit and type-safe. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 16-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ Disjs ↔ (𝑅 ∈ Rels ∧ (∀𝑥∃*𝑢 ∈ (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅)𝑥 ∈ 𝑢 ∧ ∀𝑢 ∈ (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅)∃!𝑡 ∈ dom 𝑅 𝑢 = [𝑡]𝑅))) | ||
| 16-Feb-2026 | eldisjs6 39261 |
Elementhood in the class of disjoints. A relation 𝑅 is in Disjs
iff:
it is relation-typed, and its quotient-map QMap 𝑅 is itself disjoint, and its quotient-carrier ran QMap 𝑅 = (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅) lies in ElDisjs (element-disjoint carriers). This is the central "stability-by-decomposition" theorem for Disjs: it explains why Disjs is internally well-behaved without adding an external stability clause. It is the exact template that PetParts imitates: for pet 39286, the analogue of "map layer" is the disjointness of the lifted span, the analogue of "carrier layer" is the block-lift fixpoint (BlockLiftFix), and then adds external grade stability (SucMap ShiftStable) which Disjs does not need. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 16-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ Disjs ↔ (𝑅 ∈ Rels ∧ (ran QMap 𝑅 ∈ ElDisjs ∧ QMap 𝑅 ∈ Disjs ))) | ||
| 16-Feb-2026 | rnqmapeleldisjsim 39183 | Element-disjointness of the quotient carrier forces coset disjointness. Supplies the "cosets don't overlap unless equal" direction, but expressed via ran QMap 𝑅 (the quotient carrier) and ElDisjs. This is the structural reason Disjs needs a "carrier disjointness" level distinct from the "unique representatives" level. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 16-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ ran QMap 𝑅 ∈ ElDisjs ∧ (𝐴 ∈ dom 𝑅 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ dom 𝑅)) → (([𝐴]𝑅 ∩ [𝐵]𝑅) ≠ ∅ → [𝐴]𝑅 = [𝐵]𝑅)) | ||
| 16-Feb-2026 | qmapeldisjsbi 39182 | Injectivity of coset map from QMap being disjoint (biconditional form). Convenience version of qmapeldisjsim 39181. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 16-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ QMap 𝑅 ∈ Disjs ∧ (𝐴 ∈ dom 𝑅 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ dom 𝑅)) → ([𝐴]𝑅 = [𝐵]𝑅 ↔ 𝐴 = 𝐵)) | ||
| 16-Feb-2026 | qmapeldisjsim 39181 | Injectivity of coset map from QMap being disjoint (implication form): under the Disjs condition on QMap 𝑅, the coset assignment is injective on dom 𝑅. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 16-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ QMap 𝑅 ∈ Disjs ∧ (𝐴 ∈ dom 𝑅 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ dom 𝑅)) → ([𝐴]𝑅 = [𝐵]𝑅 → 𝐴 = 𝐵)) | ||
| 16-Feb-2026 | disjimeceqbi2 39128 | Injectivity of the block constructor under disjointness. suc11reg 9540 analogue: under disjointness, equal blocks force equal generators (on dom 𝑅). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 16-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( Disj 𝑅 → ((𝐴 ∈ dom 𝑅 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ dom 𝑅) → ([𝐴]𝑅 = [𝐵]𝑅 ↔ 𝐴 = 𝐵))) | ||
| 16-Feb-2026 | disjimeceqim2 39126 | Disj implies injectivity (pairwise form). The same content as disjimeceqim 39125 but packaged for direct use with explicit hypotheses (𝐴 ∈ dom 𝑅 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ dom 𝑅). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 16-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( Disj 𝑅 → ((𝐴 ∈ dom 𝑅 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ dom 𝑅) → ([𝐴]𝑅 = [𝐵]𝑅 → 𝐴 = 𝐵))) | ||
| 16-Feb-2026 | falseral0 4454 | A false statement can only be true for elements of an empty set. (Contributed by AV, 30-Oct-2020.) (Proof shortened by TM, 16-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((∀𝑥 ¬ 𝜑 ∧ ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝜑) → 𝐴 = ∅) | ||
| 16-Feb-2026 | r19.3rzv 4443 | Restricted quantification of wff not containing quantified variable. (Contributed by NM, 10-Mar-1997.) Avoid ax-12 2185. (Revised by TM, 16-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ≠ ∅ → (𝜑 ↔ ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝜑)) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | eldisjsim5 39260 | Disjs is closed under QMap. If a relation is "disjoint-structured" (Disjs), then its canonical block map is also "disjoint-structured". This is the second "structure level" in Disjs: it expresses that the property is stable under passing to the canonical block map, a theme that mirrors Pet-grade stability at a different axis. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ Disjs → QMap 𝑅 ∈ Disjs ) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | eldisjsim4 39259 | Disjs implies element-disjoint range of QMap. Same as eldisjsim3 39258 but expressed using the block-map range ran QMap 𝑅 (often the more modular expression). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ Disjs → ran QMap 𝑅 ∈ ElDisjs ) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | vieta 33724 | Vieta's Formulas: Coefficients of a monic polynomial 𝐹 expressed as a product of linear polynomials of the form 𝑋 − 𝑍 can be expressed in terms of elementary symmetric polynomials. The formulas appear in Chapter 6 of [Lang], p. 190. Theorem vieta1 26278 is a special case for the complex numbers, for the case 𝐾 = 1. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑊 = (Poly1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ − = (-g‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (mulGrp‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐼 eval 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (𝐼eSymPoly𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (invg‘𝑅) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑋 = (var1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (algSc‘𝑊) & ⊢ ↑ = (.g‘(mulGrp‘𝑅)) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (♯‘𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ IDomn) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍:𝐼⟶𝐵) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑀 Σg (𝑛 ∈ 𝐼 ↦ (𝑋 − (𝐴‘(𝑍‘𝑛))))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (0...𝐻)) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (coe1‘𝐹) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐶‘(𝐻 − 𝐾)) = ((𝐾 ↑ (𝑁‘ 1 )) · ((𝑄‘(𝐸‘𝐾))‘𝑍))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | vietalem 33723 | Lemma for vieta 33724: induction step. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑊 = (Poly1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ − = (-g‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (mulGrp‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐼 eval 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (𝐼eSymPoly𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (invg‘𝑅) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑋 = (var1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (algSc‘𝑊) & ⊢ ↑ = (.g‘(mulGrp‘𝑅)) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (♯‘𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ IDomn) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍:𝐼⟶𝐵) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑀 Σg (𝑛 ∈ 𝐼 ↦ (𝑋 − (𝐴‘(𝑍‘𝑛))))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (0...𝐻)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝑌}) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑧 ∈ (𝐵 ↑m 𝐽)∀𝑘 ∈ (0...(♯‘𝐽))((coe1‘(𝑀 Σg (𝑛 ∈ 𝐽 ↦ (𝑋 − (𝐴‘(𝑧‘𝑛))))))‘((♯‘𝐽) − 𝑘)) = ((𝑘 ↑ (𝑁‘ 1 )) · (((𝐽 eval 𝑅)‘((𝐽eSymPoly𝑅)‘𝑘))‘𝑧))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((deg1‘𝑅)‘(𝑀 Σg (𝑛 ∈ 𝐽 ↦ (𝑋 − (𝐴‘((𝑍 ↾ 𝐽)‘𝑛)))))) = (♯‘𝐽)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((coe1‘𝐹)‘𝐾) = (((𝐻 − 𝐾) ↑ (𝑁‘ 1 )) · ((𝑄‘(𝐸‘(𝐻 − 𝐾)))‘𝑍))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | vietadeg1 33722 | The degree of a product of 𝐻 of linear polynomials of the form 𝑋 − 𝑍 is 𝐻. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑊 = (Poly1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ − = (-g‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (mulGrp‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐼 eval 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (𝐼eSymPoly𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (invg‘𝑅) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑋 = (var1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (algSc‘𝑊) & ⊢ ↑ = (.g‘(mulGrp‘𝑅)) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (♯‘𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ IDomn) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍:𝐼⟶𝐵) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑀 Σg (𝑛 ∈ 𝐼 ↦ (𝑋 − (𝐴‘(𝑍‘𝑛))))) & ⊢ 𝐷 = (deg1‘𝑅) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐷‘𝐹) = 𝐻) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | esplyfvn 33721 | Express the last elementary symmetric polynomial, evaluated at a given set of points 𝑍, in terms of the last elementary symmetric polynomial with one less variable. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝑅) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐼 eval 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑂 = (𝐽 eval 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (𝐼eSymPoly𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝐽eSymPoly𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (♯‘𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐾 = (♯‘𝐽) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝑌}) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍:𝐼⟶𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑄‘(𝐸‘𝐻))‘𝑍) = ((𝑍‘𝑌) · ((𝑂‘(𝐹‘𝐾))‘(𝑍 ↾ 𝐽)))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | esplyindfv 33720 | A recursive formula for the elementary symmetric polynomials, evaluated at a given set of points 𝑍. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝑌}) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (𝐽eSymPoly𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (0...(♯‘𝐽))) & ⊢ 𝐶 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐽) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ 𝐹 = ((𝐼eSymPoly𝑅)‘(𝐾 + 1)) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐼 eval 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑂 = (𝐽 eval 𝑅) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍:𝐼⟶𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑄‘𝐹)‘𝑍) = (((𝑍‘𝑌) · ((𝑂‘(𝐸‘𝐾))‘(𝑍 ↾ 𝐽))) + ((𝑂‘(𝐸‘(𝐾 + 1)))‘(𝑍 ↾ 𝐽)))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | esplyfval0 33708 | The 0-th elementary symmetric polynomial is the constant 1. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ 𝑈 = (1r‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐼eSymPoly𝑅)‘0) = 𝑈) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | evlextv 33686 | Evaluating a variable-extended polynomial is the same as evaluating the polynomial in the original set of variables (in both cases, the additionial variable is ignored). (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐼 eval 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑂 = (𝐽 eval 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝑌}) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐽 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (𝐼extendVars𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑀) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴:𝐼⟶𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑄‘((𝐸‘𝑌)‘𝐹))‘𝐴) = ((𝑂‘𝐹)‘(𝐴 ↾ 𝐽))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | evlvarval 33685 | Polynomial evaluation builder for a variable. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐼 eval 𝑆) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑆) & ⊢ 𝐾 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ ∙ = (.r‘𝑃) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑍) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑆 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝐾 ↑m 𝐼)) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (𝐼 mVar 𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐼) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑉‘𝑋) ∈ 𝐵 ∧ ((𝑄‘(𝑉‘𝑋))‘𝐴) = (𝐴‘𝑋))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | evlscaval 33684 | Polynomial evaluation for scalars. See evlsscaval 43000. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐼 eval 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑊 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (algSc‘𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐿:𝐼⟶𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑄‘(𝐴‘𝑋))‘𝐿) = 𝑋) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | gsummoncoe1fz 33658 | A coefficient of the polynomial represented as a sum of scaled monomials is the coefficient of the corresponding scaled monomial. See gsummoncoe1fzo 33657. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑃 = (Poly1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑋 = (var1‘𝑅) & ⊢ ↑ = (.g‘(mulGrp‘𝑃)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ 𝐾 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ ∗ = ( ·𝑠 ‘𝑃) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑘 ∈ (0...𝐷)𝐴 ∈ 𝐾) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐿 ∈ (0...𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝑘 = 𝐿 → 𝐴 = 𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((coe1‘(𝑃 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (0...𝐷) ↦ (𝐴 ∗ (𝑘 ↑ 𝑋)))))‘𝐿) = 𝐶) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | ply1coedeg 33649 | Decompose a univariate polynomial 𝐾 as a sum of powers, up to its degree 𝐷. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑃 = (Poly1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑋 = (var1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ · = ( ·𝑠 ‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (mulGrp‘𝑃) & ⊢ ↑ = (.g‘𝑀) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (coe1‘𝐾) & ⊢ 𝐷 = ((deg1‘𝑅)‘𝐾) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 = (𝑃 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (0...𝐷) ↦ ((𝐴‘𝑘) · (𝑘 ↑ 𝑋))))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | deg1prod 33643 | Degree of a product of polynomials. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = (deg1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Poly1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (mulGrp‘𝑃) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑃) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ IDomn) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝐴⟶(𝐵 ∖ { 0 })) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐷‘(𝑀 Σg 𝐹)) = Σ𝑘 ∈ 𝐴 (𝐷‘(𝐹‘𝑘))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | assaassrd 33616 | Right-associative property of an associative algebra, deduction version. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑉 = (Base‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (Scalar‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐹) & ⊢ · = ( ·𝑠 ‘𝑊) & ⊢ × = (.r‘𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑊 ∈ AssAlg) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 × (𝐴 · 𝑌)) = (𝐴 · (𝑋 × 𝑌))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | assaassd 33615 | Left-associative property of an associative algebra, deduction version. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑉 = (Base‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (Scalar‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐹) & ⊢ · = ( ·𝑠 ‘𝑊) & ⊢ × = (.r‘𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑊 ∈ AssAlg) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 · 𝑋) × 𝑌) = (𝐴 · (𝑋 × 𝑌))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | domnprodeq0 33337 | A product over a domain is zero exactly when one of the factors is zero. Generalization of domneq0 20685 for any number of factors. See also domnprodn0 33336. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑀 = (mulGrp‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ IDomn) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝐴⟶𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑀 Σg 𝐹) = 0 ↔ 0 ∈ ran 𝐹)) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | ringm1expp1 33295 | Ring exponentiation of minus one: Adding one to the exponent is the same as taking the additive inverse. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (invg‘𝑅) & ⊢ ↑ = (.g‘(mulGrp‘𝑅)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ℕ0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐾 + 1) ↑ (𝑁‘ 1 )) = (𝑁‘(𝐾 ↑ (𝑁‘ 1 )))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | ringrngd 33290 | A unital ring is a non-unital ring, deduction version. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Rng) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | gsummulsubdishift2s 33132 | Distribute a subtraction over an indexed sum, shift one of the resulting sums, and regroup terms. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝑅) & ⊢ − = (-g‘𝑅) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑖 ∈ (0...𝑁)) → 𝑉 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝑖 = 0 → 𝑉 = 𝐺) & ⊢ (𝑖 = 𝑁 → 𝑉 = 𝐻) & ⊢ (𝑖 = 𝑘 → 𝑉 = 𝑃) & ⊢ (𝑖 = (𝑘 + 1) → 𝑉 = 𝑄) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 = ((𝐺 · 𝐴) − (𝐻 · 𝐶))) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑘 ∈ (0..^𝑁)) → 𝐹 = ((𝑄 · 𝐴) − (𝑃 · 𝐶))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑅 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (0...𝑁) ↦ 𝑃)) · (𝐴 − 𝐶)) = ((𝑅 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (0..^𝑁) ↦ 𝐹)) + 𝐸)) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | gsummulsubdishift1s 33131 | Distribute a subtraction over an indexed sum, shift one of the resulting sums, and regroup terms. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝑅) & ⊢ − = (-g‘𝑅) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑖 ∈ (0...𝑁)) → 𝑉 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝑖 = 0 → 𝑉 = 𝐺) & ⊢ (𝑖 = 𝑁 → 𝑉 = 𝐻) & ⊢ (𝑖 = 𝑘 → 𝑉 = 𝑃) & ⊢ (𝑖 = (𝑘 + 1) → 𝑉 = 𝑄) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 = ((𝐻 · 𝐴) − (𝐺 · 𝐶))) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑘 ∈ (0..^𝑁)) → 𝐹 = ((𝑃 · 𝐴) − (𝑄 · 𝐶))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑅 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (0...𝑁) ↦ 𝑃)) · (𝐴 − 𝐶)) = ((𝑅 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (0..^𝑁) ↦ 𝐹)) + 𝐸)) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | gsummulsubdishift2 33130 | Distribute a subtraction over an indexed sum, shift one of the resulting sums, and regroup terms. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝑅) & ⊢ − = (-g‘𝑅) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷:(0...𝑁)⟶𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 = (((𝐷‘0) · 𝐴) − ((𝐷‘𝑁) · 𝐶))) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑘 ∈ (0..^𝑁)) → 𝐹 = (((𝐷‘(𝑘 + 1)) · 𝐴) − ((𝐷‘𝑘) · 𝐶))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑅 Σg 𝐷) · (𝐴 − 𝐶)) = ((𝑅 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (0..^𝑁) ↦ 𝐹)) + 𝐸)) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | gsummulsubdishift1 33129 | Distribute a subtraction over an indexed sum, shift one of the resulting sums, and regroup terms. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝑅) & ⊢ − = (-g‘𝑅) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷:(0...𝑁)⟶𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 = (((𝐷‘𝑁) · 𝐴) − ((𝐷‘0) · 𝐶))) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑘 ∈ (0..^𝑁)) → 𝐹 = (((𝐷‘𝑘) · 𝐴) − ((𝐷‘(𝑘 + 1)) · 𝐶))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑅 Σg 𝐷) · (𝐴 − 𝐶)) = ((𝑅 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (0..^𝑁) ↦ 𝐹)) + 𝐸)) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | gsummptfzsplitla 33120 | Split a group sum expressed as mapping with a finite set of sequential integers as domain into two parts, extracting a singleton from the left. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ CMnd) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘𝑀)) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑘 ∈ (𝑀...𝑁)) → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑘 = 𝑀) → 𝑌 = 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (𝑀...𝑁) ↦ 𝑌)) = (𝑋 + (𝐺 Σg (𝑘 ∈ ((𝑀 + 1)...𝑁) ↦ 𝑌)))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | gsummptfzsplitra 33119 | Split a group sum expressed as mapping with a finite set of sequential integers as domain into two parts, extracting a singleton from the right. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ CMnd) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘𝑀)) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑘 ∈ (𝑀...𝑁)) → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑘 = 𝑁) → 𝑌 = 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (𝑀...𝑁) ↦ 𝑌)) = ((𝐺 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (𝑀..^𝑁) ↦ 𝑌)) + 𝑋)) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | gsummptp1 33118 | Reindex a zero-based sum as a one-base sum. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CMnd) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑙 ∈ (1...𝑁)) → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (((𝜑 ∧ 𝑘 ∈ (0..^𝑁)) ∧ 𝑙 = (𝑘 + 1)) → 𝑌 = 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑅 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (0..^𝑁) ↦ 𝑋)) = (𝑅 Σg (𝑙 ∈ (1...𝑁) ↦ 𝑌))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | gsummptrev 33117 | Revert ordering in a group sum. See also gsumwrev 19341. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑀) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 ∈ CMnd) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑘 ∈ (0...𝑁)) → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (((𝜑 ∧ 𝑙 ∈ (0...𝑁)) ∧ 𝑘 = (𝑁 − 𝑙)) → 𝑋 = 𝑌) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑀 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (0...𝑁) ↦ 𝑋)) = (𝑀 Σg (𝑙 ∈ (0...𝑁) ↦ 𝑌))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | gsummptfsres 33115 | Extend a finitely supported group sum by padding outside with zeroes. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ CMnd) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 ∈ (𝐴 ∖ 𝑆)) → 𝑌 = 0 ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ↦ 𝑌) finSupp 0 ) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴) → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑆 ⊆ 𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 Σg (𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ↦ 𝑌)) = (𝐺 Σg (𝑥 ∈ 𝑆 ↦ 𝑌))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | ablcomd 33106 | An abelian group operation is commutative, deduction version. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ Abel) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 + 𝑌) = (𝑌 + 𝑋)) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | grpinvinvd 33100 | Double inverse law for groups. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (invg‘𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ Grp) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑁‘(𝑁‘𝑋)) = 𝑋) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | indsn 32923 | The indicator function of a singleton. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑂 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝑋 ∈ 𝑂) → ((𝟭‘𝑂)‘{𝑋}) = (𝑥 ∈ 𝑂 ↦ if(𝑥 = 𝑋, 1, 0))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | nn0mnfxrd 32824 | Nonnegative integers or minus infinity are extended real numbers. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (ℕ0 ∪ {-∞})) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ*) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | fresunsn 32698 | Recover the original function from a point-added function. See also funresdfunsn 7144 and fsnunres 7143. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐹 Fn 𝐴 ∧ 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ (𝐹‘𝑋) = 𝑌) → ((𝐹 ↾ (𝐴 ∖ {𝑋})) ∪ {〈𝑋, 𝑌〉}) = 𝐹) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | dfmo 2540 | Simplify definition df-mo 2539 by removing its provable hypothesis. (Contributed by Wolf Lammen, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∃*𝑥𝜑 ↔ ∃𝑦∀𝑥(𝜑 → 𝑥 = 𝑦)) | ||
| 14-Feb-2026 | dmqmap 38774 | QMap preserves the domain. Confirms that QMap is defined exactly on the points where cosets [𝑥]𝑅 make sense (those in dom 𝑅). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 14-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 → dom QMap 𝑅 = dom 𝑅) | ||
| 14-Feb-2026 | ecqmap 38770 | QMap fibers are singletons of blocks. Makes QMap behave like a "block constructor function" on dom 𝑅. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 14-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ dom 𝑅 → [𝐴] QMap 𝑅 = {[𝐴]𝑅}) | ||
| 14-Feb-2026 | dfqmap3 38769 | Alternate definition of the quotient map: QMap as ordered-pair class abstraction. Gives the raw set-builder characterization for extensional proofs, Rel proofs (relqmap 38773), and composition/intersection manipulations. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 14-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ QMap 𝑅 = {〈𝑥, 𝑦〉 ∣ (𝑥 ∈ dom 𝑅 ∧ 𝑦 = [𝑥]𝑅)} | ||
| 14-Feb-2026 | dfqmap2 38768 | Alternate definition of the quotient map: QMap in image-of-singleton form. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 14-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ QMap 𝑅 = (𝑥 ∈ dom 𝑅 ↦ (𝑅 “ {𝑥})) | ||
| 12-Feb-2026 | disjqmap 39148 | Disjointness of QMap equals unique generation of the quotient carrier. The cleaned, carrier-respecting version of disjqmap2 39147. This is the statement "each equivalence class has a unique representative" for the general coset carrier (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 → ( Disj QMap 𝑅 ↔ ∀𝑢 ∈ (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅)∃!𝑡 ∈ dom 𝑅 𝑢 = [𝑡]𝑅)) | ||
| 12-Feb-2026 | disjqmap2 39147 | Disjointness of QMap equals ∃*-generation. Pairs with disjqmap 39148 and raldmqseu 38686 to move between ∃* and ∃! depending on context. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 → ( Disj QMap 𝑅 ↔ ∀𝑢∃*𝑡 ∈ dom 𝑅 𝑢 = [𝑡]𝑅)) | ||
| 12-Feb-2026 | qmapeldisjs 39146 | When 𝑅 is a set (e.g., when it is an element of the class of relations df-rels 38761), the quotient map element of the class of disjoint relations and the disjoint relation predicate for quotient maps are the same. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 → ( QMap 𝑅 ∈ Disjs ↔ Disj QMap 𝑅)) | ||
| 12-Feb-2026 | rnqmap 38775 | The range of the quotient map is the quotient carrier. It lets us replace quotient-carrier reasoning by map/range reasoning (and conversely) via df-qmap 38767 and dfqs2 8650. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ran QMap 𝑅 = (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅) | ||
| 12-Feb-2026 | relqmap 38773 | Quotient map is a relation. Guarantees that QMap can be composed, restricted, and used in other relation infrastructure (e.g., membership in Disjs, Rels-based typing). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Rel QMap 𝑅 | ||
| 12-Feb-2026 | qmapex 38772 | Quotient map exists if 𝑅 exists. Type-safety: ensures QMap is a set under the standard "relation sethood" hypothesis. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 → QMap 𝑅 ∈ V) | ||
| 12-Feb-2026 | df-qmap 38767 |
Define the quotient map (coset map), see also dfqmap2 38768 and dfqmap3 38769.
QMap 𝑅 is the "send a generator /
domain element to its 𝑅
-coset" map: it maps each 𝑥 ∈ dom 𝑅 to the block [𝑥]𝑅.
Makes the quotient operation /
structurally explicit as the range
of a canonical map (see dfqs2 8650, rnqmap 38775). This is crucial for
(i) modular "two-layer" characterizations (map layer + carrier layer) such as dfdisjs6 39263 / dfdisjs7 39264, (ii) transport of properties between a relation and its induced quotient-carrier (e.g. "elements are blocks" via rnqmap 38775), and (iii) expressing stability/invariance constraints as ordinary conditions on a graph (e.g. ran QMap 𝑟 ∈ ElDisjs, QMap 𝑟 ∈ Disjs). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ QMap 𝑅 = (𝑥 ∈ dom 𝑅 ↦ [𝑥]𝑅) | ||
| 11-Feb-2026 | nfale2 42655 | An inner existential quantifier's variable is bound. (Contributed by SN, 11-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥∀𝑦∃𝑥𝜑 | ||
| 11-Feb-2026 | nfe2 42654 | An inner existential quantifier's variable is bound. (Contributed by SN, 11-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥∃𝑦∃𝑥𝜑 | ||
| 11-Feb-2026 | nfalh 42653 | Version of nfal 2328 with an 'h' hypothesis, avoiding ax-12 2185. (Contributed by SN, 11-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) ⇒ ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥∀𝑦𝜑 | ||
| 11-Feb-2026 | eldisjsim3 39258 | Disjs implies element-disjoint quotient carrier. Exports the carrier-disjointness property in the ElDisjs packaging. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 11-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ Disjs → (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅) ∈ ElDisjs ) | ||
| 11-Feb-2026 | disjsssrels 39257 | The class of disjoint relations is a subclass of the class of relations. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 11-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Disjs ⊆ Rels | ||
| 11-Feb-2026 | eldisjsim2 39256 | An element of the class of disjoint relations is an element of the class of relations. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 11-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ Disjs → 𝑅 ∈ Rels ) | ||
| 11-Feb-2026 | eldisjsim1 39255 | An element of the class of disjoint relations is disjoint. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 11-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ Disjs → Disj 𝑅) | ||
| 11-Feb-2026 | nfexa2 2184 | An inner universal quantifier's variable is bound. (Contributed by SN, 11-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥∃𝑦∀𝑥𝜑 | ||
| 11-Feb-2026 | nfexhe 2183 | Version of nfex 2329 with the existential dual to the 'h' hypothesis, avoiding ax-12 2185. (Contributed by SN, 11-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 → 𝜑) ⇒ ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥∃𝑦𝜑 | ||
| 10-Feb-2026 | eldisjdmqsim 39138 | Shared output implies equal cosets (under ElDisj of quotient): if 𝑢 and 𝑣 both relate to the same 𝑥, then their cosets intersect, hence must coincide under quotient ElDisj. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 10-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (( ElDisj (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅) ∧ 𝑅 ∈ Rels ) → ((𝑢𝑅𝑥 ∧ 𝑣𝑅𝑥) → [𝑢]𝑅 = [𝑣]𝑅)) | ||
| 10-Feb-2026 | eldisjdmqsim2 39137 | ElDisj of quotient implies coset-disjointness (domain form). Converts element-disjointness of the quotient carrier into a usable "cosets don't overlap unless equal" rule. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 10-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (( ElDisj (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅) ∧ 𝑅 ∈ Rels ) → ((𝑢 ∈ dom 𝑅 ∧ 𝑣 ∈ dom 𝑅) → (([𝑢]𝑅 ∩ [𝑣]𝑅) ≠ ∅ → [𝑢]𝑅 = [𝑣]𝑅))) | ||
| 10-Feb-2026 | enssdom 8923 | Equinumerosity implies dominance. (Contributed by NM, 31-Mar-1998.) (Proof shortened by TM, 10-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ≈ ⊆ ≼ | ||
| 10-Feb-2026 | f1oi 6818 | A restriction of the identity relation is a one-to-one onto function. (Contributed by NM, 30-Apr-1998.) (Proof shortened by Andrew Salmon, 22-Oct-2011.) Avoid ax-12 2185. (Revised by TM, 10-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( I ↾ 𝐴):𝐴–1-1-onto→𝐴 | ||
| 9-Feb-2026 | rsp3eq 38688 | From a restricted universal statement over 𝐴, specialize to an arbitrary element class, cf. rsp3 38687. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 9-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥𝐴 & ⊢ Ⅎ𝑦𝐴 & ⊢ Ⅎ𝑦𝜑 & ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥𝜓 & ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝑦 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓)) ⇒ ⊢ (∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝜑 → ((𝑦 = 𝐵 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝐴) → 𝜓)) | ||
| 9-Feb-2026 | rsp3 38687 | From a restricted universal statement over 𝐴, specialize to an arbitrary element 𝑦 ∈ 𝐴, cf. rsp 3225. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 9-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥𝐴 & ⊢ Ⅎ𝑦𝐴 & ⊢ Ⅎ𝑦𝜑 & ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥𝜓 & ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝑦 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓)) ⇒ ⊢ (∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝜑 → (𝑦 ∈ 𝐴 → 𝜓)) | ||
| 6-Feb-2026 | eldisjim3 39136 | ElDisj elimination (two chosen elements). Standard specialization lemma: from ElDisj 𝐴 infer the disjointness condition for two specific elements. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 6-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( ElDisj 𝐴 → ((𝐵 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ 𝐶 ∈ 𝐴) → ((𝐵 ∩ 𝐶) ≠ ∅ → 𝐵 = 𝐶))) | ||
| 6-Feb-2026 | raldmqseu 38686 | Equivalence between "exactly one" on the quotient carrier and "at most one" globally. Provides a type-safe way to talk about unique representatives either as ∃! on the intended carrier or as a global ∃* statement. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 6-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 → (∀𝑢 ∈ (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅)∃!𝑡 ∈ dom 𝑅 𝑢 = [𝑡]𝑅 ↔ ∀𝑢∃*𝑡 ∈ dom 𝑅 𝑢 = [𝑡]𝑅)) | ||
| 6-Feb-2026 | raldmqsmo 38684 | On the quotient carrier, "at most one" and "exactly one" coincide for coset witnesses. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 6-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑢 ∈ (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅)∃*𝑡 ∈ dom 𝑅 𝑢 = [𝑡]𝑅 ↔ ∀𝑢 ∈ (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅)∃!𝑡 ∈ dom 𝑅 𝑢 = [𝑡]𝑅) | ||
| 5-Feb-2026 | disjimeldisjdmqs 39254 | Disj implies element-disjoint quotient carrier. Supplies the carrier-disjointness half of the Disjs pattern: under Disj 𝑅, the coset family is element-disjoint. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 5-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( Disj 𝑅 → ElDisj (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅)) | ||
| 5-Feb-2026 | disjimdmqseq 39130 | Disjointness implies unique-generation of quotient blocks. Converts existence-quotient comprehension (see df-qs 8649) into a uniqueness-comprehension under disjointness; rewrites (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅) carriers as exactly the class of blocks with a unique representative. This is the "unique generator per block" content in a carrier-normal form. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 5-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( Disj 𝑅 → (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅) = {𝑡 ∣ ∃!𝑢 ∈ dom 𝑅 𝑡 = [𝑢]𝑅}) | ||
| 5-Feb-2026 | disjimrmoeqec 39129 | Under Disj, every block has a unique generator (∃* form). If 𝑡 is a block in the quotient sense, then there is a uniquely determined 𝑢 in dom 𝑅 such that 𝑡 = [𝑢]𝑅. This is the existence+uniqueness engine behind Disjs and QMap characterizations: it is the "representative theorem" from which the ∃! forms are obtained. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 5-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( Disj 𝑅 → ∃*𝑢 ∈ dom 𝑅 𝑡 = [𝑢]𝑅) | ||
| 5-Feb-2026 | dfsb 2070 | Simplify definition df-sb 2069 by removing its provable hypothesis. (Contributed by Wolf Lammen, 5-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ([𝑡 / 𝑥]𝜑 ↔ ∀𝑦(𝑦 = 𝑡 → ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → 𝜑))) | ||
| 4-Feb-2026 | ss2rabd 4012 | Subclass of a restricted class abstraction (deduction form). Saves ax-10 2147, ax-11 2163, ax-12 2185 over using ss2rab 4009 and sylibr 234. (Contributed by SN, 4-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 (𝜓 → 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → {𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∣ 𝜓} ⊆ {𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∣ 𝜒}) | ||
| 4-Feb-2026 | sbt 2072 | A substitution into a theorem yields a theorem. See sbtALT 2075 for a shorter proof requiring more axioms. See chvar 2399 and chvarv 2400 for versions using implicit substitution. (Contributed by NM, 21-Jan-2004.) (Proof shortened by Andrew Salmon, 25-May-2011.) (Proof shortened by Wolf Lammen, 20-Jul-2018.) Revise df-sb 2069. (Revised by Steven Nguyen, 6-Jul-2023.) Revise df-sb 2069 again. (Revised by Wolf Lammen, 4-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝜑 ⇒ ⊢ [𝑡 / 𝑥]𝜑 | ||
| 4-Feb-2026 | sbtlem 2071 | In the case of sbt 2072, the hypothesis in df-sb 2069 is derivable from propositional axioms and ax-gen 1797 alone. The essential proof step is presented in this lemma. (Contributed by Wolf Lammen, 4-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝜑 ⇒ ⊢ ∀𝑦(𝑦 = 𝑡 → ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → 𝜑)) | ||
| 4-Feb-2026 | df-sb 2069 |
Define proper substitution. For our notation, we use [𝑡 / 𝑥]𝜑
to mean "the wff that results from the proper substitution of 𝑡 for
𝑥 in the wff 𝜑". That is, 𝑡
properly replaces 𝑥.
For example, [𝑡 / 𝑥]𝑧 ∈ 𝑥 is the same as 𝑧 ∈ 𝑡 (when 𝑥
and 𝑧 are distinct), as shown in elsb2 2131.
Our notation was introduced in Haskell B. Curry's Foundations of Mathematical Logic (1977), p. 316 and is frequently used in textbooks of lambda calculus and combinatory logic. This notation improves the common but ambiguous notation, "𝜑(𝑡) is the wff that results when 𝑡 is properly substituted for 𝑥 in 𝜑(𝑥)". For example, if the original 𝜑(𝑥) is 𝑥 = 𝑡, then 𝜑(𝑡) is 𝑡 = 𝑡, from which we obtain that 𝜑(𝑥) is 𝑥 = 𝑥. So what exactly does 𝜑(𝑥) mean? Curry's notation solves this problem. A very similar notation, namely (𝑦 ∣ 𝑥)𝜑, was introduced in Bourbaki's Set Theory (Chapter 1, Description of Formal Mathematic, 1953). In most books, proper substitution has a somewhat complicated recursive definition with multiple cases based on the occurrences of free and bound variables in the wff. Instead, we use a single formula that is exactly equivalent and gives us a direct definition. We later prove that our definition has the properties we expect of proper substitution (see Theorems sbequ 2089, sbcom2 2179 and sbid2v 2513). Note that our definition is valid even when 𝑥 and 𝑡 are replaced with the same variable, as sbid 2263 shows. We achieve this by applying twice Tarski's definition sb6 2091 which is valid for disjoint variables, and introducing a dummy variable 𝑦 which isolates 𝑥 from 𝑡, as in dfsb7 2286 with respect to sb5 2283. We can also achieve this by having 𝑥 free in the first conjunct and bound in the second, as the alternate definition dfsb1 2485 shows. Another version that mixes free and bound variables is dfsb3 2498. When 𝑥 and 𝑡 are distinct, we can express proper substitution with the simpler expressions of sb5 2283 and sb6 2091. Note that the occurrences of a given variable in the definiens are either all bound (𝑥, 𝑦) or all free (𝑡). Also note that the definiens uses only primitive symbols. This double level definition will make several proofs using it appear as doubled. Alternately, one could often first prove as a lemma the same theorem with a disjoint variable condition on the substitute and the substituted variables, and then prove the original theorem by applying this lemma twice in a row. The hypothesis asserts that the definition is independent of the particular choice of the dummy variable 𝑦. Without this hypothesis, sbjust 2067 would be derivable from propositional axioms alone: one could apply the definiens for [𝑡 / 𝑥]𝜑 twice, using different dummy variables 𝑦 and 𝑧, and then invoke bitr3i 277 to establish their equivalence. This would jeopardize the independence of axioms, as demonstrated in an analoguous situation involving df-ss 3906 to prove ax-8 2116 (see in-ax8 36406). Prefer dfsb 2070 unless you can prove the hypothesis from fewer axioms in special cases, see sbt 2072. (Contributed by NM, 10-May-1993.) Revised from the original definition dfsb1 2485. (Revised by BJ, 22-Dec-2020.) Add the justification hypothesis. (Revised by Wolf Lammen, 4-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑦(𝑦 = 𝑡 → ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → 𝜑)) ↔ ∀𝑧(𝑧 = 𝑡 → ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑧 → 𝜑))) ⇒ ⊢ ([𝑡 / 𝑥]𝜑 ↔ ∀𝑦(𝑦 = 𝑡 → ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → 𝜑))) | ||
| 3-Feb-2026 | disjimeceqbi 39127 | Disj gives biconditional injectivity (domain-wise). Strengthens injectivity to an iff. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 3-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( Disj 𝑅 → ∀𝑢 ∈ dom 𝑅∀𝑣 ∈ dom 𝑅([𝑢]𝑅 = [𝑣]𝑅 ↔ 𝑢 = 𝑣)) | ||
| 3-Feb-2026 | disjimeceqim 39125 | Disj implies coset-equality injectivity (domain-wise). Extracts the practical consequence of Disj: the map 𝑢 ↦ [𝑢]𝑅 is injective on dom 𝑅. This is exactly the "canonicity" property used repeatedly when turning ∃* into ∃! and when reasoning about uniqueness of representatives. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 3-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( Disj 𝑅 → ∀𝑢 ∈ dom 𝑅∀𝑣 ∈ dom 𝑅([𝑢]𝑅 = [𝑣]𝑅 → 𝑢 = 𝑣)) | ||
| 3-Feb-2026 | dfdisjALTV5a 39124 | Alternate definition of the disjoint relation predicate. Disj 𝑅 means: different domain generators have disjoint cosets (unless the generators are equal), plus Rel 𝑅 for relation-typedness. This is the characterization that makes canonicity/uniqueness arguments modular. It is the starting point for the entire "Disj ↔ unique representative per block" pipeline that feeds into Disjs, see dfdisjs7 39264. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 3-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( Disj 𝑅 ↔ (∀𝑢 ∈ dom 𝑅∀𝑣 ∈ dom 𝑅(([𝑢]𝑅 ∩ [𝑣]𝑅) ≠ ∅ → 𝑢 = 𝑣) ∧ Rel 𝑅)) | ||
| 2-Feb-2026 | ralrnmo 38682 | On the range, "at most one" becomes "exactly one". (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 27-Sep-2018.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 2-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑥 ∈ ran 𝑅∃*𝑢 𝑢𝑅𝑥 ↔ ∀𝑥 ∈ ran 𝑅∃!𝑢 𝑢𝑅𝑥) | ||
| 2-Feb-2026 | ralmo 38681 | "At most one" can be restricted to the range. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 2-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑥∃*𝑢 𝑢𝑅𝑥 ↔ ∀𝑥 ∈ ran 𝑅∃*𝑢 𝑢𝑅𝑥) | ||
| 2-Feb-2026 | mptelee 28963 | A condition for a mapping to be an element of a Euclidean space. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 7-Jun-2013.) (Proof shortened by SN, 2-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ ℕ → ((𝑘 ∈ (1...𝑁) ↦ (𝐴𝐹𝐵)) ∈ (𝔼‘𝑁) ↔ ∀𝑘 ∈ (1...𝑁)(𝐴𝐹𝐵) ∈ ℝ)) | ||
| 2-Feb-2026 | moabex 5410 | "At most one" existence implies a class abstraction exists. (Contributed by NM, 30-Dec-1996.) Avoid axioms. (Revised by SN, 2-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∃*𝑥𝜑 → {𝑥 ∣ 𝜑} ∈ V) | ||
| 2-Feb-2026 | iunss 4987 | Subset theorem for an indexed union. (Contributed by NM, 13-Sep-2003.) (Proof shortened by Andrew Salmon, 25-Jul-2011.) Avoid ax-10 2147, ax-12 2185. (Revised by SN, 2-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∪ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝐵 ⊆ 𝐶 ↔ ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝐵 ⊆ 𝐶) | ||
| 2-Feb-2026 | iunssf 4985 | Subset theorem for an indexed union. (Contributed by Glauco Siliprandi, 3-Mar-2021.) Avoid ax-10 2147. (Revised by SN, 2-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥𝐶 ⇒ ⊢ (∪ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝐵 ⊆ 𝐶 ↔ ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝐵 ⊆ 𝐶) | ||
| 1-Feb-2026 | xp0 5731 | The Cartesian product with the empty set is empty. Part of Theorem 3.13(ii) of [Monk1] p. 37. (Contributed by NM, 12-Apr-2004.) Avoid axioms. (Revised by TM, 1-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 × ∅) = ∅ | ||
| 1-Feb-2026 | uni0 4878 | The union of the empty set is the empty set. Theorem 8.7 of [Quine] p. 54. (Contributed by NM, 16-Sep-1993.) Remove use of ax-nul 5241. (Revised by Eric Schmidt, 4-Apr-2007.) Avoid ax-11 2163. (Revised by TM, 1-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∪ ∅ = ∅ | ||
| 1-Feb-2026 | rabss2 4017 | Subclass law for restricted abstraction. (Contributed by NM, 18-Dec-2004.) (Proof shortened by Andrew Salmon, 26-Jun-2011.) Avoid axioms. (Revised by TM, 1-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ⊆ 𝐵 → {𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∣ 𝜑} ⊆ {𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 ∣ 𝜑}) | ||
| 1-Feb-2026 | ss2rabdv 4015 | Deduction of restricted abstraction subclass from implication. (Contributed by NM, 30-May-2006.) Avoid axioms. (Revised by TM, 1-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴) → (𝜓 → 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → {𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∣ 𝜓} ⊆ {𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∣ 𝜒}) | ||
| 31-Jan-2026 | cnv0 6103 | The converse of the empty set. (Contributed by NM, 6-Apr-1998.) Remove dependency on ax-sep 5231, ax-nul 5241, ax-pr 5375. (Revised by KP, 25-Oct-2021.) Avoid ax-12 2185. (Revised by TM, 31-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ◡∅ = ∅ | ||
| 30-Jan-2026 | chnsuslle 47311 | Length of a subsequence is bounded by the length of original chain. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 30-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑊 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ ( < Chain (0..^(♯‘𝑊)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → < Po 𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (♯‘(𝑊 ∘ 𝐼)) ≤ (♯‘𝑊)) | ||
| 30-Jan-2026 | dfsuccl4 38795 | Alternate definition that incorporates the most desirable properties of the successor class. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 30-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ Suc = {𝑛 ∣ ∃!𝑚 ∈ 𝑛 (𝑚 ⊆ 𝑛 ∧ suc 𝑚 = 𝑛)} | ||
| 30-Jan-2026 | dfsuccl3 38794 | Alternate definition of the class of all successors. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 30-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ Suc = {𝑛 ∣ ∃!𝑚 suc 𝑚 = 𝑛} | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | nthrucw 47316 | Some number sets form a chain of proper subsets. This is rephrasing nthruc 16219 as a statement about chains; the hypothesis sets the ordering relation to be "is a proper subset". The theorem talks about singleton 1, natural numbers, natural-or-zero numbers, integers, rational numbers, algebraic reals (the definition includes complex numbers as algebraic so intersection is taken), real numbers and complex numbers, which are proper subsets in order. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ < = {〈𝑥, 𝑦〉 ∣ 𝑥 ⊊ 𝑦} ⇒ ⊢ 〈“{1}ℕℕ0ℤℚ(𝔸 ∩ ℝ)ℝℂ”〉 ∈ ( < Chain V) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | chner 47315 | Any two elements are equivalent in a chain constructed on an equivalence relation. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∼ Er 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ( ∼ Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐽 ∈ (0..^(♯‘𝐶))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ (0..^(♯‘𝐶))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐶‘𝐼) ∼ (𝐶‘𝐽)) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | chnerlem3 47314 | Lemma for chner 47315- trichotomy of integers within the word's domain. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∼ Er 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ( ∼ Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐽 ∈ (0..^(♯‘𝐶))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ (0..^(♯‘𝐶))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐼 ∈ (0..^𝐽) ∨ 𝐽 ∈ (0..^𝐼) ∨ 𝐼 = 𝐽)) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | chnerlem2 47313 | Lemma for chner 47315 where the I-th element comes before the J-th. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∼ Er 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ( ∼ Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐽 ∈ (0..^(♯‘𝐶))) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝐼 ∈ (0..^𝐽)) → (𝐶‘𝐼) ∼ (𝐶‘𝐽)) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | chnerlem1 47312 | In a chain constructed on an equivalence relation, the last element is equivalent to any. This theorem is a translation of chnub 18588 to equivalence relations. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∼ Er 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ( ∼ Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐽 ∈ (0..^(♯‘𝐶))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐶‘𝐽) ∼ (lastS‘𝐶)) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | dfsuccl2 38791 | Alternate definition of the class of all successors. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ Suc = {𝑛 ∣ ∃𝑚 suc 𝑚 = 𝑛} | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | dfblockliftmap2 38782 | Alternate definition of the block lift map. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 BlockLiftMap 𝐴) = (𝑚 ∈ (𝐴 ∩ (dom 𝑅 ∖ {∅})) ↦ ([𝑚]𝑅 × 𝑚)) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | dmxrncnvepres2 38754 | Domain of the range product with restricted converse epsilon relation. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ dom (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) = (𝐴 ∩ (dom 𝑅 ∖ {∅})) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | frgr2wwlkeu 30397 | For two different vertices in a friendship graph, there is exactly one third vertex being the middle vertex of a (simple) path/walk of length 2 between the two vertices. (Contributed by Alexander van der Vekens, 18-Feb-2018.) (Revised by AV, 12-May-2021.) (Proof shortened by AV, 4-Jan-2022.) (Revised by Ender Ting, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐺 ∈ FriendGraph ∧ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉) ∧ 𝐴 ≠ 𝐵) → ∃!𝑐 ∈ 𝑉 〈“𝐴𝑐𝐵”〉 ∈ (𝐴(2 WWalksNOn 𝐺)𝐵)) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | usgr2wspthon 30036 | A simple path of length 2 between two vertices corresponds to two adjacent edges in a simple graph. (Contributed by Alexander van der Vekens, 9-Mar-2018.) (Revised by AV, 17-May-2021.) (Revised by Ender Ting, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐺 ∈ USGraph ∧ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉)) → (𝑇 ∈ (𝐴(2 WSPathsNOn 𝐺)𝐶) ↔ ∃𝑏 ∈ 𝑉 ((𝑇 = 〈“𝐴𝑏𝐶”〉 ∧ 𝐴 ≠ 𝐶) ∧ ({𝐴, 𝑏} ∈ 𝐸 ∧ {𝑏, 𝐶} ∈ 𝐸)))) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | usgr2wspthons3 30035 | A simple path of length 2 between two vertices represented as length 3 string corresponds to two adjacent edges in a simple graph. (Contributed by Alexander van der Vekens, 8-Mar-2018.) (Revised by AV, 17-May-2021.) (Proof shortened by AV, 16-Mar-2022.) (Revised by Ender Ting, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐺 ∈ USGraph ∧ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉)) → (〈“𝐴𝐵𝐶”〉 ∈ (𝐴(2 WSPathsNOn 𝐺)𝐶) ↔ (𝐴 ≠ 𝐶 ∧ {𝐴, 𝐵} ∈ 𝐸 ∧ {𝐵, 𝐶} ∈ 𝐸))) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | wpthswwlks2on 30032 | For two different vertices, a walk of length 2 between these vertices is a simple path of length 2 between these vertices in a simple graph. (Contributed by Alexander van der Vekens, 2-Mar-2018.) (Revised by AV, 16-Mar-2022.) (Revised by Ender Ting, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐺 ∈ USGraph ∧ 𝐴 ≠ 𝐵) → (𝐴(2 WSPathsNOn 𝐺)𝐵) = (𝐴(2 WWalksNOn 𝐺)𝐵)) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | elwspths2onw 30031 | A simple path of length 2 between two vertices (in a simple pseudograph) as length 3 string. This theorem avoids the Axiom of Choice for its proof, at the cost of requiring a simple graph; the more general version is elwspths2on 30030. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐺 ∈ USPGraph ∧ 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) → (𝑊 ∈ (𝐴(2 WSPathsNOn 𝐺)𝐶) ↔ ∃𝑏 ∈ 𝑉 (𝑊 = 〈“𝐴𝑏𝐶”〉 ∧ 〈“𝐴𝑏𝐶”〉 ∈ (𝐴(2 WSPathsNOn 𝐺)𝐶)))) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | usgrwwlks2on 30026 | A walk of length 2 between two vertices as word in a simple graph. This theorem is analogous to umgrwwlks2on 30027 except it talks about simple graphs and therefore does not require the Axiom of Choice for its proof. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐺 ∈ USGraph ∧ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉)) → (〈“𝐴𝐵𝐶”〉 ∈ (𝐴(2 WWalksNOn 𝐺)𝐶) ↔ ({𝐴, 𝐵} ∈ 𝐸 ∧ {𝐵, 𝐶} ∈ 𝐸))) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | elreno2 28487 | Alternate characterization of the surreal reals. Theorem 4.4(b) of [Gonshor] p. 39. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℝs ↔ (𝐴 ∈ No ∧ (∃𝑛 ∈ ℕs (( -us ‘𝑛) <s 𝐴 ∧ 𝐴 <s 𝑛) ∧ ∀𝑥𝑂 ∈ (( L ‘𝐴) ∪ ( R ‘𝐴))∃𝑛 ∈ ℕs ( 1s /su 𝑛) ≤s (abss‘(𝐴 -s 𝑥𝑂))))) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | abssubs 28242 | Swapping order of surreal subtraction doesn't change the absolute value. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ No ∧ 𝐵 ∈ No ) → (abss‘(𝐴 -s 𝐵)) = (abss‘(𝐵 -s 𝐴))) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | lesubsd 28088 | Swap subtrahends in a surreal inequality. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 ≤s (𝐵 -s 𝐶) ↔ 𝐶 ≤s (𝐵 -s 𝐴))) | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | dfsucmap4 38786 | Alternate definition of the successor map. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ SucMap = (𝑚 ∈ V ↦ suc 𝑚) | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | dfsucmap2 38785 | Alternate definition of the successor map. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ SucMap = ( I AdjLiftMap dom I ) | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | dfsucmap3 38784 | Alternate definition of the successor map. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ SucMap = ( I AdjLiftMap V) | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | blockadjliftmap 38779 | A "two-stage" construction is obtained by first forming the block relation (𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E ) and then adjoining elements as "BlockAdj". Combined, it uses the relation ((𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E ) ∪ ◡ E ). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E ) AdjLiftMap 𝐴) = {〈𝑚, 𝑛〉 ∣ (𝑚 ∈ (𝐴 ∖ {∅}) ∧ 𝑛 = (𝑚 ∪ ([𝑚]𝑅 × 𝑚)))} | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | dfadjliftmap2 38778 | Alternate definition of the adjoined lift map. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 AdjLiftMap 𝐴) = (𝑚 ∈ (𝐴 ∩ (dom 𝑅 ∪ (V ∖ {∅}))) ↦ (𝑚 ∪ [𝑚]𝑅)) | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | ecuncnvepres 38716 | The restricted union with converse epsilon relation coset of 𝐵. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐵 ∈ 𝐴 → [𝐵]((𝑅 ∪ ◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴) = (𝐵 ∪ [𝐵]𝑅)) | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | ecunres 38715 | The restricted union coset of 𝐵. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐵 ∈ 𝑉 → [𝐵]((𝑅 ∪ 𝑆) ↾ 𝐴) = ([𝐵](𝑅 ↾ 𝐴) ∪ [𝐵](𝑆 ↾ 𝐴))) | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | ecun 38714 | The union coset of 𝐴. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → [𝐴](𝑅 ∪ 𝑆) = ([𝐴]𝑅 ∪ [𝐴]𝑆)) | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | dmxrnuncnvepres 38713 | Domain of the combined relation of two special relations, see blockadjliftmap 38779. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ dom (((𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E ) ∪ ◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴) = (𝐴 ∖ {∅}) | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | dmuncnvepres 38712 | Domain of the union with the converse epsilon, restricted. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ dom ((𝑅 ∪ ◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴) = (𝐴 ∩ (dom 𝑅 ∪ (V ∖ {∅}))) | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | dmcnvepres 38711 | Domain of the restricted converse epsilon relation. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ dom (◡ E ↾ 𝐴) = (𝐴 ∖ {∅}) | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | sps3wwlks2on 30025 | A length 3 string which represents a walk of length 2 between two vertices. Concerns simple pseudographs, in contrast to s3wwlks2on 30024 and does not require the Axiom of Choice for its proof. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐺 ∈ USPGraph ∧ 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) → (〈“𝐴𝐵𝐶”〉 ∈ (𝐴(2 WWalksNOn 𝐺)𝐶) ↔ ∃𝑓(𝑓(Walks‘𝐺)〈“𝐴𝐵𝐶”〉 ∧ (♯‘𝑓) = 2))) | ||
| 27-Jan-2026 | sucpre 38818 | suc is a right-inverse of pre on Suc. This theorem states the partial inverse relation in the direction we most often need. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 27-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ Suc → suc pre 𝑁 = 𝑁) | ||
| 27-Jan-2026 | eupre 38815 | Unique predecessor exists on the successor class. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 27-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ 𝑉 → (𝑁 ∈ Suc ↔ ∃!𝑚 𝑚 SucMap 𝑁)) | ||
| 27-Jan-2026 | dfpre 38797 | Alternate definition of the successor-predecessor. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 27-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ pre 𝑁 = (℩𝑚𝑚 ∈ Pred( SucMap , V, 𝑁)) | ||
| 27-Jan-2026 | df-pre 38796 |
Define the term-level successor-predecessor. It is the unique 𝑚
with suc 𝑚 = 𝑁 when such an 𝑚 exists; otherwise pre 𝑁 is
the
arbitrary default chosen by ℩. See its
alternate definitions
dfpre 38797, dfpre2 38798, dfpre3 38799 and dfpre4 38801.
Our definition is a special case of the widely recognised general 𝑅 -predecessor class df-pred 6265 (the class of all elements 𝑚 of 𝐴 such that 𝑚𝑅𝑁, dfpred3g 6277, cf. also df-bnj14 34832) in several respects. Its most abstract property as a specialisation is that it has a unique existing value by default. This is in contrast to the general version. The uniqueness (conditional on existence) is implied by the property of this specific instance of the general case involving the successor map df-sucmap 38783 in place of 𝑅, so that 𝑚 SucMap 𝑁, cf. sucmapleftuniq 38811, which originates from suc11reg 9540. Existence ∃𝑚𝑚 SucMap 𝑁 holds exactly on 𝑁 ∈ ran SucMap, cf. elrng 5846. Note that dom SucMap = V (see dmsucmap 38789), so the equivalent definition dfpre 38797 uses (℩𝑚𝑚 ∈ Pred( SucMap , V, 𝑁)). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 27-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ pre 𝑁 = (℩𝑚𝑚 ∈ Pred( SucMap , dom SucMap , 𝑁)) | ||
| 26-Jan-2026 | dfpre4 38801 | Alternate definition of the predecessor of the 𝑁 set. The ◡ SucMap is just the "PreMap"; we did not define it because we do not expect to use it extensively in future (cf. the comments of df-sucmap 38783). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 26-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ 𝑉 → pre 𝑁 = (℩𝑚𝑚 ∈ [𝑁]◡ SucMap )) | ||
| 26-Jan-2026 | dfpred4 38800 | Alternate definition of the predecessor class when 𝑁 is a set. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 26-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ 𝑉 → Pred(𝑅, 𝐴, 𝑁) = [𝑁]◡(𝑅 ↾ 𝐴)) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | df-shiftstable 38803 |
Define shift-stability, a general "procedure" pattern for "the
one-step
backward shift/transport of 𝐹 along 𝑆", and then ∩ 𝐹
enforces "and it already holds here".
Let 𝐹 be a relation encoding a property that depends on a "level" coordinate (for example, a feasibility condition indexed by a carrier, a grade, or a stage in a construction). Let 𝑆 be a shift relation between levels (for example, the successor map SucMap, or any other grading step). The composed relation (𝑆 ∘ 𝐹) transports 𝐹 one step along the shift: 𝑟(𝑆 ∘ 𝐹)𝑛 means there exists a predecessor level 𝑚 such that 𝑟𝐹𝑚 and 𝑚𝑆𝑛 (e.g., 𝑚 SucMap 𝑛). We do not introduce a separate notation for "Shift" because it is simply the standard relational composition df-co 5640. The intersection ((𝑆 ∘ 𝐹) ∩ 𝐹) is the locally shift-stable fragment of 𝐹: it consists exactly of those points where the property holds at some immediate predecessor that shifts to 𝑛 and also holds at level 𝑛. In other words, it isolates the part of 𝐹 that is already compatible with one-step tower coherence. This definition packages a common construction pattern used throughout the development: "constrain by one-step stability under a chosen shift, then additionally constrain by 𝐹". Iterating the operator (𝑋 ↦ ((𝑆 ∘ 𝑋) ∩ 𝑋) corresponds to multi-step/tower coherence; the one-step definition here is the economical kernel from which such "tower" readings can be developed when needed. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑆 ShiftStable 𝐹) = ((𝑆 ∘ 𝐹) ∩ 𝐹) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | df-succl 38790 | Define Suc as the class of all successors, i.e. the range of the successor map: 𝑛 ∈ Suc iff ∃𝑚suc 𝑚 = 𝑛 (see dfsuccl2 38791). By injectivity of suc (suc11reg 9540), every 𝑛 ∈ Suc has at most one predecessor, which is exactly what pre 𝑛 (df-pre 38796) names. Cf. dfsuccl3 38794 and dfsuccl4 38795. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ Suc = ran SucMap | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | df-sucmap 38783 |
Define the successor map, directly as the graph of the successor
operation, using only elementary set theory (ordered-pair class
abstraction). This avoids committing to any particular construction of
the successor function/class from other operators (e.g. a
union/composition presentation), while remaining provably equivalent to
those presentations (cf. dfsucmap2 38785 and dfsucmap3 38784 vs. df-succf 36052 and
dfsuccf2 36123). For maximum mappy shape, see dfsucmap4 38786.
We also treat the successor relation as the default shift relation for grading/tower arguments (cf. df-shiftstable 38803). Because it is used pervasively in shift-lift infrastructure, we adopt the short name SucMap rather than the fully systematic "SucAdjLiftMap". You may also define the predecessor relation as the converse graph "PreMap" as ◡ SucMap, which reverses successor edges ( cf. cnvopab 6100) and sends each successor to its (unique) predecessor when it exists. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ SucMap = {〈𝑚, 𝑛〉 ∣ suc 𝑚 = 𝑛} | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | ecxrncnvep2 38731 | The (𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E )-coset of a set is the Cartesian product of its 𝑅-coset and the set. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → [𝐴](𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E ) = ([𝐴]𝑅 × 𝐴)) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | omprcomonb 35264 | The class of all finite ordinals is a proper class iff all ordinal sets are finite. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (¬ ω ∈ V ↔ ω = On) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | fineqvomonb 35263 | All sets are finite iff all ordinal sets are finite. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (Fin = V ↔ ω = On) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | r1omfv 35254 | Value of the cumulative hierarchy of sets function at ω. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅1‘ω) = ∪ (𝑅1 “ ω) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | r12 35238 | Value of the cumulative hierarchy of sets function at 2o. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅1‘2o) = 2o | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | xoromon 35232 | ω is either an ordinal set or the proper class of all ordinal sets, but not both. This is a stronger version of omon 7829. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (ω ∈ On ⊻ ω = On) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | esplyind 33719 | A recursive formula for the elementary symmetric polynomials. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑊 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (𝐼 mVar 𝑅) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝑊) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ 𝐺 = ((𝐼extendVars𝑅)‘𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝑌}) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (𝐽eSymPoly𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (1...(♯‘𝐼))) & ⊢ 𝐶 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐽) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐼eSymPoly𝑅)‘𝐾) = (((𝑉‘𝑌) · (𝐺‘(𝐸‘(𝐾 − 1)))) + (𝐺‘(𝐸‘𝐾)))) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | esplyfval3 33716 | Alternate expression for the value of the 𝐾-th elementary symmetric polynomial. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐼eSymPoly𝑅)‘𝐾) = (𝑓 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if((ran 𝑓 ⊆ {0, 1} ∧ (♯‘(𝑓 supp 0)) = 𝐾), 1 , 0 ))) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | esplyfval2 33709 | When 𝐾 is out-of-bounds, the 𝐾-th elementary symmetric polynomial is zero. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (ℕ0 ∖ (0...(♯‘𝐼)))) & ⊢ 𝑍 = (0g‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐼eSymPoly𝑅)‘𝐾) = 𝑍) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | mplmulmvr 33683 | Multiply a polynomial 𝐹 with a variable 𝑋 (i.e. with a monic monomial). (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑃 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑋 = ((𝐼 mVar 𝑅)‘𝑌) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑃) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ 𝐴 = ((𝟭‘𝐼)‘{𝑌}) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑀) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 · 𝐹) = (𝑏 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if((𝑏‘𝑌) = 0, 0 , (𝐹‘(𝑏 ∘f − 𝐴))))) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | mvrvalind 33682 | Value of the generating elements of the power series structure, expressed using the indicator function. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑉 = (𝐼 mVar 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ (◡ℎ “ ℕ) ∈ Fin} & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ 𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐴 = ((𝟭‘𝐼)‘{𝑋}) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑉‘𝑋)‘𝐹) = if(𝐹 = 𝐴, 1 , 0 )) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | extvfvalf 33681 | The "variable extension" function maps polynomials with variables indexed in 𝐽 to polynomials with variables indexed in 𝐼. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝐴}) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐽 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (Base‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐼extendVars𝑅)‘𝐴):𝑀⟶𝑁) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | extvfvcl 33680 | Closure for the "variable extension" function evaluated for converting a given polynomial 𝐹 by adding a variable with index 𝐴. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝐴}) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐽 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑀) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (Base‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (((𝐼extendVars𝑅)‘𝐴)‘𝐹) ∈ 𝑁) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | extvfvvcl 33679 | Closure for the "variable extension" function evaluated for converting a given polynomial 𝐹 by adding a variable with index 𝐴. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝐴}) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐽 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑀) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐷) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((((𝐼extendVars𝑅)‘𝐴)‘𝐹)‘𝑋) ∈ 𝐵) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | extvfvv 33678 | The "variable extension" function evaluated for converting a given polynomial 𝐹 by adding a variable with index 𝐴. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝐴}) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐽 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑀) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐷) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((((𝐼extendVars𝑅)‘𝐴)‘𝐹)‘𝑋) = if((𝑋‘𝐴) = 0, (𝐹‘(𝑋 ↾ 𝐽)), 0 )) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | extvfv 33677 | The "variable extension" function evaluated for converting a given polynomial 𝐹 by adding a variable with index 𝐴. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝐴}) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐽 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑀) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (((𝐼extendVars𝑅)‘𝐴)‘𝐹) = (𝑥 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if((𝑥‘𝐴) = 0, (𝐹‘(𝑥 ↾ 𝐽)), 0 ))) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | extvfval 33676 | The "variable extension" function evaluated for adding a variable with index 𝐴. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝐴}) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐽 mPoly 𝑅)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐼extendVars𝑅)‘𝐴) = (𝑓 ∈ 𝑀 ↦ (𝑥 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if((𝑥‘𝐴) = 0, (𝑓‘(𝑥 ↾ 𝐽)), 0 )))) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | extvval 33675 | Value of the "variable extension" function. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝑎}) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐽 mPoly 𝑅)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐼extendVars𝑅) = (𝑎 ∈ 𝐼 ↦ (𝑓 ∈ 𝑀 ↦ (𝑥 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if((𝑥‘𝑎) = 0, (𝑓‘(𝑥 ↾ (𝐼 ∖ {𝑎}))), 0 ))))) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | nn0diffz0 32867 | Upper set of the nonnegative integers. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ ℕ0 → (ℕ0 ∖ (0...𝑁)) = (ℤ≥‘(𝑁 + 1))) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | rnressnsn 32750 | The range of a restriction to a singleton is a singleton. See dmressnsn 5988. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((Fun 𝐹 ∧ 𝐴 ∈ dom 𝐹) → ran (𝐹 ↾ {𝐴}) = {(𝐹‘𝐴)}) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | partfun2 32749 | Rewrite a function defined by parts, using a mapping and an if construct, into a union of functions on disjoint domains. See also partfun 6645 and ifmpt2v 7469. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∣ 𝜑} ⇒ ⊢ (𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ↦ if(𝜑, 𝐵, 𝐶)) = ((𝑥 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ 𝐵) ∪ (𝑥 ∈ (𝐴 ∖ 𝐷) ↦ 𝐶)) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | indconst1 12172 | Indicator of the whole set. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑂 ∈ 𝑉 → ((𝟭‘𝑂)‘𝑂) = (𝑂 × {1})) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | indconst0 12171 | Indicator of the empty set. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑂 ∈ 𝑉 → ((𝟭‘𝑂)‘∅) = (𝑂 × {0})) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | tz6.12-2 6827 | Function value when 𝐹 is not a function. Theorem 6.12(2) of [TakeutiZaring] p. 27. (Contributed by NM, 30-Apr-2004.) (Proof shortened by Mario Carneiro, 31-Aug-2015.) Avoid ax-10 2147, ax-11 2163, ax-12 2185. (Revised by TM, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (¬ ∃!𝑥 𝐴𝐹𝑥 → (𝐹‘𝐴) = ∅) | ||
| 24-Jan-2026 | r1omhfb 35256 | The class of all hereditarily finite sets is the only class with the property that all sets are members of it iff they are finite and all of their elements are members of it. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 24-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐻 = ∪ (𝑅1 “ ω) ↔ ∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝐻 ↔ (𝑥 ∈ Fin ∧ ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 𝑦 ∈ 𝐻))) | ||
| 24-Jan-2026 | trssfir1om 35255 | If every element in a transitive class is finite, then every element is also hereditarily finite. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 24-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((Tr 𝐴 ∧ 𝐴 ⊆ Fin) → 𝐴 ⊆ ∪ (𝑅1 “ ω)) | ||
| 24-Jan-2026 | r11 35237 | Value of the cumulative hierarchy of sets function at 1o. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 24-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅1‘1o) = 1o | ||
| 24-Jan-2026 | rnco 6216 | The range of the composition of two classes. (Contributed by NM, 12-Dec-2006.) (Proof shortened by Peter Mazsa, 2-Oct-2022.) Avoid ax-11 2163. (Revised by TM, 24-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ran (𝐴 ∘ 𝐵) = ran (𝐴 ↾ ran 𝐵) | ||
| 24-Jan-2026 | dm0rn0 5879 | An empty domain is equivalent to an empty range. (Contributed by NM, 21-May-1998.) Avoid ax-10 2147, ax-11 2163, ax-12 2185. (Revised by TM, 24-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (dom 𝐴 = ∅ ↔ ran 𝐴 = ∅) | ||
| 24-Jan-2026 | eqabcbw 2810 | Version of eqabcb 2876 using implicit substitution, which requires fewer axioms. (Contributed by TM, 24-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝑦 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓)) ⇒ ⊢ ({𝑥 ∣ 𝜑} = 𝐴 ↔ ∀𝑦(𝜓 ↔ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐴)) | ||
| 24-Jan-2026 | excomw 2048 | Weak version of excom 2168 and biconditional form of excomimw 2046. Uses only Tarski's FOL axiom schemes. (Contributed by TM, 24-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝑤 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓)) & ⊢ (𝑦 = 𝑧 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (∃𝑥∃𝑦𝜑 ↔ ∃𝑦∃𝑥𝜑) | ||
| 22-Jan-2026 | chnsubseq 47310 | An order-preserving subsequence of an ordered chain is itself a chain. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 22-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑊 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ ( < Chain (0..^(♯‘𝑊)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → < Po 𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑊 ∘ 𝐼) ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) | ||
| 22-Jan-2026 | chnsubseqwl 47309 | A subsequence of a chain has the same length as its indexing sequence. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 22-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑊 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ ( < Chain (0..^(♯‘𝑊)))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (♯‘(𝑊 ∘ 𝐼)) = (♯‘𝐼)) | ||
| 22-Jan-2026 | chnsubseqword 47308 | A subsequence of a chain is a word. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 22-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑊 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ ( < Chain (0..^(♯‘𝑊)))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑊 ∘ 𝐼) ∈ Word 𝐴) | ||
| 22-Jan-2026 | r1filim 35247 | A finite set appears in the cumulative hierarchy prior to a limit ordinal iff all of its elements appear in the cumulative hierarchy prior to that limit ordinal. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 22-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ Fin ∧ Lim 𝐵) → (𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ 𝐵) ↔ ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝑥 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ 𝐵))) | ||
| 22-Jan-2026 | rankfilimb 35245 | The rank of a finite well-founded set is less than a limit ordinal iff the ranks of all of its elements are less than that limit ordinal. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 22-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ Fin ∧ 𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On) ∧ Lim 𝐵) → ((rank‘𝐴) ∈ 𝐵 ↔ ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 (rank‘𝑥) ∈ 𝐵)) | ||
| 21-Jan-2026 | r1omhfbregs 35281 | The class of all hereditarily finite sets is the only class with the property that all sets are members of it iff they are finite and all of their elements are members of it. This version of r1omhfb 35256 replaces setinds2 9672 with setinds2regs 35275 and trssfir1om 35255 with trssfir1omregs 35280. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 21-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐻 = ∪ (𝑅1 “ ω) ↔ ∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝐻 ↔ (𝑥 ∈ Fin ∧ ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 𝑦 ∈ 𝐻))) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | trssfir1omregs 35280 | If every element in a transitive class is finite, then every element is also hereditarily finite. This version of trssfir1om 35255 replaces setinds2 9672 with setinds2regs 35275. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((Tr 𝐴 ∧ 𝐴 ⊆ Fin) → 𝐴 ⊆ ∪ (𝑅1 “ ω)) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | df-extv 33674 | Define the "variable extension" function. The function ((𝐼extendVars𝑅)‘𝐴) converts polynomials with variables indexed by (𝐼 ∖ {𝐴}) into polynomials indexed by 𝐼, and therefore maps elements of ((𝐼 ∖ {𝐴}) mPoly 𝑅) onto (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅). (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ extendVars = (𝑖 ∈ V, 𝑟 ∈ V ↦ (𝑎 ∈ 𝑖 ↦ (𝑓 ∈ (Base‘((𝑖 ∖ {𝑎}) mPoly 𝑟)) ↦ (𝑥 ∈ {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝑖) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} ↦ if((𝑥‘𝑎) = 0, (𝑓‘(𝑥 ↾ (𝑖 ∖ {𝑎}))), (0g‘𝑟)))))) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chnfibg 18602 | Given a partial order, the set of chains is finite iff the alphabet is finite. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( < Po 𝐴 → (𝐴 ∈ Fin ↔ ( < Chain 𝐴) ∈ Fin)) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chninf 18601 | There is an infinite number of chains for any infinite alphabet and any relation. For instance, all the singletons of alphabet characters match. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∉ Fin → ( < Chain 𝐴) ∉ Fin) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chnfi 18600 | There is a finite number of chains over finite domain, as long as the relation orders it. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ Fin ∧ < Po 𝐴) → ( < Chain 𝐴) ∈ Fin) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chnpolfz 18599 | Provided that chain's relation is a partial order, the chain length is restricted to a specific integer range. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → < Po 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Fin) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (♯‘𝐵) ∈ (0...(♯‘𝐴))) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chnpolleha 18598 | A chain under relation which orders the alphabet has at most alphabet's size elements in it. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → < Po 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (♯‘𝐵) ≤ (♯‘𝐴)) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chnpoadomd 18597 | A chain under relation which orders the alphabet cannot have more elements than the alphabet itself. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → < Po 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (0..^(♯‘𝐵)) ≼ 𝐴) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chnpof1 18596 | A chain under relation which orders the alphabet is a one-to-one function from its domain to alphabet. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → < Po 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵:(0..^(♯‘𝐵))–1-1→𝐴) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chnf 18595 | A chain is a zero-based finite sequence with a recoverable upper limit. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐵 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴) → 𝐵:(0..^(♯‘𝐵))⟶𝐴) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chnrev 18593 | Reverse of a chain is chain under the converse relation and same domain. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐵 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴) → (reverse‘𝐵) ∈ (◡ < Chain 𝐴)) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chnccat 18592 | Concatenate two chains. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑇 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑈 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑇 = ∅ ∨ 𝑈 = ∅ ∨ (lastS‘𝑇) < (𝑈‘0))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑇 ++ 𝑈) ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chnrdss 18583 | Subset theorem for chains. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (( < ⊆ 𝑅 ∧ 𝐴 ⊆ 𝐵) → ( < Chain 𝐴) ⊆ (𝑅 Chain 𝐵)) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chndss 18582 | Chains with an alphabet are also chains with any superset alphabet. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ⊆ 𝐵 → ( < Chain 𝐴) ⊆ ( < Chain 𝐵)) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chnrss 18581 | Chains under a relation are also chains under any superset relation. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( < ⊆ 𝑅 → ( < Chain 𝐴) ⊆ (𝑅 Chain 𝐴)) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | nfchnd 18577 | Bound-variable hypothesis builder for chain collection constructor. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → Ⅎ𝑥 < ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → Ⅎ𝑥𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → Ⅎ𝑥( < Chain 𝐴)) | ||
| 19-Jan-2026 | r1omhf 35249 | A set is hereditarily finite iff it is finite and all of its elements are hereditarily finite. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 19-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ ω) ↔ (𝐴 ∈ Fin ∧ ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝑥 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ ω))) | ||
| 19-Jan-2026 | r1filimi 35246 | If all elements in a finite set appear in the cumulative hierarchy prior to a limit ordinal, then that set also appears in the cumulative hierarchy prior to the limit ordinal. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 19-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ Fin ∧ ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝑥 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ 𝐵) ∧ Lim 𝐵) → 𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ 𝐵)) | ||
| 19-Jan-2026 | rankfilimbi 35244 | If all elements in a finite well-founded set have a rank less than a limit ordinal, then the rank of that set is also less than the limit ordinal. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 19-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (((𝐴 ∈ Fin ∧ 𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On)) ∧ (∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 (rank‘𝑥) ∈ 𝐵 ∧ Lim 𝐵)) → (rank‘𝐴) ∈ 𝐵) | ||
| 19-Jan-2026 | rankval4b 35243 | The rank of a set is the supremum of the successors of the ranks of its members. Exercise 9.1 of [Jech] p. 72. Also a special case of Theorem 7V(b) of [Enderton] p. 204. This variant of rankval4 9791 does not use Regularity, and so requires the assumption that 𝐴 is in the range of 𝑅1. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 19-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On) → (rank‘𝐴) = ∪ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 suc (rank‘𝑥)) | ||
| 19-Jan-2026 | rankval2b 35242 | Value of an alternate definition of the rank function. Definition of [BellMachover] p. 478. This variant of rankval2 9742 does not use Regularity, and so requires the assumption that 𝐴 is in the range of 𝑅1. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 19-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On) → (rank‘𝐴) = ∩ {𝑥 ∈ On ∣ 𝐴 ⊆ (𝑅1‘𝑥)}) | ||
| 19-Jan-2026 | r1wf 35239 | Each stage in the cumulative hierarchy is well-founded. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 19-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅1‘𝐴) ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | esplysply 33715 | The 𝐾-th elementary symmetric polynomial is symmetric. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (0...(♯‘𝐼))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐼eSymPoly𝑅)‘𝐾) ∈ (𝐼SymPoly𝑅)) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | esplyfv 33714 | Coefficient for the 𝐾-th elementary symmetric polynomial and a bag of variables 𝐹: the coefficient is 1 for the bags of exactly 𝐾 variables, having exponent at most 1. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (0...(♯‘𝐼))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝐷) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (((𝐼eSymPoly𝑅)‘𝐾)‘𝐹) = if((ran 𝐹 ⊆ {0, 1} ∧ (♯‘(𝐹 supp 0)) = 𝐾), 1 , 0 )) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | esplyfv1 33713 | Coefficient for the 𝐾-th elementary symmetric polynomial and a bag of variables 𝐹 where variables are not raised to a power. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (0...(♯‘𝐼))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝐷) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ran 𝐹 ⊆ {0, 1}) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (((𝐼eSymPoly𝑅)‘𝐾)‘𝐹) = if((♯‘(𝐹 supp 0)) = 𝐾, 1 , 0 )) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | esplymhp 33712 | The 𝐾-th elementary symmetric polynomial is homogeneous of degree 𝐾. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (𝐼 mHomP 𝑅) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐼eSymPoly𝑅)‘𝐾) ∈ (𝐻‘𝐾)) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | esplympl 33711 | Elementary symmetric polynomials are polynomials. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐼eSymPoly𝑅)‘𝐾) ∈ 𝑀) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | esplylem 33710 | Lemma for esplyfv 33714 and others. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ℕ0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝟭‘𝐼) “ {𝑐 ∈ 𝒫 𝐼 ∣ (♯‘𝑐) = 𝐾}) ⊆ 𝐷) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | esplyfval 33707 | The 𝐾-th elementary polynomial for a given index 𝐼 of variables and base ring 𝑅. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ℕ0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐼eSymPoly𝑅)‘𝐾) = ((ℤRHom‘𝑅) ∘ ((𝟭‘𝐷)‘((𝟭‘𝐼) “ {𝑐 ∈ 𝒫 𝐼 ∣ (♯‘𝑐) = 𝐾})))) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | esplyval 33706 | The elementary polynomials for a given index 𝐼 of variables and base ring 𝑅. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐼eSymPoly𝑅) = (𝑘 ∈ ℕ0 ↦ ((ℤRHom‘𝑅) ∘ ((𝟭‘𝐷)‘((𝟭‘𝐼) “ {𝑐 ∈ 𝒫 𝐼 ∣ (♯‘𝑐) = 𝑘}))))) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | issply 33705 | Conditions for being a symmetric polynomial. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (SymGrp‘𝐼) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑀) & ⊢ (((𝜑 ∧ 𝑝 ∈ 𝑃) ∧ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐷) → (𝐹‘(𝑥 ∘ 𝑝)) = (𝐹‘𝑥)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐼SymPoly𝑅)) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | df-esply 33702 | Define elementary symmetric polynomials. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ eSymPoly = (𝑖 ∈ V, 𝑟 ∈ V ↦ (𝑘 ∈ ℕ0 ↦ ((ℤRHom‘𝑟) ∘ ((𝟭‘{ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝑖) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0})‘((𝟭‘𝑖) “ {𝑐 ∈ 𝒫 𝑖 ∣ (♯‘𝑐) = 𝑘}))))) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | gsumind 33405 | The group sum of an indicator function of the set 𝐴 gives the size of 𝐴. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑂 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ⊆ 𝑂) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Fin) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (ℂfld Σg ((𝟭‘𝑂)‘𝐴)) = (♯‘𝐴)) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | indfsid 32929 | Conditions for a function to be an indicator function. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑂 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝑂⟶{0, 1}) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = ((𝟭‘𝑂)‘(𝐹 supp 0))) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | indfsd 32928 | The indicator function of a finite set has finite support. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑂 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ⊆ 𝑂) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Fin) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝟭‘𝑂)‘𝐴) finSupp 0) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | hashimaf1 32884 | Taking the image of a set by a one-to-one function does not affect size. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝐴–1-1→𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ⊆ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (♯‘(𝐹 “ 𝐶)) = (♯‘𝐶)) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | pw2cut2 28454 | Cut expression for powers of two. Theorem 12 of [Conway] p. 12-13. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℤs ∧ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) → (𝐴 /su (2s↑s𝑁)) = ({((𝐴 -s 1s ) /su (2s↑s𝑁))} |s {((𝐴 +s 1s ) /su (2s↑s𝑁))})) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | pw2ltsdiv1d 28444 | Surreal less-than relationship for division by a power of two. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 <s 𝐵 ↔ (𝐴 /su (2s↑s𝑁)) <s (𝐵 /su (2s↑s𝑁)))) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | sltssnb 27761 | Surreal set less-than of two singletons. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ({𝐴} <<s {𝐵} ↔ 𝐴 <s 𝐵)) | ||
| 17-Jan-2026 | ex-chn2 18604 | Example: sequence <" ZZ NN QQ "> is a valid chain under the equinumerosity relation in universal domain. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 17-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 〈“ℤℕℚ”〉 ∈ ( ≈ Chain V) | ||
| 17-Jan-2026 | ex-chn1 18603 | Example: a doubleton of twos is a valid chain under the identity relation and domain of integers. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 17-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 〈“22”〉 ∈ ( I Chain ℤ) | ||
| 17-Jan-2026 | chnflenfi 18594 | There is a finite number of chains with fixed length over finite alphabet. Trivially holds for invalid lengths as there're no matching sequences. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 5-Jan-2025.) (Revised by Ender Ting, 17-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ Fin → {𝑎 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴) ∣ (♯‘𝑎) = 𝑇} ∈ Fin) | ||
| 17-Jan-2026 | nulchn 18585 | Empty set is an increasing chain for every range and every relation. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 19-Nov-2024.) (Revised by Ender Ting, 17-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∅ ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴) | ||
| 17-Jan-2026 | chnexg 18584 | Chains with a set given for range form a set. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 21-Nov-2024.) (Revised by Ender Ting, 17-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → ( < Chain 𝐴) ∈ V) | ||
| 17-Jan-2026 | chneq12 18580 | Equality theorem for chains. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 17-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (( < = 𝑅 ∧ 𝐴 = 𝐵) → ( < Chain 𝐴) = (𝑅 Chain 𝐵)) | ||
| 17-Jan-2026 | chneq2 18579 | Equality theorem for chains. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 17-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 = 𝐵 → ( < Chain 𝐴) = ( < Chain 𝐵)) | ||
| 17-Jan-2026 | chneq1 18578 | Equality theorem for chains. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 17-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( < = 𝑅 → ( < Chain 𝐴) = (𝑅 Chain 𝐴)) | ||
| 15-Jan-2026 | r1ssel 35250 | A set is a subset of the value of the cumulative hierarchy of sets function iff it is an element of the value at the successor. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 15-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐵 ∈ On → (𝐴 ⊆ (𝑅1‘𝐵) ↔ 𝐴 ∈ (𝑅1‘suc 𝐵))) | ||
| 15-Jan-2026 | fissorduni 35233 | The union (supremum) of a finite set of ordinals less than a nonzero ordinal class is an element of that ordinal class. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 15-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ Fin ∧ 𝐴 ⊆ 𝐵 ∧ (Ord 𝐵 ∧ 𝐵 ≠ ∅)) → ∪ 𝐴 ∈ 𝐵) | ||
| 15-Jan-2026 | splysubrg 33704 | The symmetric polynomials form a subring of the ring of polynomials. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (SymGrp‘𝐼) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (𝑑 ∈ 𝑃, 𝑓 ∈ 𝑀 ↦ (𝑥 ∈ {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} ↦ (𝑓‘(𝑥 ∘ 𝑑)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐼SymPoly𝑅) ∈ (SubRing‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅))) | ||
| 15-Jan-2026 | mplvrpmrhm 33691 | The action of permuting variables in a multivariate polynomial is a ring homomorphism. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (SymGrp‘𝐼) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (𝑑 ∈ 𝑃, 𝑓 ∈ 𝑀 ↦ (𝑥 ∈ {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} ↦ (𝑓‘(𝑥 ∘ 𝑑)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑓 ∈ 𝑀 ↦ (𝐷𝐴𝑓)) & ⊢ 𝑊 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑃) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑊 RingHom 𝑊)) | ||
| 15-Jan-2026 | cocnvf1o 32802 | Composing with the inverse of a bijection. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝐴⟶𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺:𝐴⟶𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐻:𝐴–1-1-onto→𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐹 = (𝐺 ∘ 𝐻) ↔ 𝐺 = (𝐹 ∘ ◡𝐻))) | ||
| 15-Jan-2026 | ofrco 32683 | Function relation between function compositions. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 Fn 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 Fn 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐻:𝐶⟶𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∘r 𝑅𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐹 ∘ 𝐻) ∘r 𝑅(𝐺 ∘ 𝐻)) | ||
| 15-Jan-2026 | fnfvor 32682 | Relation between two functions implies the same relation for the function value at a given 𝑋. See also fnfvof 7648. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 Fn 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 Fn 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∘r 𝑅𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐹‘𝑋)𝑅(𝐺‘𝑋)) | ||
| 15-Jan-2026 | elrabrd 32568 | Deduction version of elrab 3634, just like elrabd 3636, but backwards direction. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝐴 → (𝜓 ↔ 𝜒)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ {𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 ∣ 𝜓}) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝜒) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | preel 38821 | Predecessor is a subset of its successor. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ Suc → pre 𝑁 ∈ 𝑁) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | press 38820 | Predecessor is a subset of its successor. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ Suc → pre 𝑁 ⊆ 𝑁) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | presuc 38819 | pre is a left-inverse of suc. This theorem gives a clean rewrite rule that eliminates pre on explicit successors. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑀 ∈ 𝑉 → pre suc 𝑀 = 𝑀) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | preuniqval 38817 | Uniqueness/canonicity of pre. presucmap 38816 gives one witness; this theorem gives it is the only one. It turns any predecessor proof into an equality with pre 𝑁. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ ran SucMap → ∀𝑚(𝑚 SucMap 𝑁 → 𝑚 = pre 𝑁)) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | presucmap 38816 | pre is really a predecessor (when it should be). This correctness theorem for pre makes it usable in proofs without unfolding ℩. This theorem gives one witness; preuniqval 38817 gives it is the only one. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ ran SucMap → pre 𝑁 SucMap 𝑁) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | eupre2 38814 | Unique predecessor exists on the range of the successor map. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ 𝑉 → (𝑁 ∈ ran SucMap ↔ ∃!𝑚 𝑚 SucMap 𝑁)) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | preex 38813 | The successor-predecessor exists. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ pre 𝑁 ∈ V | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | exeupre 38812 | Whenever a predecessor exists, it exists alone. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ 𝑉 → (∃𝑚 𝑚 SucMap 𝑁 ↔ ∃!𝑚 𝑚 SucMap 𝑁)) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | dfpre3 38799 | Alternate definition of the successor-predecessor. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ 𝑉 → pre 𝑁 = (℩𝑚 suc 𝑚 = 𝑁)) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | dfpre2 38798 | Alternate definition of the successor-predecessor. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ 𝑉 → pre 𝑁 = (℩𝑚𝑚 SucMap 𝑁)) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | exeupre2 38793 | Whenever a predecessor exists, it exists alone. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑚 suc 𝑚 = 𝑁 ↔ ∃!𝑚 suc 𝑚 = 𝑁) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | mopre 38792 | There is at most one predecessor of 𝑁. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∃*𝑚 suc 𝑚 = 𝑁 | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | fineqvnttrclse 35268 | A counterexample demonstrating that ttrclse 9648 does not hold when all sets are finite. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑅 = {〈𝑥, 𝑦〉 ∣ (𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ 𝑥 = suc 𝑦)} & ⊢ 𝐴 = ω ⇒ ⊢ (Fin = V → (𝑅 Se 𝐴 ∧ ¬ t++(𝑅 ↾ 𝐴) Se 𝐴)) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | fineqvnttrclselem3 35267 | Lemma for fineqvnttrclse 35268. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑅 = {〈𝑥, 𝑦〉 ∣ (𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ 𝑥 = suc 𝑦)} & ⊢ 𝐴 = ω & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑣 ∈ suc suc 𝑁 ↦ ∪ {𝑑 ∈ On ∣ (𝑣 +o 𝑑) = 𝐵}) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐵 ∈ (ω ∖ 1o) ∧ 𝑁 ∈ 𝐵) → ∀𝑎 ∈ suc 𝑁(𝐹‘𝑎)𝑅(𝐹‘suc 𝑎)) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | fineqvnttrclselem2 35266 | Lemma for fineqvnttrclse 35268. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑣 ∈ suc suc 𝑁 ↦ ∪ {𝑑 ∈ On ∣ (𝑣 +o 𝑑) = 𝐵}) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐵 ∈ (ω ∖ 1o) ∧ 𝑁 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ 𝐴 ∈ suc suc 𝑁) → (𝐴 +o (𝐹‘𝐴)) = 𝐵) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | fineqvnttrclselem1 35265 | Lemma for fineqvnttrclse 35268. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐵 ∈ (ω ∖ 1o) → ∪ {𝑑 ∈ On ∣ (𝐴 +o 𝑑) = 𝐵} ∈ ω) | ||
| 11-Jan-2026 | splyval 33703 | The symmetric polynomials for a given index 𝐼 of variables and base ring 𝑅. These are the fixed points of the action 𝐴 which permutes variables. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 11-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (SymGrp‘𝐼) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (𝑑 ∈ 𝑃, 𝑓 ∈ 𝑀 ↦ (𝑥 ∈ {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} ↦ (𝑓‘(𝑥 ∘ 𝑑)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐼SymPoly𝑅) = (𝑀FixPts𝐴)) | ||
| 11-Jan-2026 | df-sply 33701 | Define symmetric polynomials. See splyval 33703 for a more readable expression. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 11-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ SymPoly = (𝑖 ∈ V, 𝑟 ∈ V ↦ ((Base‘(𝑖 mPoly 𝑟))FixPts(𝑑 ∈ (Base‘(SymGrp‘𝑖)), 𝑓 ∈ (Base‘(𝑖 mPoly 𝑟)) ↦ (𝑥 ∈ {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝑖) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} ↦ (𝑓‘(𝑥 ∘ 𝑑)))))) | ||
| 11-Jan-2026 | mplvrpmmhm 33690 | The action of permuting variables in a multivariate polynomial is a monoid homomorphism. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 11-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (SymGrp‘𝐼) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (𝑑 ∈ 𝑃, 𝑓 ∈ 𝑀 ↦ (𝑥 ∈ {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} ↦ (𝑓‘(𝑥 ∘ 𝑑)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑓 ∈ 𝑀 ↦ (𝐷𝐴𝑓)) & ⊢ 𝑊 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑃) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑊 MndHom 𝑊)) | ||
| 11-Jan-2026 | mplvrpmlem 33687 | Lemma for mplvrpmga 33689 and others. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 11-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (SymGrp‘𝐼) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑃) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0}) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 ∘ 𝐷) ∈ {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0}) | ||
| 11-Jan-2026 | constcof 32694 | Composition with a constant function. See also fcoconst 7087. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 11-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝑋⟶𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐼 × {𝑌}) ∘ 𝐹) = (𝑋 × {𝑌})) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | finextalg 33842 | A finite field extension is algebraic. Proposition 1.1 of [Lang], p. 224. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸/FinExt𝐹) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸/AlgExt𝐹) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | bralgext 33841 | Express the fact that a field extension 𝐸 / 𝐹 is algebraic. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐸) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (Base‘𝐹) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐸/AlgExt𝐹 ↔ (𝐸/FldExt𝐹 ∧ (𝐸 IntgRing 𝐶) = 𝐵))) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | extdgfialg 33838 | A finite field extension 𝐸 / 𝐹 is algebraic. Part of the proof of Proposition 1.1 of [Lang], p. 224. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐸) & ⊢ 𝐷 = (dim‘((subringAlg ‘𝐸)‘𝐹)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ Field) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (SubDRing‘𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ ℕ0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐸 IntgRing 𝐹) = 𝐵) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | extdgfialglem2 33837 | Lemma for extdgfialg 33838. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐸) & ⊢ 𝐷 = (dim‘((subringAlg ‘𝐸)‘𝐹)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ Field) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (SubDRing‘𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ 𝑍 = (0g‘𝐸) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝐸) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑛 ∈ (0...𝐷) ↦ (𝑛(.g‘(mulGrp‘((subringAlg ‘𝐸)‘𝐹)))𝑋)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴:(0...𝐷)⟶𝐹) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 finSupp 𝑍) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐸 Σg (𝐴 ∘f · 𝐺)) = 𝑍) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ≠ ((0...𝐷) × {𝑍})) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ (𝐸 IntgRing 𝐹)) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | extdgfialglem1 33836 | Lemma for extdgfialg 33838. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐸) & ⊢ 𝐷 = (dim‘((subringAlg ‘𝐸)‘𝐹)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ Field) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (SubDRing‘𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ 𝑍 = (0g‘𝐸) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝐸) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑛 ∈ (0...𝐷) ↦ (𝑛(.g‘(mulGrp‘((subringAlg ‘𝐸)‘𝐹)))𝑋)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ∃𝑎 ∈ (𝐹 ↑m (0...𝐷))(𝑎 finSupp 𝑍 ∧ ((𝐸 Σg (𝑎 ∘f · 𝐺)) = 𝑍 ∧ 𝑎 ≠ ((0...𝐷) × {𝑍})))) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | finextfldext 33808 | A finite field extension is a field extension. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸/FinExt𝐹) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸/FldExt𝐹) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | srapwov 33733 | The "power" operation on a subring algebra. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐴 = ((subringAlg ‘𝑊)‘𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑊 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑆 ⊆ (Base‘𝑊)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (.g‘(mulGrp‘𝑊)) = (.g‘(mulGrp‘𝐴))) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | mplvrpmga 33689 | The action of permuting variables in a multivariate polynomial is a group action. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (SymGrp‘𝐼) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (𝑑 ∈ 𝑃, 𝑓 ∈ 𝑀 ↦ (𝑥 ∈ {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} ↦ (𝑓‘(𝑥 ∘ 𝑑)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝑆 GrpAct 𝑀)) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | mplvrpmfgalem 33688 | Permuting variables in a multivariate polynomial conserves finite support. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (SymGrp‘𝐼) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (𝑑 ∈ 𝑃, 𝑓 ∈ 𝑀 ↦ (𝑥 ∈ {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} ↦ (𝑓‘(𝑥 ∘ 𝑑)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑀) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑄 ∈ 𝑃) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑄𝐴𝐹) finSupp 0 ) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | psrbasfsupp 33672 | Rewrite a finite support for nonnegative integers : For functions mapping a set 𝐼 to the nonnegative integers, having finite support can also be written as having a finite preimage of the positive integers. The latter expression is used for example in psrbas 21913, but with the former expression, theorems about finite support can be used more directly. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {𝑓 ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ 𝑓 finSupp 0} ⇒ ⊢ 𝐷 = {𝑓 ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ (◡𝑓 “ ℕ) ∈ Fin} | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | evls1monply1 33639 | Subring evaluation of a scaled monomial. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝑆 evalSub1 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐾 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 𝑊 = (Poly1‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝑈 = (𝑆 ↾s 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑋 = (var1‘𝑈) & ⊢ ↑ = (.g‘(mulGrp‘𝑊)) & ⊢ ∧ = (.g‘(mulGrp‘𝑆)) & ⊢ ∗ = ( ·𝑠 ‘𝑊) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑆 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ (SubRing‘𝑆)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐾) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑄‘(𝐴 ∗ (𝑁 ↑ 𝑋)))‘𝑌) = (𝐴 · (𝑁 ∧ 𝑌))) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | fcobijfs2 32795 | Composing finitely supported functions with a bijection yields a bijection between sets of finitely supported functions. See also fcobijfs 32794 and mapfien 9321. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺:𝑅–1-1-onto→𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ 𝑈) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑆 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑇 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑂 ∈ 𝑇) & ⊢ 𝑋 = {𝑔 ∈ (𝑇 ↑m 𝑆) ∣ 𝑔 finSupp 𝑂} & ⊢ 𝑌 = {ℎ ∈ (𝑇 ↑m 𝑅) ∣ ℎ finSupp 𝑂} ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑓 ∈ 𝑋 ↦ (𝑓 ∘ 𝐺)):𝑋–1-1-onto→𝑌) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | f1oeq3dd 32702 | Equality deduction for one-to-one onto functions. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝐶–1-1-onto→𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 = 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝐶–1-1-onto→𝐵) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | fconst7v 32693 | An alternative way to express a constant function. (Contributed by Glauco Siliprandi, 5-Feb-2022.) Removed hyphotheses as suggested by SN (Revised by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 Fn 𝐴) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴) → (𝐹‘𝑥) = 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = (𝐴 × {𝐵})) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | breq2dd 32677 | Equality deduction for a binary relation. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 = 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶𝑅𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶𝑅𝐵) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | breq1dd 32676 | Equality deduction for a binary relation. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 = 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴𝑅𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵𝑅𝐶) | ||
| 8-Jan-2026 | sucmapleftuniq 38811 | Left uniqueness of the successor mapping. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 8-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐿 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝑀 ∈ 𝑊 ∧ 𝑁 ∈ 𝑋) → ((𝐿 SucMap 𝑁 ∧ 𝑀 SucMap 𝑁) → 𝐿 = 𝑀)) | ||
| 7-Jan-2026 | sucmapsuc 38810 | A set is succeeded by its successor. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 7-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑀 ∈ 𝑉 → 𝑀 SucMap suc 𝑀) | ||
| 7-Jan-2026 | dmsucmap 38789 | The domain of the successor map is the universe. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 7-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ dom SucMap = V | ||
| 7-Jan-2026 | relsucmap 38788 | The successor map is a relation. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 7-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ Rel SucMap | ||
| 6-Jan-2026 | brsucmap 38787 | Binary relation form of the successor map, general version. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 6-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑀 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝑁 ∈ 𝑊) → (𝑀 SucMap 𝑁 ↔ suc 𝑀 = 𝑁)) | ||
| 6-Jan-2026 | dfsuccf2 36123 | Alternate definition of Scott Fenton's version of Succ, cf. df-sucmap 38783. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 6-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ Succ = {〈𝑚, 𝑛〉 ∣ suc 𝑚 = 𝑛} | ||
| 1-Jan-2026 | rightge0 27813 | A surreal is non-negative iff all its right options are positive. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 1-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 <<s 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 = (𝐴 |s 𝐵)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( 0s ≤s 𝑋 ↔ ∀𝑥𝑅 ∈ 𝐵 0s <s 𝑥𝑅)) | ||
| 31-Dec-2025 | tz9.1regs 35278 |
Every set has a transitive closure (the smallest transitive extension).
This version of tz9.1 9650 depends on ax-regs 35270 instead of ax-reg 9507 and
ax-inf2 9562. This suggests a possible answer to the
third question posed
in tz9.1 9650, namely that the missing property is that
countably infinite
classes must obey regularity. In ZF set theory we can prove this by
showing that countably infinite classes are sets and thus ax-reg 9507
applies to them directly, but in a finitist context it seems that an
axiom like ax-regs 35270 is required since countably infinite classes
are
proper classes.
A related candidate for the missing property is the non-existence of infinite descending ∈-chains, proven as noinfep 9581 using ax-reg 9507 and ax-inf2 9562 and as noinfepregs 35277 using ax-regs 35270. If all sets are finite, then the existence of such a chain implies there is a set which does not have a transitive closure, as shown in fineqvinfep 35269. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 31-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐴 ∈ V ⇒ ⊢ ∃𝑥(𝐴 ⊆ 𝑥 ∧ Tr 𝑥 ∧ ∀𝑦((𝐴 ⊆ 𝑦 ∧ Tr 𝑦) → 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑦)) | ||
| 31-Dec-2025 | setinds2regs 35275 | Principle of set induction (or E-induction). If a property passes from all elements of 𝑥 to 𝑥 itself, then it holds for all 𝑥. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 31-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝑦 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓)) & ⊢ (∀𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 𝜓 → 𝜑) ⇒ ⊢ 𝜑 | ||
| 31-Dec-2025 | nelaneqOLD 9517 | Obsolete version of nelaneq 9516 as of 22-Apr-2026. (Proposed by BJ, 18-Jun-2022.) (Contributed by AV, 18-Jun-2022.) (Proof shortened by TM, 31-Dec-2025.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ¬ (𝐴 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ 𝐴 = 𝐵) | ||
| 31-Dec-2025 | zfregcl 9509 | The Axiom of Regularity with class variables. (Contributed by NM, 5-Aug-1994.) Replace sethood hypothesis with sethood antecedent. (Revised by BJ, 27-Apr-2021.) Avoid ax-10 2147 and ax-12 2185. (Revised by TM, 31-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → (∃𝑥 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 → ∃𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 ¬ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐴)) | ||
| 31-Dec-2025 | dmcosseq 5933 | Domain of a composition. (Contributed by NM, 28-May-1998.) (Proof shortened by Andrew Salmon, 27-Aug-2011.) Avoid ax-11 2163. (Revised by BTernaryTau, 23-Jun-2025.) Avoid ax-10 2147 and ax-12 2185. (Revised by TM, 31-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (ran 𝐵 ⊆ dom 𝐴 → dom (𝐴 ∘ 𝐵) = dom 𝐵) | ||
| 31-Dec-2025 | dmcoss 5930 | Domain of a composition. Theorem 21 of [Suppes] p. 63. (Contributed by NM, 19-Mar-1998.) (Proof shortened by Andrew Salmon, 27-Aug-2011.) Avoid ax-10 2147 and ax-12 2185. (Revised by TM, 31-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ dom (𝐴 ∘ 𝐵) ⊆ dom 𝐵 | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | grlimedgnedg 48607 | In general, the image of an edge of a graph by a local isomprphism is not an edge of the other graph, proven by an example (see gpg5edgnedg 48606). This theorem proves that the analogon (((𝐺 ∈ USPGraph ∧ 𝐻 ∈ USPGraph) ∧ (𝐹 ∈ (𝐺 GraphLocIso 𝐻) ∧ 𝐾 ∈ 𝐼)) → (𝐹 “ 𝐾) ∈ 𝐸) of grimedgi 48412 for ordinarily isomorphic graphs does not hold in general. (Contributed by AV, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑔 ∈ USGraph ∃ℎ ∈ USGraph ∃𝑓 ∈ (𝑔 GraphLocIso ℎ)∃𝑎 ∈ (Vtx‘𝑔)∃𝑏 ∈ (Vtx‘𝑔)({𝑎, 𝑏} ∈ (Edg‘𝑔) ∧ {(𝑓‘𝑎), (𝑓‘𝑏)} ∉ (Edg‘ℎ)) | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | grimedgi 48412 | Graph isomorphisms map edges onto the corresponding edges. (Contributed by AV, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐻) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐺 ∈ UHGraph ∧ 𝐻 ∈ UHGraph ∧ 𝐹 ∈ (𝐺 GraphIso 𝐻)) → (𝐾 ∈ 𝐼 → (𝐹 “ 𝐾) ∈ 𝐸)) | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | fineqvr1ombregs 35282 | All sets are finite iff all sets are hereditarily finite. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (Fin = V ↔ ∪ (𝑅1 “ ω) = V) | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | unir1regs 35279 | The cumulative hierarchy of sets covers the universe. This version of unir1 9737 replaces setind 9668 with setindregs 35274. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On) = V | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | setindregs 35274 | Set (epsilon) induction. This version of setind 9668 replaces zfregs 9653 with axregszf 35273. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑥(𝑥 ⊆ 𝐴 → 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴) → 𝐴 = V) | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | axregszf 35273 | Derivation of zfregs 9653 using ax-regs 35270. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ≠ ∅ → ∃𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 (𝑥 ∩ 𝐴) = ∅) | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | axregscl 35272 | A version of ax-regs 35270 with a class variable instead of a wff variable. Axiom D in Gödel, The Consistency of the Axiom of Choice and of the Generalized Continuum Hypothesis with the Axioms of Set Theory (1940), p. 6. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 → ∃𝑦(𝑦 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ 𝑧 ∈ 𝐴))) | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | axreg 35271 | Derivation of ax-reg 9507 from ax-regs 35270 and Tarski's FOL axiom schemes. This demonstrates the sense in which ax-regs 35270 is a stronger version of ax-reg 9507. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑦 𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 → ∃𝑦(𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ 𝑧 ∈ 𝑥))) | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | fineqvomon 35262 | If all sets are finite, then the class of all natural numbers equals the proper class of all ordinal numbers. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (Fin = V → ω = On) | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | r1omfi 35248 | Hereditarily finite sets are finite sets. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ∪ (𝑅1 “ ω) ⊆ Fin | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | r1elcl 35241 | Each set of the cumulative hierarchy is closed under membership. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ (𝑅1‘𝐵) ∧ 𝐶 ∈ 𝐴) → 𝐶 ∈ (𝑅1‘𝐵)) | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | elwf 35240 | An element of a well-founded set is well-founded. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On) ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝐴) → 𝐵 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On)) | ||
| 29-Dec-2025 | gpg5edgnedg 48606 | Two consecutive (according to the numbering) inside vertices of the Petersen graph G(5,2) are not connected by an edge, but are connected by an edge in a 5-prism G(5,1). (Contributed by AV, 29-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ({〈1, 0〉, 〈1, 1〉} ∈ (Edg‘(5 gPetersenGr 1)) ∧ {〈1, 0〉, 〈1, 1〉} ∉ (Edg‘(5 gPetersenGr 2))) | ||
| 29-Dec-2025 | axregs 35283 | Derivation of ax-regs 35270 from the axioms of ZF set theory. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 29-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 → ∃𝑦(∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → 𝜑) ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑧 → 𝜑)))) | ||
| 29-Dec-2025 | ax-regs 35270 | A strong version of the Axiom of Regularity. It states that if there exists a set with property 𝜑, then there must exist a set with property 𝜑 such that none of its elements have property 𝜑. This axiom can be derived from the axioms of ZF set theory as shown in axregs 35283, but this derivation relies on ax-inf2 9562 and is thus not possible in a finitist context. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 29-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 → ∃𝑦(∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → 𝜑) ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑧 → 𝜑)))) | ||
| 29-Dec-2025 | optocl 5725 | Implicit substitution of class for ordered pair. (Contributed by NM, 5-Mar-1995.) Shorten and reduce axiom usage. (Revised by TM, 29-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = (𝐵 × 𝐶) & ⊢ (〈𝑥, 𝑦〉 = 𝐴 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓)) & ⊢ ((𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐶) → 𝜑) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝐷 → 𝜓) | ||
| 28-Dec-2025 | gpg5grlim 48569 | A local isomorphism between the two generalized Petersen graphs G(N,K) of order 10 (𝑁 = 5), which are the Petersen graph G(5,2) and the 5-prism G(5,1). (Contributed by AV, 28-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ( I ↾ ({0, 1} × (0..^5))) ∈ ((5 gPetersenGr 1) GraphLocIso (5 gPetersenGr 2)) | ||
| 28-Dec-2025 | clnbgr3stgrgrlim 48495 | If all (closed) neighborhoods of the vertices in two simple graphs with the same order induce a subgraph which is isomorphic to an 𝑁-star, then any bijection between the vertices is a local isomorphism between the two graphs. (Contributed by AV, 28-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0 & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑊 = (Vtx‘𝐻) ⇒ ⊢ (((𝐺 ∈ USGraph ∧ 𝐻 ∈ USGraph ∧ 𝐹:𝑉–1-1-onto→𝑊) ∧ ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝑉 (𝐺 ISubGr (𝐺 ClNeighbVtx 𝑥)) ≃𝑔𝑟 (StarGr‘𝑁) ∧ ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝑊 (𝐻 ISubGr (𝐻 ClNeighbVtx 𝑦)) ≃𝑔𝑟 (StarGr‘𝑁)) → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐺 GraphLocIso 𝐻)) | ||
| 28-Dec-2025 | grlimgredgex 48476 | Local isomorphisms between simple pseudographs map an edge onto an edge with an endpoint being the image of one of the endpoints of the first edge under the local isomorphism. (Contributed by AV, 28-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐻) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐻) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑋) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ 𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → {𝐴, 𝐵} ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ USPGraph) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐻 ∈ USPGraph) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐺 GraphLocIso 𝐻)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ∃𝑣 ∈ 𝑉 {(𝐹‘𝐴), 𝑣} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 28-Dec-2025 | grlimprclnbgrvtx 48475 | For two locally isomorphic graphs 𝐺 and 𝐻 and a vertex 𝐴 of 𝐺 there is a bijection 𝑓 mapping the closed neighborhood 𝑁 of 𝐴 onto the closed neighborhood 𝑀 of (𝐹‘𝐴), so that the mapped vertices of an edge {𝐴, 𝐵} containing the vertex 𝐴 is an edge between the vertices in 𝑀 containing the vertex (𝐹‘𝐴). (Contributed by AV, 28-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 ClNeighbVtx 𝐴) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐾 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐼 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑁} & ⊢ 𝑀 = (𝐻 ClNeighbVtx (𝐹‘𝐴)) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Edg‘𝐻) & ⊢ 𝐿 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐽 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑀} ⇒ ⊢ (((𝐺 ∈ USPGraph ∧ 𝐻 ∈ USPGraph) ∧ 𝐹 ∈ (𝐺 GraphLocIso 𝐻) ∧ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑊 ∧ {𝐴, 𝐵} ∈ 𝐼)) → ∃𝑓(𝑓:𝑁–1-1-onto→𝑀 ∧ ({(𝐹‘𝐴), (𝑓‘𝐵)} ∈ 𝐿 ∨ {(𝐹‘𝐴), (𝑓‘𝐴)} ∈ 𝐿))) | ||
| 28-Dec-2025 | clnbupgreli 48311 | A member of the closed neighborhood of a vertex in a pseudograph. (Contributed by AV, 28-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐺 ∈ UPGraph ∧ 𝑁 ∈ (𝐺 ClNeighbVtx 𝐾)) → (𝑁 = 𝐾 ∨ {𝑁, 𝐾} ∈ 𝐸)) | ||
| 28-Dec-2025 | elirrvALT 9526 | Alternate proof of elirrv 9512, shorter but using more axioms. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 28-Dec-2025.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ¬ 𝑥 ∈ 𝑥 | ||
| 27-Dec-2025 | grlimgrtrilem1 48477 | Lemma 3 for grlimgrtri 48479. (Contributed by AV, 24-Aug-2025.) (Proof shortened by AV, 27-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 ClNeighbVtx 𝑎) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐾 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐼 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑁} ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐺 ∈ UHGraph ∧ ({𝑎, 𝑏} ∈ 𝐼 ∧ {𝑎, 𝑐} ∈ 𝐼 ∧ {𝑏, 𝑐} ∈ 𝐼)) → ({𝑎, 𝑏} ∈ 𝐾 ∧ {𝑎, 𝑐} ∈ 𝐾 ∧ {𝑏, 𝑐} ∈ 𝐾)) | ||
| 27-Dec-2025 | grlimpredg 48474 | For two locally isomorphic graphs 𝐺 and 𝐻 and a vertex 𝐴 of 𝐺 there is a bijection 𝑓 mapping the closed neighborhood 𝑁 of 𝐴 onto the closed neighborhood 𝑀 of (𝐹‘𝐴), so that the mapped vertices of an edge {𝐴, 𝐵} containing the vertex 𝐴 is an edge in 𝐻. (Contributed by AV, 27-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 ClNeighbVtx 𝐴) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐾 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐼 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑁} & ⊢ 𝑀 = (𝐻 ClNeighbVtx (𝐹‘𝐴)) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Edg‘𝐻) & ⊢ 𝐿 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐽 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑀} ⇒ ⊢ (((𝐺 ∈ USPGraph ∧ 𝐻 ∈ USPGraph) ∧ 𝐹 ∈ (𝐺 GraphLocIso 𝐻) ∧ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑊 ∧ {𝐴, 𝐵} ∈ 𝐼)) → ∃𝑓(𝑓:𝑁–1-1-onto→𝑀 ∧ {(𝑓‘𝐴), (𝑓‘𝐵)} ∈ 𝐽)) | ||
| 27-Dec-2025 | grlimprclnbgredg 48473 | For two locally isomorphic graphs 𝐺 and 𝐻 and a vertex 𝐴 of 𝐺 there is a bijection 𝑓 mapping the closed neighborhood 𝑁 of 𝐴 onto the closed neighborhood 𝑀 of (𝐹‘𝐴), so that the mapped vertices of an edge {𝐴, 𝐵} containing the vertex 𝐴 is an edge between the vertices in 𝑀. (Contributed by AV, 27-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 ClNeighbVtx 𝐴) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐾 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐼 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑁} & ⊢ 𝑀 = (𝐻 ClNeighbVtx (𝐹‘𝐴)) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Edg‘𝐻) & ⊢ 𝐿 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐽 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑀} ⇒ ⊢ (((𝐺 ∈ USPGraph ∧ 𝐻 ∈ USPGraph) ∧ 𝐹 ∈ (𝐺 GraphLocIso 𝐻) ∧ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑊 ∧ {𝐴, 𝐵} ∈ 𝐼)) → ∃𝑓(𝑓:𝑁–1-1-onto→𝑀 ∧ {(𝑓‘𝐴), (𝑓‘𝐵)} ∈ 𝐿)) | ||
| 27-Dec-2025 | elirrv 9512 | The membership relation is irreflexive: no set is a member of itself. Theorem 105 of [Suppes] p. 54. This is trivial to prove from zfregfr 9525 and efrirr 5611 (see elirrvALT 9526), but this proof is direct from ax-reg 9507. (Contributed by NM, 19-Aug-1993.) Reduce axiom dependencies and make use of ax-reg 9507 directly. (Revised by BTernaryTau, 27-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ¬ 𝑥 ∈ 𝑥 | ||
| 25-Dec-2025 | grlimprclnbgr 48472 | For two locally isomorphic graphs 𝐺 and 𝐻 and a vertex 𝐴 of 𝐺 there are two bijections 𝑓 and 𝑔 mapping the closed neighborhood 𝑁 of 𝐴 onto the closed neighborhood 𝑀 of (𝐹‘𝐴) and the edges between the vertices in 𝑁 onto the edges between the vertices in 𝑀, so that the mapped vertices of an edge {𝐴, 𝐵} containing the vertex 𝐴 is an edge between the vertices in 𝑀. (Contributed by AV, 25-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 ClNeighbVtx 𝐴) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐾 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐼 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑁} & ⊢ 𝑀 = (𝐻 ClNeighbVtx (𝐹‘𝐴)) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Edg‘𝐻) & ⊢ 𝐿 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐽 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑀} ⇒ ⊢ (((𝐺 ∈ USPGraph ∧ 𝐻 ∈ USPGraph) ∧ 𝐹 ∈ (𝐺 GraphLocIso 𝐻) ∧ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑊 ∧ {𝐴, 𝐵} ∈ 𝐼)) → ∃𝑓∃𝑔(𝑓:𝑁–1-1-onto→𝑀 ∧ 𝑔:𝐾–1-1-onto→𝐿 ∧ {(𝑓‘𝐴), (𝑓‘𝐵)} = (𝑔‘{𝐴, 𝐵}))) | ||
| 25-Dec-2025 | grlimedgclnbgr 48471 | For two locally isomorphic graphs 𝐺 and 𝐻 and a vertex 𝐴 of 𝐺 there are two bijections 𝑓 and 𝑔 mapping the closed neighborhood 𝑁 of 𝐴 onto the closed neighborhood 𝑀 of (𝐹‘𝐴) and the edges between the vertices in 𝑁 onto the edges between the vertices in 𝑀, so that the mapped vertices of an edge 𝐸 containing the vertex 𝐴 is an edge between the vertices in 𝑀. (Contributed by AV, 25-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 ClNeighbVtx 𝐴) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐾 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐼 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑁} & ⊢ 𝑀 = (𝐻 ClNeighbVtx (𝐹‘𝐴)) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Edg‘𝐻) & ⊢ 𝐿 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐽 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑀} ⇒ ⊢ (((𝐺 ∈ USPGraph ∧ 𝐻 ∈ USPGraph) ∧ 𝐹 ∈ (𝐺 GraphLocIso 𝐻) ∧ (𝐸 ∈ 𝐼 ∧ 𝐴 ∈ 𝐸)) → ∃𝑓∃𝑔(𝑓:𝑁–1-1-onto→𝑀 ∧ 𝑔:𝐾–1-1-onto→𝐿 ∧ (𝑓 “ 𝐸) = (𝑔‘𝐸))) | ||
| 25-Dec-2025 | clnbgrvtxedg 48470 | An edge 𝐸 containing a vertex 𝐴 is an edge in the closed neighborhood of this vertex 𝐴. (Contributed by AV, 25-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 ClNeighbVtx 𝐴) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐾 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐼 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑁} ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐺 ∈ UHGraph ∧ 𝐸 ∈ 𝐼 ∧ 𝐴 ∈ 𝐸) → 𝐸 ∈ 𝐾) | ||
| 23-Dec-2025 | zsoring 28401 | The surreal integers form an ordered ring. Note that we have to restrict the operations here since No is a proper class. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 23-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ℤs = (Base‘𝐾) & ⊢ ( +s ↾ (ℤs × ℤs)) = (+g‘𝐾) & ⊢ ( ·s ↾ (ℤs × ℤs)) = (.r‘𝐾) & ⊢ ( ≤s ∩ (ℤs × ℤs)) = (le‘𝐾) & ⊢ 0s = (0g‘𝐾) ⇒ ⊢ 𝐾 ∈ oRing | ||
| 12-Dec-2025 | z12subscl 28471 | The dyadics are closed under subtraction. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 12-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℤs[1/2] ∧ 𝐵 ∈ ℤs[1/2]) → (𝐴 -s 𝐵) ∈ ℤs[1/2]) | ||
| 11-Dec-2025 | z12shalf 28472 | Half of a dyadic is a dyadic. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℤs[1/2] → (𝐴 /su 2s) ∈ ℤs[1/2]) | ||
| 11-Dec-2025 | z12addscl 28469 | The dyadics are closed under addition. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℤs[1/2] ∧ 𝐵 ∈ ℤs[1/2]) → (𝐴 +s 𝐵) ∈ ℤs[1/2]) | ||
| 11-Dec-2025 | z12no 28468 | A dyadic is a surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℤs[1/2] → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 11-Dec-2025 | avglts2d 28446 | Ordering property for average. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 <s 𝐵 ↔ ((𝐴 +s 𝐵) /su 2s) <s 𝐵)) | ||
| 11-Dec-2025 | avglts1d 28445 | Ordering property for average. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 <s 𝐵 ↔ 𝐴 <s ((𝐴 +s 𝐵) /su 2s))) | ||
| 11-Dec-2025 | pw2ltmuldivs2d 28443 | Surreal less-than relationship between division and multiplication for powers of two. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (((2s↑s𝑁) ·s 𝐴) <s 𝐵 ↔ 𝐴 <s (𝐵 /su (2s↑s𝑁)))) | ||
| 11-Dec-2025 | pw2ltdivmulsd 28442 | Surreal less-than relationship between division and multiplication for powers of two. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 /su (2s↑s𝑁)) <s 𝐵 ↔ 𝐴 <s ((2s↑s𝑁) ·s 𝐵))) | ||
| 11-Dec-2025 | pw2divscan4d 28436 | Cancellation law for divison by powers of two. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 ∈ ℕ0s) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 /su (2s↑s𝑁)) = (((2s↑s𝑀) ·s 𝐴) /su (2s↑s(𝑁 +s 𝑀)))) | ||
| 11-Dec-2025 | pw2divsassd 28435 | An associative law for division by powers of two. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 ·s 𝐵) /su (2s↑s𝑁)) = (𝐴 ·s (𝐵 /su (2s↑s𝑁)))) | ||
| 11-Dec-2025 | zexpscl 28426 | Closure law for surreal integer exponentiation. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℤs ∧ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) → (𝐴↑s𝑁) ∈ ℤs) | ||
| 11-Dec-2025 | nobdaymin 27745 | Any non-empty class of surreals has a birthday-minimal element. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ⊆ No ∧ 𝐴 ≠ ∅) → ∃𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ( bday ‘𝑥) = ∩ ( bday “ 𝐴)) | ||
| 10-Dec-2025 | sinnpoly 47339 | Sine function is not a polynomial with complex coefficients. Indeed, it has infinitely many zeros but is not constant zero, contrary to fta1 26274. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 10-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ¬ sin ∈ (Poly‘ℂ) | ||
| 10-Dec-2025 | tannpoly 47338 | The tangent function is not a polynomial with complex coefficients, as it is not defined on the whole complex plane. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 10-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ¬ tan ∈ (Poly‘ℂ) | ||
| 8-Dec-2025 | cjnpoly 47337 | Complex conjugation operator is not a polynomial with complex coefficients. Indeed; if it was, then multiplying 𝑥 conjugate by 𝑥 itself and adding 1 would yield a nowhere-zero non-constant polynomial, contrary to the fta 27043. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 8-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ¬ ∗ ∈ (Poly‘ℂ) | ||
| 6-Dec-2025 | vonf1owev 35290 | If 𝐹 is a bijection from the universe to the ordinals, then 𝑅 well-orders the universe. This is the ZFC version of (2 → 3) in https://tinyurl.com/hamkins-gblac. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 6-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑅 = {〈𝑥, 𝑦〉 ∣ (𝐹‘𝑥) ∈ (𝐹‘𝑦)} ⇒ ⊢ (𝐹:V–1-1-onto→On → 𝑅 We V) | ||
| 5-Dec-2025 | antnestALT 35876 | Alternative proof of antnest 35871 from the valid schema ((((⊤ → 𝜑) → 𝜑) → 𝜓) → 𝜓) using laws of nested antecedents. Our proof uses only the laws antnestlaw1 35873 and antnestlaw3 35875. (Contributed by Adrian Ducourtial, 5-Dec-2025.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ((((((⊤ → 𝜑) → 𝜓) → 𝜓) → 𝜑) → 𝜓) → 𝜓) | ||
| 5-Dec-2025 | antnestlaw3 35875 | A law of nested antecedents. Compare with looinv 203. (Contributed by Adrian Ducourtial, 5-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((((𝜑 → 𝜓) → 𝜒) → 𝜒) ↔ (((𝜑 → 𝜒) → 𝜓) → 𝜓)) | ||
| 5-Dec-2025 | antnestlaw2 35874 | A law of nested antecedents. (Contributed by Adrian Ducourtial, 5-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((((𝜑 → 𝜓) → 𝜓) → 𝜒) ↔ (((𝜑 → 𝜒) → 𝜓) → 𝜒)) | ||
| 5-Dec-2025 | antnestlaw1 35873 | A law of nested antecedents. The converse direction is a subschema of pm2.27 42. (Contributed by Adrian Ducourtial, 5-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((((𝜑 → 𝜓) → 𝜓) → 𝜓) ↔ (𝜑 → 𝜓)) | ||
| 5-Dec-2025 | antnestlaw3lem 35872 | Lemma for antnestlaw3 35875. (Contributed by Adrian Ducourtial, 5-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (¬ (((𝜑 → 𝜓) → 𝜒) → 𝜒) → ¬ (((𝜑 → 𝜒) → 𝜓) → 𝜓)) | ||
| 5-Dec-2025 | onvf1od 35289 | If 𝐺 is a global choice function, then 𝐹 is a bijection from the ordinals to the universe. This is the ZFC version of (1 → 2) in https://tinyurl.com/hamkins-gblac. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 5-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑧(𝑧 ≠ ∅ → (𝐺‘𝑧) ∈ 𝑧)) & ⊢ 𝑀 = ∩ {𝑥 ∈ On ∣ ∃𝑦 ∈ (𝑅1‘𝑥) ¬ 𝑦 ∈ ran 𝑤} & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺‘((𝑅1‘𝑀) ∖ ran 𝑤)) & ⊢ 𝐹 = recs((𝑤 ∈ V ↦ 𝑁)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:On–1-1-onto→V) | ||
| 5-Dec-2025 | z12zsodd 28474 | A dyadic fraction is either an integer or an odd number divided by a positive power of two. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 5-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℤs[1/2] → (𝐴 ∈ ℤs ∨ ∃𝑥 ∈ ℤs ∃𝑦 ∈ ℕs 𝐴 = (((2s ·s 𝑥) +s 1s ) /su (2s↑s𝑦)))) | ||
| 5-Dec-2025 | ltsrecd 27794 | A comparison law for surreals considered as cuts of sets of surreals. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 5-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 <<s 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 <<s 𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 = (𝐴 |s 𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 = (𝐶 |s 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 <s 𝑌 ↔ (∃𝑐 ∈ 𝐶 𝑋 ≤s 𝑐 ∨ ∃𝑏 ∈ 𝐵 𝑏 ≤s 𝑌))) | ||
| 5-Dec-2025 | lesrecd 27792 | A comparison law for surreals considered as cuts of sets of surreals. Definition from [Conway] p. 4. Theorem 4 of [Alling] p. 186. Theorem 2.5 of [Gonshor] p. 9. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 5-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 <<s 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 <<s 𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 = (𝐴 |s 𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 = (𝐶 |s 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 ≤s 𝑌 ↔ (∀𝑑 ∈ 𝐷 𝑋 <s 𝑑 ∧ ∀𝑎 ∈ 𝐴 𝑎 <s 𝑌))) | ||
| 4-Dec-2025 | onvf1odlem4 35288 | Lemma for onvf1od 35289. If the range of 𝐹 does not exist, then it must equal the universe. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 4-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑧(𝑧 ≠ ∅ → (𝐺‘𝑧) ∈ 𝑧)) & ⊢ 𝑀 = ∩ {𝑥 ∈ On ∣ ∃𝑦 ∈ (𝑅1‘𝑥) ¬ 𝑦 ∈ ran 𝑤} & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺‘((𝑅1‘𝑀) ∖ ran 𝑤)) & ⊢ 𝐹 = recs((𝑤 ∈ V ↦ 𝑁)) & ⊢ 𝐵 = ∩ {𝑢 ∈ On ∣ ∃𝑣 ∈ (𝑅1‘𝑢) ¬ 𝑣 ∈ (𝐹 “ 𝑡)} & ⊢ 𝐶 = (𝐺‘((𝑅1‘𝐵) ∖ (𝐹 “ 𝑡))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (¬ ran 𝐹 ∈ V → ran 𝐹 = V)) | ||
| 2-Dec-2025 | onvf1odlem3 35287 | Lemma for onvf1od 35289. The value of 𝐹 at an ordinal 𝐴. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 2-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑀 = ∩ {𝑥 ∈ On ∣ ∃𝑦 ∈ (𝑅1‘𝑥) ¬ 𝑦 ∈ ran 𝑤} & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺‘((𝑅1‘𝑀) ∖ ran 𝑤)) & ⊢ 𝐹 = recs((𝑤 ∈ V ↦ 𝑁)) & ⊢ 𝐵 = ∩ {𝑢 ∈ On ∣ ∃𝑣 ∈ (𝑅1‘𝑢) ¬ 𝑣 ∈ (𝐹 “ 𝐴)} & ⊢ 𝐶 = (𝐺‘((𝑅1‘𝐵) ∖ (𝐹 “ 𝐴))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ On → (𝐹‘𝐴) = 𝐶) | ||
| 2-Dec-2025 | onvf1odlem2 35286 | Lemma for onvf1od 35289. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 2-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑧(𝑧 ≠ ∅ → (𝐺‘𝑧) ∈ 𝑧)) & ⊢ 𝑀 = ∩ {𝑥 ∈ On ∣ ∃𝑦 ∈ (𝑅1‘𝑥) ¬ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐴} & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺‘((𝑅1‘𝑀) ∖ 𝐴)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → 𝑁 ∈ ((𝑅1‘𝑀) ∖ 𝐴))) | ||
| 2-Dec-2025 | onvf1odlem1 35285 | Lemma for onvf1od 35289. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 2-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → ∃𝑥 ∈ On ∃𝑦 ∈ (𝑅1‘𝑥) ¬ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐴) | ||
| 1-Dec-2025 | sn-msqgt0d 42931 | A nonzero square is positive. (Contributed by SN, 1-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 0 < (𝐴 · 𝐴)) | ||
| 1-Dec-2025 | sn-mullt0d 42930 | The product of two negative numbers is positive. (Contributed by SN, 1-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 < 0) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 < 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 0 < (𝐴 · 𝐵)) | ||
| 1-Dec-2025 | elabgt 3614 | Membership in a class abstraction, using implicit substitution. (Closed theorem version of elabg 3619.) (Contributed by NM, 7-Nov-2005.) (Proof shortened by Andrew Salmon, 8-Jun-2011.) Reduce axiom usage. (Revised by GG, 12-Oct-2024.) (Proof shortened by Wolf Lammen, 11-May-2025.) (Proof shortened by SN, 1-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝐴 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓))) → (𝐴 ∈ {𝑥 ∣ 𝜑} ↔ 𝜓)) | ||
| 30-Nov-2025 | eluz3nn 12839 | An integer greater than or equal to 3 is a positive integer. (Contributed by Alexander van der Vekens, 17-Sep-2018.) (Proof shortened by AV, 30-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘3) → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ) | ||
| 28-Nov-2025 | eqcuts3 27796 | A variant of the simplicity theorem - if 𝐵 lies between the cut sets of 𝐴 but none of its options do, then 𝐴 = 𝐵. Theorem 11 of [Conway] p. 23. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 28-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐿 <<s 𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 <<s 𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 = (𝐿 |s 𝑅)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 = (𝑀 |s 𝑆)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐿 <<s {𝐵}) & ⊢ (𝜑 → {𝐵} <<s 𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝑂 ∈ (𝑀 ∪ 𝑆) ¬ (𝐿 <<s {𝑥𝑂} ∧ {𝑥𝑂} <<s 𝑅)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 = 𝐵) | ||
| 27-Nov-2025 | difmodm1lt 47813 | The difference between an integer modulo a positive integer and the integer decreased by 1 modulo the same modulus is less than the modulus decreased by 1 (if the modulus is greater than 2). This theorem would not be valid for an odd 𝐴 and 𝑁 = 2, since ((𝐴 mod 𝑁) − ((𝐴 − 1) mod 𝑁)) would be (1 − 0) = 1 which is not less than (𝑁 − 1) = 1. (Contributed by AV, 6-Jun-2012.) (Proof shortened by SN, 27-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℤ ∧ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ ∧ 2 < 𝑁) → ((𝐴 mod 𝑁) − ((𝐴 − 1) mod 𝑁)) < (𝑁 − 1)) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | cmdlan 50147 | To each colimit of a diagram there is a corresponding left Kan extention of the diagram along a functor to a terminal category. The morphism parts coincide, while the object parts are one-to-one correspondent (diag1f1o 50009). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 1 ∈ TermCat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐷 Func 1 )) & ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc 1 ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 = ((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑋)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋((𝐶 Colimit 𝐷)‘𝐹)𝑀 ↔ 𝑌(𝐺(〈𝐷, 1 〉 Lan 𝐶)𝐹)𝑀)) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | lmdran 50146 | To each limit of a diagram there is a corresponding right Kan extention of the diagram along a functor to a terminal category. The morphism parts coincide, while the object parts are one-to-one correspondent (diag1f1o 50009). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 1 ∈ TermCat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐷 Func 1 )) & ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc 1 ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 = ((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑋)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋((𝐶 Limit 𝐷)‘𝐹)𝑀 ↔ 𝑌(𝐺(〈𝐷, 1 〉 Ran 𝐶)𝐹)𝑀)) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | ranval3 50106 | The set of right Kan extensions is the set of universal pairs. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘(𝐷 FuncCat 𝐸)) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘(𝐶 FuncCat 𝐸)) & ⊢ 𝐾 = (〈𝐷, 𝐸〉 −∘F 𝐹) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷) → (𝐹(〈𝐶, 𝐷〉 Ran 𝐸)𝑋) = (( oppFunc ‘𝐾)(𝑂 UP 𝑃)𝑋)) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | ffthoppf 49640 | The opposite functor of a fully faithful functor is also full and faithful. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ ((𝐶 Full 𝐷) ∩ (𝐶 Faith 𝐷))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) ∈ ((𝑂 Full 𝑃) ∩ (𝑂 Faith 𝑃))) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | fthoppf 49639 | The opposite functor of a faithful functor is also faithful. Proposition 3.43(c) in [Adamek] p. 39. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Faith 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) ∈ (𝑂 Faith 𝑃)) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | fulloppf 49638 | The opposite functor of a full functor is also full. Proposition 3.43(d) in [Adamek] p. 39. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Full 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) ∈ (𝑂 Full 𝑃)) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | cofuoppf 49625 | Composition of opposite functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐾) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (( oppFunc ‘𝐺) ∘func ( oppFunc ‘𝐹)) = ( oppFunc ‘𝐾)) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | mullt0b2d 42929 | When the second term is negative, the first term is positive iff the product is negative. (Contributed by SN, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 < 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (0 < 𝐴 ↔ (𝐴 · 𝐵) < 0)) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | mullt0b1d 42928 | When the first term is negative, the second term is positive iff the product is negative. (Contributed by SN, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 < 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (0 < 𝐵 ↔ (𝐴 · 𝐵) < 0)) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | mulltgt0d 42927 | Negative times positive is negative. (Contributed by SN, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 < 0) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 0 < 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 · 𝐵) < 0) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | sn-reclt0d 42926 | The reciprocal of a negative real is negative. (Contributed by SN, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 < 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (1 /ℝ 𝐴) < 0) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | sn-recgt0d 42922 | The reciprocal of a positive real is positive. (Contributed by SN, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 0 < 𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 0 < (1 /ℝ 𝐴)) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | prcofdiag 49869 | A diagonal functor post-composed by a pre-composition functor is another diagonal functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐸) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐸 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐷, 𝐶〉 −∘F 𝐹) = 𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 ∘func 𝐿) = 𝑀) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | prcofdiag1 49868 | A constant functor pre-composed by a functor is another constant functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐸) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐸 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑋) ∘func 𝐹) = ((1st ‘𝑀)‘𝑋)) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | uptr2a 49697 | Universal property and fully faithful functor surjective on objects. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 = ((1st ‘𝐾)‘𝑋)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 ∘func 𝐾) = 𝐹) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ((𝐶 Full 𝐷) ∩ (𝐶 Faith 𝐷))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (1st ‘𝐾):𝐴–onto→𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋(𝐹(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑍)𝑀 ↔ 𝑌(𝐺(𝐷 UP 𝐸)𝑍)𝑀)) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | uptr2 49696 | Universal property and fully faithful functor surjective on objects. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 = (𝑅‘𝑋)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅:𝐴–onto→𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅((𝐶 Full 𝐷) ∩ (𝐶 Faith 𝐷))𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 ∘func 〈𝑅, 𝑆〉) = 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐿) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋(〈𝐹, 𝐺〉(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑍)𝑀 ↔ 𝑌(〈𝐾, 𝐿〉(𝐷 UP 𝐸)𝑍)𝑀)) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | xpco2 49332 | Composition of a Cartesian product with a function. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐹:𝐴⟶𝐵 → ((𝐵 × 𝐶) ∘ 𝐹) = (𝐴 × 𝐶)) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | ffvbr 49331 | Relation with function value. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐹:𝐴⟶𝐵 ∧ 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) → 𝑋𝐹(𝐹‘𝑋)) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | rerecid2d 42890 | Multiplication of a number and its reciprocal. (Contributed by SN, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1 /ℝ 𝐴) · 𝐴) = 1) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | rerecidd 42889 | Multiplication of a number and its reciprocal. (Contributed by SN, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 · (1 /ℝ 𝐴)) = 1) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | sn-rereccld 42887 | Closure law for reciprocal. (Contributed by SN, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (1 /ℝ 𝐴) ∈ ℝ) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | rediveq0d 42881 | A ratio is zero iff the numerator is zero. (Contributed by SN, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 /ℝ 𝐵) = 0 ↔ 𝐴 = 0)) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | redivcan3d 42880 | A cancellation law for division. (Contributed by SN, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐵 · 𝐴) /ℝ 𝐵) = 𝐴) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | redivcan2d 42879 | A cancellation law for division. (Contributed by SN, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐵 · (𝐴 /ℝ 𝐵)) = 𝐴) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | redivmuld 42877 | Relationship between division and multiplication. (Contributed by SN, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 /ℝ 𝐶) = 𝐵 ↔ (𝐶 · 𝐵) = 𝐴)) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | sn-redivcld 42876 | Closure law for real division. (Contributed by SN, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 /ℝ 𝐵) ∈ ℝ) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | rediveud 42875 | Existential uniqueness of real quotients. (Contributed by SN, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ∃!𝑥 ∈ ℝ (𝐵 · 𝑥) = 𝐴) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | redivvald 42874 | Value of real division, which is the (unique) real 𝑥 such that (𝐵 · 𝑥) = 𝐴. (Contributed by SN, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 /ℝ 𝐵) = (℩𝑥 ∈ ℝ (𝐵 · 𝑥) = 𝐴)) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | df-rediv 42873 | Define division between real numbers. This operator saves ax-mulcom 11102 over df-div 11808 in certain situations. (Contributed by SN, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ /ℝ = (𝑥 ∈ ℝ, 𝑦 ∈ (ℝ ∖ {0}) ↦ (℩𝑧 ∈ ℝ (𝑦 · 𝑧) = 𝑥)) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | uniqsw 8721 | The union of a quotient set. More restrictive antecedent; kept for backward compatibility; for new work, prefer uniqs 8720. (Contributed by NM, 9-Dec-2008.) (Proof shortened by AV, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 → ∪ (𝐴 / 𝑅) = (𝑅 “ 𝐴)) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | ecelqsw 8715 | Membership of an equivalence class in a quotient set. More restrictive antecedent; kept for backward compatibility; for new work, prefer ecelqs 8714. (Contributed by Jeff Madsen, 10-Jun-2010.) (Revised by Mario Carneiro, 9-Jul-2014.) (Proof shortened by AV, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝐴) → [𝐵]𝑅 ∈ (𝐴 / 𝑅)) | ||
| 24-Nov-2025 | f1omo 49368 | There is at most one element in the function value of a constant function whose output is 1o. (An artifact of our function value definition.) Proof could be significantly shortened by fvconstdomi 49367 assuming ax-un 7689 (see f1omoALT 49370). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Sep-2024.) (Proof shortened by SN, 24-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = (𝐴 × {1o})) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ∃*𝑦 𝑦 ∈ (𝐹‘𝑋)) | ||
| 24-Nov-2025 | mulgt0b2d 42923 | Biconditional, deductive form of mulgt0 11223. The first factor is positive iff the product is. (Contributed by SN, 24-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 0 < 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (0 < 𝐴 ↔ 0 < (𝐴 · 𝐵))) | ||
| 24-Nov-2025 | sn-remul0ord 42840 | A product is zero iff one of its factors are zero. (Contributed by SN, 24-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 · 𝐵) = 0 ↔ (𝐴 = 0 ∨ 𝐵 = 0))) | ||
| 23-Nov-2025 | lgricngricex 48605 | There are two different locally isomorphic graphs which are not isomorphic. (Contributed by AV, 23-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑔∃ℎ(𝑔 ≃𝑙𝑔𝑟 ℎ ∧ ¬ 𝑔 ≃𝑔𝑟 ℎ) | ||
| 23-Nov-2025 | dmqsblocks 39288 | If the pet 39286 span (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) partitions 𝐴, then every block 𝑢 ∈ 𝐴 is of the form [𝑣] for some 𝑣 that not only lies in the domain but also has at least one internal element 𝑐 and at least one 𝑅-target 𝑏 (cf. also the comments of qseq 39054). It makes explicit that pet 39286 gives active representatives for each block, without ever forcing 𝑣 = 𝑢. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 23-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((dom (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) / (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴))) = 𝐴 → ∀𝑢 ∈ 𝐴 ∃𝑣 ∈ dom (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴))∃𝑏∃𝑐(𝑢 = [𝑣](𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) ∧ 𝑐 ∈ 𝑣 ∧ 𝑣𝑅𝑏)) | ||
| 23-Nov-2025 | eceldmqsxrncnvepres2 38758 | An (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴))-coset in its domain quotient. In the pet 39286 span (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)), a block [ B ] lies in the domain quotient exactly when its representative 𝐵 belongs to 𝐴 and actually fires at least one arrow (has some 𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 and some 𝑦 with 𝐵𝑅𝑦). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 23-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑊 ∧ 𝑅 ∈ 𝑋) → ([𝐵](𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) ∈ (dom (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) / (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴))) ↔ (𝐵 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ ∃𝑥 𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ ∃𝑦 𝐵𝑅𝑦))) | ||
| 23-Nov-2025 | eceldmqsxrncnvepres 38757 | An (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴))-coset in its domain quotient. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 23-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑊 ∧ 𝑅 ∈ 𝑋) → ([𝐵](𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) ∈ (dom (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) / (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴))) ↔ (𝐵 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ 𝐵 ≠ ∅ ∧ [𝐵]𝑅 ≠ ∅))) | ||
| 23-Nov-2025 | eldmxrncnvepres2 38756 | Element of the domain of the range product with restricted converse epsilon relation. This identifies the domain of the pet 39286 span (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)): a 𝐵 belongs to the domain of the span exactly when 𝐵 is in 𝐴 and has at least one 𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 and 𝑦 with 𝐵𝑅𝑦. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 23-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐵 ∈ 𝑉 → (𝐵 ∈ dom (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) ↔ (𝐵 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ ∃𝑥 𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ ∃𝑦 𝐵𝑅𝑦))) | ||
| 23-Nov-2025 | eldmxrncnvepres 38755 | Element of the domain of the range product with restricted converse epsilon relation. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 23-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐵 ∈ 𝑉 → (𝐵 ∈ dom (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) ↔ (𝐵 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ 𝐵 ≠ ∅ ∧ [𝐵]𝑅 ≠ ∅))) | ||
| 23-Nov-2025 | dmxrncnvepres 38753 | Domain of the range product with restricted converse epsilon relation. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 23-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ dom (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) = (dom (𝑅 ↾ 𝐴) ∖ {∅}) | ||
| 23-Nov-2025 | dmxrncnvep 38710 | Domain of the range product with converse epsilon relation. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 23-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ dom (𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E ) = (dom 𝑅 ∖ {∅}) | ||
| 23-Nov-2025 | dmcnvep 38709 | Domain of converse epsilon relation. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 30-Jan-2018.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 23-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ dom ◡ E = (V ∖ {∅}) | ||
| 23-Nov-2025 | eldmres3 38604 | Elementhood in the domain of a restriction. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 23-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐵 ∈ 𝑉 → (𝐵 ∈ dom (𝑅 ↾ 𝐴) ↔ (𝐵 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ [𝐵]𝑅 ≠ ∅))) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | gpg5ngric 48604 | The two generalized Petersen graphs G(5,K) of order 10, which are the Petersen graph G(5,2) and the 5-prism G(5,1), are not isomorphic. (Contributed by AV, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ¬ (5 gPetersenGr 1) ≃𝑔𝑟 (5 gPetersenGr 2) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | pg4cyclnex 48603 | In the Petersen graph G(5,2), there is no cycle of length 4. (Contributed by AV, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ¬ ∃𝑝∃𝑓(𝑓(Cycles‘(5 gPetersenGr 2))𝑝 ∧ (♯‘𝑓) = 4) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | gpg5grlic 48570 | The two generalized Petersen graphs G(N,K) of order 10 (𝑁 = 5), which are the Petersen graph G(5,2) and the 5-prism G(5,1), are locally isomorphic. (Contributed by AV, 29-Sep-2025.) (Proof shortened by AV, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (5 gPetersenGr 1) ≃𝑙𝑔𝑟 (5 gPetersenGr 2) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | gpg3nbgrvtx1 48554 | In a generalized Petersen graph 𝐺, every inside vertex has exactly three (different) neighbors. (Contributed by AV, 3-Sep-2025.) (Proof shortened by AV, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐽 = (1..^(⌈‘(𝑁 / 2))) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑁 gPetersenGr 𝐾) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑈 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ (((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘3) ∧ 𝐾 ∈ 𝐽) ∧ (𝑋 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ (1st ‘𝑋) = 1)) → (♯‘𝑈) = 3) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | modm1nem2 47823 | A nonnegative integer less than a modulus greater than 4 minus one/minus two are not equal modulo the modulus. (Contributed by AV, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘5) ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) → ((𝑌 − 1) mod 𝑁) ≠ ((𝑌 − 2) mod 𝑁)) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | modm1nep2 47822 | A nonnegative integer less than a modulus greater than 4 plus one/minus two are not equal modulo the modulus. (Contributed by AV, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘5) ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) → ((𝑌 − 1) mod 𝑁) ≠ ((𝑌 + 2) mod 𝑁)) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | modp2nep1 47821 | A nonnegative integer less than a modulus greater than 4 plus one/plus two are not equal modulo the modulus. (Contributed by AV, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘5) ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) → ((𝑌 + 2) mod 𝑁) ≠ ((𝑌 + 1) mod 𝑁)) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | modm2nep1 47820 | A nonnegative integer less than a modulus greater than 4 plus one/minus two are not equal modulo the modulus. (Contributed by AV, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘5) ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) → ((𝑌 − 2) mod 𝑁) ≠ ((𝑌 + 1) mod 𝑁)) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | dmxrn 38708 | Domain of the range product. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 19-Apr-2020.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ dom (𝑅 ⋉ 𝑆) = (dom 𝑅 ∩ dom 𝑆) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | brxrncnvep 38707 | The range product with converse epsilon relation. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 22-Jun-2020.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑊 ∧ 𝐶 ∈ 𝑋) → (𝐴(𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E )〈𝐵, 𝐶〉 ↔ (𝐶 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ 𝐴𝑅𝐵))) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | bdayle 27908 | A condition for bounding a birthday above. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑋 ∈ No ∧ Ord 𝑂) → (( bday ‘𝑋) ⊆ 𝑂 ↔ ∀𝑦 ∈ ( O ‘( bday ‘𝑋))( bday ‘𝑦) ∈ 𝑂)) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | bdayiun 27907 | The birthday of a surreal is the least upper bound of the successors of the birthdays of its options. This is the definition of the birthday of a combinatorial game in the Lean Combinatorial Game Theory library at https://github.com/vihdzp/combinatorial-games. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ No → ( bday ‘𝐴) = ∪ 𝑥 ∈ ( O ‘( bday ‘𝐴))suc ( bday ‘𝑥)) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | nn0absidi 15393 | A nonnegative integer is its own absolute value (inference form). (Contributed by AV, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0 ⇒ ⊢ (abs‘𝑁) = 𝑁 | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | nn0absid 15392 | A nonnegative integer is its own absolute value. (Contributed by AV, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ ℕ0 → (abs‘𝑁) = 𝑁) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | eluz5nn 12841 | An integer greater than or equal to 5 is a positive integer. (Contributed by AV, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘5) → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | eceldmqs 8734 | 𝑅-coset in its domain quotient. This is the bridge between 𝐴 in the domain and its block [𝐴]𝑅 in its domain quotient. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 17-Apr-2019.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 → ([𝐴]𝑅 ∈ (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅) ↔ 𝐴 ∈ dom 𝑅)) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | ecelqsdmb 8733 | 𝑅-coset of 𝐵 in a quotient set, biconditional version. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 17-Apr-2019.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (((𝑅 ↾ 𝐴) ∈ 𝑉 ∧ dom 𝑅 = 𝐴) → ([𝐵]𝑅 ∈ (𝐴 / 𝑅) ↔ 𝐵 ∈ 𝐴)) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | ecelqs 8714 | Membership of an equivalence class in a quotient set. (Contributed by Jeff Madsen, 10-Jun-2010.) (Revised by Mario Carneiro, 9-Jul-2014.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (((𝑅 ↾ 𝐴) ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝐴) → [𝐵]𝑅 ∈ (𝐴 / 𝑅)) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | ranpropd 50091 | If the categories have the same set of objects, morphisms, and compositions, then they have the same right Kan extensions. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐴) = (Homf ‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐴) = (compf‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐶) = (Homf ‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐶) = (compf‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐸) = (Homf ‘𝐹)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐸) = (compf‘𝐹)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐴, 𝐶〉 Ran 𝐸) = (〈𝐵, 𝐷〉 Ran 𝐹)) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | lanpropd 50090 | If the categories have the same set of objects, morphisms, and compositions, then they have the same left Kan extensions. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐴) = (Homf ‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐴) = (compf‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐶) = (Homf ‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐶) = (compf‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐸) = (Homf ‘𝐹)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐸) = (compf‘𝐹)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐴, 𝐶〉 Lan 𝐸) = (〈𝐵, 𝐷〉 Lan 𝐹)) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | prcofpropd 49854 | If the categories have the same set of objects, morphisms, and compositions, then they have the same pre-composition functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐴) = (Homf ‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐴) = (compf‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐶) = (Homf ‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐶) = (compf‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐴, 𝐶〉 −∘F 𝐹) = (〈𝐵, 𝐷〉 −∘F 𝐹)) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem5 48599 | Lemma 5 for pgnbgreunbgr 48601. Impossible cases. (Contributed by AV, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐿 = 〈0, (((2nd ‘𝑋) + 1) mod 5)〉 ∨ 𝐿 = 〈1, (2nd ‘𝑋)〉 ∨ 𝐿 = 〈0, (((2nd ‘𝑋) − 1) mod 5)〉) → ((𝐾 = 〈0, (((2nd ‘𝑋) + 1) mod 5)〉 ∨ 𝐾 = 〈1, (2nd ‘𝑋)〉 ∨ 𝐾 = 〈0, (((2nd ‘𝑋) − 1) mod 5)〉) → ((𝑋 = 〈0, 𝑦〉 ∧ 𝑋 ∈ 𝑉) → ((𝐾 ≠ 𝐿 ∧ (𝑏 ∈ (0..^5) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ (0..^5))) → (({𝐾, 〈1, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸 ∧ {〈1, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) → 𝑋 = 〈1, 𝑏〉))))) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem5lem1 48596 | Lemma 1 for pgnbgreunbgrlem5 48599. (Contributed by AV, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ ((((𝐿 = 〈0, ((𝑦 + 1) mod 5)〉 ∧ 𝐾 = 〈1, 𝑦〉) ∧ (𝑏 ∈ (0..^5) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ (0..^5))) ∧ {𝐾, 〈1, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸) → ¬ {〈1, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | pgnioedg5 48588 | An inside and an outside vertex not adjacent in a Petersen graph. (Contributed by AV, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑦 ∈ (0..^5) → ¬ {〈1, ((𝑦 − 1) mod 5)〉, 〈0, ((𝑦 + 1) mod 5)〉} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | pgnioedg4 48587 | An inside and an outside vertex not adjacent in a Petersen graph. (Contributed by AV, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑦 ∈ (0..^5) → ¬ {〈1, ((𝑦 − 2) mod 5)〉, 〈0, ((𝑦 − 1) mod 5)〉} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | pgnioedg3 48586 | An inside and an outside vertex not adjacent in a Petersen graph. (Contributed by AV, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑦 ∈ (0..^5) → ¬ {〈1, ((𝑦 + 2) mod 5)〉, 〈0, ((𝑦 − 1) mod 5)〉} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | pgnioedg2 48585 | An inside and an outside vertex not adjacent in a Petersen graph. (Contributed by AV, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑦 ∈ (0..^5) → ¬ {〈1, ((𝑦 + 2) mod 5)〉, 〈0, ((𝑦 + 1) mod 5)〉} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | pgnioedg1 48584 | An inside and an outside vertex not adjacent in a Petersen graph. (Contributed by AV, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑦 ∈ (0..^5) → ¬ {〈1, ((𝑦 − 2) mod 5)〉, 〈0, ((𝑦 + 1) mod 5)〉} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | modlt0b 47817 | An integer with an absolute value less than a positive integer is 0 modulo the positive integer iff it is 0. (Contributed by AV, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ ℕ ∧ 𝑋 ∈ ℤ ∧ (abs‘𝑋) < 𝑁) → ((𝑋 mod 𝑁) = 0 ↔ 𝑋 = 0)) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | zabs0b 15276 | An integer has an absolute value less than 1 iff it is 0. (Contributed by AV, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑋 ∈ ℤ → ((abs‘𝑋) < 1 ↔ 𝑋 = 0)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | termolmd 50145 | Terminal objects are the object part of limits of the empty diagram. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (TermO‘𝐶) = dom (∅(𝐶 Limit ∅)∅) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | cmddu 50143 | The duality of limits and colimits: colimits of a diagram are limits of an opposite diagram in opposite categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐺 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐶 Colimit 𝐷)‘𝐹) = ((𝑂 Limit 𝑃)‘𝐺)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | lmddu 50142 | The duality of limits and colimits: limits of a diagram are colimits of an opposite diagram in opposite categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐺 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐶 Limit 𝐷)‘𝐹) = ((𝑂 Colimit 𝑃)‘𝐺)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | cmdpropd 50133 | If the categories have the same set of objects, morphisms, and compositions, then they have the same colimits. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐴) = (Homf ‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐴) = (compf‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐶) = (Homf ‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐶) = (compf‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 Colimit 𝐶) = (𝐵 Colimit 𝐷)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | lmdpropd 50132 | If the categories have the same set of objects, morphisms, and compositions, then they have the same limits. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐴) = (Homf ‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐴) = (compf‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐶) = (Homf ‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐶) = (compf‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 Limit 𝐶) = (𝐵 Limit 𝐷)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | cmdrcl 50127 | Reverse closure for a colimit of a diagram. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑋 ∈ ((𝐶 Colimit 𝐷)‘𝐹) → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐶)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | lmdrcl 50126 | Reverse closure for a limit of a diagram. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑋 ∈ ((𝐶 Limit 𝐷)‘𝐹) → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐶)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | diagpropd 49767 | If two categories have the same set of objects, morphisms, and compositions, then they have same diagonal functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐴) = (Homf ‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐴) = (compf‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐶) = (Homf ‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐶) = (compf‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ Cat) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴Δfunc𝐶) = (𝐵Δfunc𝐷)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | 2ndfpropd 49766 | If two categories have the same set of objects, morphisms, and compositions, then they have same second projection functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐴) = (Homf ‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐴) = (compf‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐶) = (Homf ‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐶) = (compf‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ Cat) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 2ndF 𝐶) = (𝐵 2ndF 𝐷)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | 1stfpropd 49765 | If two categories have the same set of objects, morphisms, and compositions, then they have same first projection functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐴) = (Homf ‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐴) = (compf‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐶) = (Homf ‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐶) = (compf‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ Cat) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 1stF 𝐶) = (𝐵 1stF 𝐷)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | uppropd 49656 | If two categories have the same set of objects, morphisms, and compositions, then they have the same universal pairs. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐴) = (Homf ‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐴) = (compf‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐶) = (Homf ‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐶) = (compf‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 UP 𝐶) = (𝐵 UP 𝐷)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | reueqbidva 49281 | Formula-building rule for restricted existential uniqueness quantifier. Deduction form. General version of reueqbidv 3378. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 = 𝐵) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴) → (𝜓 ↔ 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∃!𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝜓 ↔ ∃!𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 𝜒)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem6 48600 | Lemma 6 for pgnbgreunbgr 48601. (Contributed by AV, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ (((𝐾 ∈ 𝑁 ∧ 𝐿 ∈ 𝑁 ∧ 𝐾 ≠ 𝐿) ∧ 𝑏 ∈ (0..^5)) → (({𝐾, 〈1, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸 ∧ {〈1, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) → 𝑋 = 〈1, 𝑏〉)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem5lem3 48598 | Lemma 3 for pgnbgreunbgrlem5 48599. (Contributed by AV, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ ((((𝐿 = 〈0, ((𝑦 + 1) mod 5)〉 ∧ 𝐾 = 〈0, ((𝑦 − 1) mod 5)〉) ∧ (𝑏 ∈ (0..^5) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ (0..^5))) ∧ {𝐾, 〈1, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸) → ¬ {〈1, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem5lem2 48597 | Lemma 2 for pgnbgreunbgrlem5 48599. (Contributed by AV, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ ((((𝐿 = 〈0, ((𝑦 − 1) mod 5)〉 ∧ 𝐾 = 〈1, 𝑦〉) ∧ (𝑏 ∈ (0..^5) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ (0..^5))) ∧ {𝐾, 〈1, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸) → ¬ {〈1, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem4 48595 | Lemma 4 for pgnbgreunbgr 48601. (Contributed by AV, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐿 = 〈1, (((2nd ‘𝑋) + 2) mod 5)〉 ∨ 𝐿 = 〈0, (2nd ‘𝑋)〉 ∨ 𝐿 = 〈1, (((2nd ‘𝑋) − 2) mod 5)〉) → ((𝐾 = 〈1, (((2nd ‘𝑋) + 2) mod 5)〉 ∨ 𝐾 = 〈0, (2nd ‘𝑋)〉 ∨ 𝐾 = 〈1, (((2nd ‘𝑋) − 2) mod 5)〉) → ((𝑋 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝑋 = 〈1, 𝑦〉) → ((𝐾 ≠ 𝐿 ∧ (𝑏 ∈ (0..^5) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ (0..^5))) → (({𝐾, 〈1, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸 ∧ {〈1, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) → 𝑋 = 〈1, 𝑏〉))))) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | gpgedg2iv 48543 | The edges of the generalized Petersen graph GPG(N,K) between two inside vertices. (Contributed by AV, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐽 = (1..^(⌈‘(𝑁 / 2))) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑁 gPetersenGr 𝐾) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘5) ∧ (𝑋 ∈ 𝐼 ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) ∧ (𝐾 ∈ 𝐽 ∧ ((4 · 𝐾) mod 𝑁) ≠ 0)) → (({〈1, ((𝑌 − 𝐾) mod 𝑁)〉, 〈1, 𝑋〉} ∈ 𝐸 ∧ {〈1, 𝑋〉, 〈1, ((𝑌 + 𝐾) mod 𝑁)〉} ∈ 𝐸) ↔ 𝑋 = 𝑌)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | 8mod5e3 47814 | 8 modulo 5 is 3. (Contributed by AV, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (8 mod 5) = 3 | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | oppfdiag 49891 | A diagonal functor for opposite categories is the opposite functor of the diagonal functor for original categories post-composed by an isomorphism (fucoppc 49885). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐷 Func 𝐶))) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐷 Nat 𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 = (𝑚 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐶), 𝑛 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐶) ↦ ( I ↾ (𝑛𝑁𝑚)))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐹, 𝐺〉 ∘func ( oppFunc ‘𝐿)) = (𝑂Δfunc𝑃)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | oppfdiag1a 49890 | A constant functor for opposite categories is the opposite functor of the constant functor for original categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑋)) = ((1st ‘(𝑂Δfunc𝑃))‘𝑋)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | oppfdiag1 49889 | A constant functor for opposite categories is the opposite functor of the constant functor for original categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐷 Func 𝐶))) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐹‘((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑋)) = ((1st ‘(𝑂Δfunc𝑃))‘𝑋)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | fucoppcfunc 49887 | A functor from the opposite category of functors to the category of opposite functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐶 FuncCat 𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑅 = (oppCat‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝑆 = (𝑂 FuncCat 𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐶 Nat 𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐶 Func 𝐷))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 = (𝑥 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷), 𝑦 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷) ↦ ( I ↾ (𝑦𝑁𝑥)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ Cat) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝑅 Func 𝑆)𝐺) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | fucoppcffth 49886 | A fully faithful functor from the opposite category of functors to the category of opposite functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐶 FuncCat 𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑅 = (oppCat‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝑆 = (𝑂 FuncCat 𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐶 Nat 𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐶 Func 𝐷))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 = (𝑥 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷), 𝑦 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷) ↦ ( I ↾ (𝑦𝑁𝑥)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ Cat) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹((𝑅 Full 𝑆) ∩ (𝑅 Faith 𝑆))𝐺) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | opf12 49879 | The object part of the op functor on functor categories. Lemma for oppfdiag 49891. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐶 Func 𝐷))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑀(2nd ‘(𝐹‘𝑋))𝑁) = (𝑁(2nd ‘𝑋)𝑀)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | oppc2ndf 49764 | The opposite functor of the second projection functor is the second projection functor of opposite categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘(𝐶 2ndF 𝐷)) = (𝑂 2ndF 𝑃)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | oppc1stf 49763 | The opposite functor of the first projection functor is the first projection functor of opposite categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘(𝐶 1stF 𝐷)) = (𝑂 1stF 𝑃)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | oppc1stflem 49762 | A utility theorem for proving theorems on projection functors of opposite categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ (𝐶 ∈ Cat ∧ 𝐷 ∈ Cat)) → ( oppFunc ‘(𝐶𝐹𝐷)) = (𝑂𝐹𝑃)) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑐 ∈ Cat, 𝑑 ∈ Cat ↦ 𝑌) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘(𝐶𝐹𝐷)) = (𝑂𝐹𝑃)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | uobffth 49693 | A fully faithful functor generates equal sets of universal objects. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐾 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐾)‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ((𝐷 Full 𝐸) ∩ (𝐷 Faith 𝐸))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → dom (𝐹(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋) = dom (𝐺(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | oppf2 49615 | Value of the morphism part of the opposite functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑀(2nd ‘( oppFunc ‘𝐹))𝑁) = (𝑁(2nd ‘𝐹)𝑀)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | oppf1 49614 | Value of the object part of the opposite functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (1st ‘( oppFunc ‘𝐹)) = (1st ‘𝐹)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | oppfval3 49613 | Value of the opposite functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = 〈𝐺, 𝐾〉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) = 〈𝐺, tpos 𝐾〉) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | eqfnovd 49341 | Deduction for equality of operations. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 Fn (𝐴 × 𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 Fn (𝐴 × 𝐵)) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ (𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵)) → (𝑥𝐹𝑦) = (𝑥𝐺𝑦)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = 𝐺) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | cos4t3rdpi 42788 | The cosine of 4 · (π / 3) is -1 / 2. (Contributed by SN, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (cos‘(4 · (π / 3))) = -(1 / 2) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | sin4t3rdpi 42787 | The sine of 4 · (π / 3) is -(√3) / 2. (Contributed by SN, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (sin‘(4 · (π / 3))) = -((√‘3) / 2) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | cos2t3rdpi 42786 | The cosine of 2 · (π / 3) is -1 / 2. (Contributed by SN, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (cos‘(2 · (π / 3))) = -(1 / 2) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | sin2t3rdpi 42785 | The sine of 2 · (π / 3) is (√3) / 2. (Contributed by SN, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (sin‘(2 · (π / 3))) = ((√‘3) / 2) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | cospim 42783 | Cosine of a number subtracted from π. (Contributed by SN, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℂ → (cos‘(π − 𝐴)) = -(cos‘𝐴)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | sinpim 42782 | Sine of a number subtracted from π. (Contributed by SN, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℂ → (sin‘(π − 𝐴)) = (sin‘𝐴)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | 3rdpwhole 42724 | A third of a number plus the number is four thirds of the number. (Contributed by SN, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℂ → ((𝐴 / 3) + 𝐴) = (4 · (𝐴 / 3))) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | 1p3e4 42697 | 1 + 3 = 4. (Contributed by SN, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (1 + 3) = 4 | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | spsv 1989 | Generalization of antecedent. A trivial weak version of sps 2193 avoiding ax-12 2185. (Contributed by SN, 13-Nov-2025.) (Proof shortened by WL, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝜓) ⇒ ⊢ (∀𝑥𝜑 → 𝜓) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fucoppccic 49888 | The opposite category of functors is isomorphic to the category of opposite functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐶 = (CatCat‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑋 = (oppCat‘(𝐷 FuncCat 𝐸)) & ⊢ 𝑌 = ((oppCat‘𝐷) FuncCat (oppCat‘𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋( ≃𝑐 ‘𝐶)𝑌) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fucoppc 49885 | The isomorphism from the opposite category of functors to the category of opposite functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐶 FuncCat 𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑅 = (oppCat‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝑆 = (𝑂 FuncCat 𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐶 Nat 𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐶 Func 𝐷))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 = (𝑥 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷), 𝑦 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷) ↦ ( I ↾ (𝑦𝑁𝑥)))) & ⊢ 𝑇 = (CatCat‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑇) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Iso‘𝑇) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑆 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝑅𝐼𝑆)𝐺) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fucoppcco 49884 | The opposite category of functors is compatible with the category of opposite functors in terms of composition. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐶 FuncCat 𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑅 = (oppCat‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝑆 = (𝑂 FuncCat 𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐶 Nat 𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐶 Func 𝐷))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 = (𝑥 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷), 𝑦 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷) ↦ ( I ↾ (𝑦𝑁𝑥)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝑋(Hom ‘𝑅)𝑌)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ (𝑌(Hom ‘𝑅)𝑍)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋𝐺𝑍)‘(𝐵(〈𝑋, 𝑌〉(comp‘𝑅)𝑍)𝐴)) = (((𝑌𝐺𝑍)‘𝐵)(〈(𝐹‘𝑋), (𝐹‘𝑌)〉(comp‘𝑆)(𝐹‘𝑍))((𝑋𝐺𝑌)‘𝐴))) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fucoppcid 49883 | The opposite category of functors is compatible with the category of opposite functors in terms of identity morphism. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐶 FuncCat 𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑅 = (oppCat‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝑆 = (𝑂 FuncCat 𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐶 Nat 𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐶 Func 𝐷))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 = (𝑥 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷), 𝑦 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷) ↦ ( I ↾ (𝑦𝑁𝑥)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋𝐺𝑋)‘((Id‘𝑅)‘𝑋)) = ((Id‘𝑆)‘(𝐹‘𝑋))) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fucoppclem 49882 | Lemma for fucoppc 49885. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐶 Nat 𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐶 Func 𝐷))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑌𝑁𝑋) = ((𝐹‘𝑋)(𝑂 Nat 𝑃)(𝐹‘𝑌))) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | opf2 49881 | The morphism part of the op functor on functor categories. Lemma for fucoppc 49885. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = (𝑥 ∈ 𝐴, 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ ( I ↾ (𝑦𝑁𝑥)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 = 𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ (𝑌𝑁𝑋)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋𝐹𝑌)‘𝐶) = 𝐷) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | opf2fval 49880 | The morphism part of the op functor on functor categories. Lemma for fucoppc 49885. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = (𝑥 ∈ 𝐴, 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ ( I ↾ (𝑦𝑁𝑥)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋𝐹𝑌) = ( I ↾ (𝑌𝑁𝑋))) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | opf11 49878 | The object part of the op functor on functor categories. Lemma for fucoppc 49885. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐶 Func 𝐷))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (1st ‘(𝐹‘𝑋)) = (1st ‘𝑋)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | natoppfb 49706 | A natural transformation is natural between opposite functors, and vice versa. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐶 Nat 𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (𝑂 Nat 𝑃) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐿 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐺)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐹𝑁𝐺) = (𝐿𝑀𝐾)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | natoppf2 49705 | A natural transformation is natural between opposite functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐶 Nat 𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (𝑂 Nat 𝑃) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐿 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐺)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝐹𝑁𝐺)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝐿𝑀𝐾)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | natoppf 49704 | A natural transformation is natural between opposite functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐶 Nat 𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (𝑂 Nat 𝑃) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (〈𝐹, 𝐺〉𝑁〈𝐾, 𝐿〉)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (〈𝐾, tpos 𝐿〉𝑀〈𝐹, tpos 𝐺〉)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | eloppf2 49609 | Both components of a pre-image of a non-empty opposite functor exist; and the second component is a relation on triples. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐹 oppFunc 𝐺) = 𝐾 & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐾) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐹 ∈ V ∧ 𝐺 ∈ V) ∧ (Rel 𝐺 ∧ Rel dom 𝐺))) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | eloppf 49608 | The pre-image of a non-empty opposite functor is non-empty; and the second component of the pre-image is a relation on triples. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐹 ≠ ∅ ∧ (Rel (2nd ‘𝐹) ∧ Rel dom (2nd ‘𝐹)))) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem3 48594 | Lemma 3 for pgnbgreunbgr 48601. (Contributed by AV, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ (((𝐾 ∈ 𝑁 ∧ 𝐿 ∈ 𝑁 ∧ 𝐾 ≠ 𝐿) ∧ 𝑏 ∈ (0..^5)) → (({𝐾, 〈0, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸 ∧ {〈0, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) → 𝑋 = 〈0, 𝑏〉)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem2 48593 | Lemma 2 for pgnbgreunbgr 48601. Impossible cases. (Contributed by AV, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐿 = 〈1, (((2nd ‘𝑋) + 2) mod 5)〉 ∨ 𝐿 = 〈0, (2nd ‘𝑋)〉 ∨ 𝐿 = 〈1, (((2nd ‘𝑋) − 2) mod 5)〉) → ((𝐾 = 〈1, (((2nd ‘𝑋) + 2) mod 5)〉 ∨ 𝐾 = 〈0, (2nd ‘𝑋)〉 ∨ 𝐾 = 〈1, (((2nd ‘𝑋) − 2) mod 5)〉) → ((𝑋 = 〈1, 𝑦〉 ∧ 𝑋 ∈ 𝑉) → ((𝐾 ≠ 𝐿 ∧ (𝑏 ∈ (0..^5) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ (0..^5))) → (({𝐾, 〈0, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸 ∧ {〈0, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) → 𝑋 = 〈0, 𝑏〉))))) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fxpsdrg 33236 | The fixed points of a group action 𝐴 on a division ring 𝑊 is a sub-division-ring. Since sub-division-rings of fields are subfields (see fldsdrgfld 20775), (𝐶FixPts𝐴) might be called the fixed subfield under 𝐴. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (Base‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑥 ∈ 𝐶 ↦ (𝑝𝐴𝑥)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝐺 GrpAct 𝐶)) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑝 ∈ 𝐵) → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑊 RingHom 𝑊)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑊 ∈ DivRing) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐶FixPts𝐴) ∈ (SubDRing‘𝑊)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fxpsubrg 33235 | The fixed points of a group action 𝐴 on a ring 𝑊 is a subgring. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (Base‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑥 ∈ 𝐶 ↦ (𝑝𝐴𝑥)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝐺 GrpAct 𝐶)) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑝 ∈ 𝐵) → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑊 RingHom 𝑊)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐶FixPts𝐴) ∈ (SubRing‘𝑊)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fxpsubg 33234 | The fixed points of a group action 𝐴 on a group 𝑊 is a subgroup. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (Base‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑥 ∈ 𝐶 ↦ (𝑝𝐴𝑥)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝐺 GrpAct 𝐶)) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑝 ∈ 𝐵) → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑊 GrpHom 𝑊)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐶FixPts𝐴) ∈ (SubGrp‘𝑊)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fxpsubm 33233 | Provided the group action 𝐴 induces monoid automorphisms, the set of fixed points of 𝐴 on a monoid 𝑊 is a submonoid, which could be called the fixed submonoid under 𝐴. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (Base‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑥 ∈ 𝐶 ↦ (𝑝𝐴𝑥)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝐺 GrpAct 𝐶)) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑝 ∈ 𝐵) → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑊 MndHom 𝑊)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐶FixPts𝐴) ∈ (SubMnd‘𝑊)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | cntrval2 33232 | Express the center 𝑍 of a group 𝑀 as the set of fixed points of the conjugation operation ⊕. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑀) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝑀) & ⊢ − = (-g‘𝑀) & ⊢ ⊕ = (𝑥 ∈ 𝐵, 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ ((𝑥 + 𝑦) − 𝑥)) & ⊢ 𝑍 = (Cntr‘𝑀) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑀 ∈ Grp → 𝑍 = (𝐵FixPts ⊕ )) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | conjga 33231 | Group conjugation induces a group action. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑀) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝑀) & ⊢ − = (-g‘𝑀) & ⊢ ⊕ = (𝑥 ∈ 𝐵, 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ ((𝑥 + 𝑦) − 𝑥)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑀 ∈ Grp → ⊕ ∈ (𝑀 GrpAct 𝐵)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fxpgaeq 33230 | A fixed point 𝑋 is invariant under group action 𝐴. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑈 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝐺 GrpAct 𝐶)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ (𝐶FixPts𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑃 ∈ 𝑈) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑃𝐴𝑋) = 𝑋) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | isfxp 33229 | Property of being a fixed point. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑈 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝐺 GrpAct 𝐶)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 ∈ (𝐶FixPts𝐴) ↔ ∀𝑝 ∈ 𝑈 (𝑝𝐴𝑋) = 𝑋)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fxpgaval 33228 | Value of the set of fixed points for a group action 𝐴. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑈 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝐺 GrpAct 𝐶)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐶FixPts𝐴) = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐶 ∣ ∀𝑝 ∈ 𝑈 (𝑝𝐴𝑥) = 𝑥}) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fxpss 33227 | The set of fixed points is a subset of the set acted upon. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐵FixPts𝐴) ⊆ 𝐵) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fxpval 33226 | Value of the set of fixed points. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐵FixPts𝐴) = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 ∣ ∀𝑝 ∈ dom dom 𝐴(𝑝𝐴𝑥) = 𝑥}) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | df-fxp 33225 | Define the set of fixed points left unchanged by a group action. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ FixPts = (𝑏 ∈ V, 𝑎 ∈ V ↦ {𝑥 ∈ 𝑏 ∣ ∀𝑝 ∈ dom dom 𝑎(𝑝𝑎𝑥) = 𝑥}) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | ralimd6v 3190 | Deduction sextupally quantifying both antecedent and consequent. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 5-Mar-2025.) Reduce DV conditions. (Revised by Eric Schmidt, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜓 → 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ∀𝑧 ∈ 𝐶 ∀𝑤 ∈ 𝐷 ∀𝑝 ∈ 𝐸 ∀𝑞 ∈ 𝐹 𝜓 → ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ∀𝑧 ∈ 𝐶 ∀𝑤 ∈ 𝐷 ∀𝑝 ∈ 𝐸 ∀𝑞 ∈ 𝐹 𝜒)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | ralimd4v 3188 | Deduction quadrupally quantifying both antecedent and consequent. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 2-Mar-2025.) Reduce DV conditions. (Revised by Eric Schmidt, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜓 → 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ∀𝑧 ∈ 𝐶 ∀𝑤 ∈ 𝐷 𝜓 → ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ∀𝑧 ∈ 𝐶 ∀𝑤 ∈ 𝐷 𝜒)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | ralimdvv 3186 | Deduction doubly quantifying both antecedent and consequent. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 2-Mar-2025.) Shorten and reduce DV conditions. (Revised by Eric Schmidt, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜓 → 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 𝜓 → ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 𝜒)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | initocmd 50144 | Initial objects are the object part of colimits of the empty diagram. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (InitO‘𝐶) = dom (∅(𝐶 Colimit ∅)∅) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | isinito4a 50023 | The predicate "is an initial object" of a category, using universal property. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 1 ∈ TermCat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ (Base‘ 1 )) & ⊢ 𝐹 = ((1st ‘( 1 Δfunc𝐶))‘𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐼 ∈ (InitO‘𝐶) ↔ 𝐼 ∈ dom (𝐹(𝐶 UP 1 )𝑋))) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | isinito4 50022 | The predicate "is an initial object" of a category, using universal property. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 1 ∈ TermCat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ (Base‘ 1 )) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 1 )) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐼 ∈ (InitO‘𝐶) ↔ 𝐼 ∈ dom (𝐹(𝐶 UP 1 )𝑋))) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | uobeqterm 50021 | Universal objects and terminal categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐸) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ TermCat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ TermCat) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → dom (𝐹(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋) = dom (𝐺(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | cofuterm 50020 | Post-compose with a functor to a terminal category. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ TermCat) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐾) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | termfucterm 50019 | All functors between two terminal categories are isomorphisms. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐶 = (CatCat‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Iso‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ TermCat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ TermCat) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 Func 𝑌) = (𝑋𝐼𝑌)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | 0fucterm 50018 | The category of functors from an initial category is terminal. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∅ = (Base‘𝐶)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐶 FuncCat 𝐷) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑄 ∈ TermCat) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | fucterm 50017 | The category of functors to a terminal category is terminal. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐶 FuncCat 𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ TermCat) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑄 ∈ TermCat) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | funcsn 50016 | The category of one functor to a thin category is terminal. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐶 FuncCat 𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐶 Func 𝐷) = {𝐹}) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ ThinCat) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑄 ∈ TermCat) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | termco 49956 | The object of a terminal category. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ TermCat) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ∪ 𝐵 ∈ 𝐵) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | uobeq3 49877 | An isomorphism between categories generates equal sets of universal objects. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐾 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐾)‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (CatCat‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Iso‘𝑄) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (𝐷𝐼𝐸)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → dom (𝐹(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋) = dom (𝐺(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | uobeq2 49876 | If a full functor (in fact, a full embedding) is a section, then the sets of universal objects are equal. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐾 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐾)‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (CatCat‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝑆 = (Sect‘𝑄) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (𝐷 Full 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ dom (𝐷𝑆𝐸)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → dom (𝐹(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋) = dom (𝐺(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | catcisoi 49875 | A functor is an isomorphism of categories only if it is full and faithful, and is a bijection on the objects. Remark 3.28(2) in [Adamek] p. 34. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐶 = (CatCat‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝑅 = (Base‘𝑋) & ⊢ 𝑆 = (Base‘𝑌) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Iso‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑋𝐼𝑌)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐹 ∈ ((𝑋 Full 𝑌) ∩ (𝑋 Faith 𝑌)) ∧ (1st ‘𝐹):𝑅–1-1-onto→𝑆)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | uobeq 49695 | If a full functor (in fact, a full embedding) is a section of a functor (surjective on objects), then the sets of universal objects are equal. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐾 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐾)‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (𝐷 Full 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐿 ∘func 𝐾) = 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐿 ∈ (𝐸 Func 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → dom (𝐹(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋) = dom (𝐺(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | uobeqw 49694 | If a full functor (in fact, a full embedding) is a section of a fully faithful functor (surjective on objects), then the sets of universal objects are equal. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐾 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐾)‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (𝐷 Full 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐿 ∘func 𝐾) = 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐿 ∈ ((𝐸 Full 𝐷) ∩ (𝐸 Faith 𝐷))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → dom (𝐹(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋) = dom (𝐺(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | uptrar 49691 | Universal property and fully faithful functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐾)‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ((𝐷 Full 𝐸) ∩ (𝐷 Faith 𝐸))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐾 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (◡(𝑋(2nd ‘𝐾)((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑍))‘𝑁) = 𝑀) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍(𝐺(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)𝑁) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍(𝐹(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋)𝑀) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | uobrcl 49668 | Reverse closure for universal object. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑋 ∈ dom (𝐹(𝐷 UP 𝐸)𝑊) → (𝐷 ∈ Cat ∧ 𝐸 ∈ Cat)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | oppff1o 49624 | The operation generating opposite functors is bijective. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)):(𝐶 Func 𝐷)–1-1-onto→(𝑂 Func 𝑃)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | oppff1 49623 | The operation generating opposite functors is injective. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) ⇒ ⊢ ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)):(𝐶 Func 𝐷)–1-1→(𝑂 Func 𝑃) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | 2oppffunc 49621 | The opposite functor of an opposite functor is a functor on the original categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) The functor in opposite categories does not have to be an opposite functor. (Revised by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑂 Func 𝑃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | oppffn 49599 | oppFunc is a function on (V × V). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ oppFunc Fn (V × V) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | isoval2 49510 | The isomorphisms are the domain of the inverse relation. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 = (Inv‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Iso‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑋𝐼𝑌) = dom (𝑋𝑁𝑌) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | isorcl2 49509 | Reverse closure for isomorphism relations. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (Iso‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑋𝐼𝑌)) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | isorcl 49508 | Reverse closure for isomorphism relations. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (Iso‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑋𝐼𝑌)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem2lem3 48592 | Lemma 3 for pgnbgreunbgrlem2 48593. (Contributed by AV, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ ((((𝐿 = 〈1, ((𝑦 + 2) mod 5)〉 ∧ 𝐾 = 〈1, ((𝑦 − 2) mod 5)〉) ∧ (𝑏 ∈ (0..^5) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ (0..^5))) ∧ {𝐾, 〈0, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸) → ¬ {〈0, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | uptrai 49692 | Universal property and fully faithful functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐾)‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ((𝐷 Full 𝐸) ∩ (𝐷 Faith 𝐸))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐾 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋(2nd ‘𝐾)((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑍))‘𝑀) = 𝑁) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍(𝐹(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋)𝑀) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍(𝐺(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)𝑁) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | uptra 49690 | Universal property and fully faithful functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐾)‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ((𝐷 Full 𝐸) ∩ (𝐷 Faith 𝐸))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐾 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋(2nd ‘𝐾)((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑍))‘𝑀) = 𝑁) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 ∈ (𝑋𝐽((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑍))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑍(𝐹(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋)𝑀 ↔ 𝑍(𝐺(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)𝑁)) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | uptri 49689 | Universal property and fully faithful functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑅‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅((𝐷 Full 𝐸) ∩ (𝐷 Faith 𝐸))𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝑅, 𝑆〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 〈𝐾, 𝐿〉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋𝑆(𝐹‘𝑍))‘𝑀) = 𝑁) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍(〈𝐹, 𝐺〉(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋)𝑀) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍(〈𝐾, 𝐿〉(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)𝑁) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | uptr 49688 | Universal property and fully faithful functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑅‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅((𝐷 Full 𝐸) ∩ (𝐷 Faith 𝐸))𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝑅, 𝑆〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 〈𝐾, 𝐿〉) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐶 Func 𝐷)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋𝑆(𝐹‘𝑍))‘𝑀) = 𝑁) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 ∈ (𝑋𝐽(𝐹‘𝑍))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑍(〈𝐹, 𝐺〉(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋)𝑀 ↔ 𝑍(〈𝐾, 𝐿〉(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)𝑁)) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | uptrlem3 49687 | Lemma for uptr 49688. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑅‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅((𝐷 Full 𝐸) ∩ (𝐷 Faith 𝐸))𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝑅, 𝑆〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 〈𝐾, 𝐿〉) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐶 Func 𝐷)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋𝑆(𝐹‘𝑍))‘𝑀) = 𝑁) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 ∈ (𝑋𝐽(𝐹‘𝑍))) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍 ∈ 𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑍(〈𝐹, 𝐺〉(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋)𝑀 ↔ 𝑍(〈𝐾, 𝐿〉(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)𝑁)) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | uptrlem2 49686 | Lemma for uptr 49688. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Hom ‘𝐸) & ⊢ ∙ = (comp‘𝐷) & ⊢ ⚬ = (comp‘𝐸) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐾)‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍 ∈ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑊 ∈ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 ∈ (𝑋𝐼((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑍))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋(2nd ‘𝐾)((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑍))‘𝑀) = 𝑁) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ((𝐷 Full 𝐸) ∩ (𝐷 Faith 𝐸))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐾 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀ℎ ∈ (𝑌𝐽((1st ‘𝐺)‘𝑊))∃!𝑘 ∈ (𝑍𝐻𝑊)ℎ = (((𝑍(2nd ‘𝐺)𝑊)‘𝑘)(〈𝑌, ((1st ‘𝐺)‘𝑍)〉 ⚬ ((1st ‘𝐺)‘𝑊))𝑁) ↔ ∀𝑔 ∈ (𝑋𝐼((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑊))∃!𝑘 ∈ (𝑍𝐻𝑊)𝑔 = (((𝑍(2nd ‘𝐹)𝑊)‘𝑘)(〈𝑋, ((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑍)〉 ∙ ((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑊))𝑀))) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | uptrlem1 49685 | Lemma for uptr 49688. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Hom ‘𝐸) & ⊢ ∙ = (comp‘𝐷) & ⊢ ⚬ = (comp‘𝐸) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ (Base‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑀‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍 ∈ (Base‘𝐶)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑊 ∈ (Base‘𝐶)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝑋𝐼(𝐹‘𝑍))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋𝑁(𝐹‘𝑍))‘𝐴) = 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐶 Func 𝐷)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀((𝐷 Full 𝐸) ∩ (𝐷 Faith 𝐸))𝑁) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝑀, 𝑁〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 〈𝐾, 𝐿〉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀ℎ ∈ (𝑌𝐽(𝐾‘𝑊))∃!𝑘 ∈ (𝑍𝐻𝑊)ℎ = (((𝑍𝐿𝑊)‘𝑘)(〈𝑌, (𝐾‘𝑍)〉 ⚬ (𝐾‘𝑊))𝐵) ↔ ∀𝑔 ∈ (𝑋𝐼(𝐹‘𝑊))∃!𝑘 ∈ (𝑍𝐻𝑊)𝑔 = (((𝑍𝐺𝑊)‘𝑘)(〈𝑋, (𝐹‘𝑍)〉 ∙ (𝐹‘𝑊))𝐴))) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | idemb 49634 | The inclusion functor is an embedding. Remark 4.4(1) in [Adamek] p. 49. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐼 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸) → (𝐼 ∈ (𝐷 Faith 𝐸) ∧ Fun ◡(1st ‘𝐼))) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | idfu1stf1o 49574 | The identity functor/inclusion functor is bijective on objects. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐶 ∈ Cat → (1st ‘𝐼):𝐵–1-1-onto→𝐵) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | cofucla 49571 | The composition of two functors is a functor. Proposition 3.23 of [Adamek] p. 33. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐶 Func 𝐷)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐿) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐸)) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | cofu2a 49570 | Value of the morphism part of the functor composition. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐶 Func 𝐷)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐿) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 〈𝑀, 𝑁〉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ (𝑋𝐻𝑌)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (((𝐹‘𝑋)𝐿(𝐹‘𝑌))‘((𝑋𝐺𝑌)‘𝑅)) = ((𝑋𝑁𝑌)‘𝑅)) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | cofu1a 49569 | Value of the object part of the functor composition. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐶 Func 𝐷)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐿) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 〈𝑀, 𝑁〉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐾‘(𝐹‘𝑋)) = (𝑀‘𝑋)) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem2lem2 48591 | Lemma 2 for pgnbgreunbgrlem2 48593. (Contributed by AV, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ ((((𝐿 = 〈1, ((𝑦 − 2) mod 5)〉 ∧ 𝐾 = 〈0, 𝑦〉) ∧ (𝑏 ∈ (0..^5) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ (0..^5))) ∧ {𝐾, 〈0, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸) → ¬ {〈0, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem2lem1 48590 | Lemma 1 for pgnbgreunbgrlem2 48593. (Contributed by AV, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ ((((𝐿 = 〈1, ((𝑦 + 2) mod 5)〉 ∧ 𝐾 = 〈0, 𝑦〉) ∧ (𝑏 ∈ (0..^5) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ (0..^5))) ∧ {𝐾, 〈0, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸) → ¬ {〈0, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | nregmodelaxext 45445 | The Axiom of Extensionality ax-ext 2708 is true in the permutation model defined from 𝐹. This theorem is an immediate consequence of the fact that ax-ext 2708 holds in all permutation models and is provided as an illustration. (Contributed by Eric Schmidt, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹 = (( I ↾ (V ∖ {∅, {∅}})) ∪ {〈∅, {∅}〉, 〈{∅}, ∅〉}) & ⊢ 𝑅 = (◡𝐹 ∘ E ) ⇒ ⊢ (∀𝑧(𝑧𝑅𝑥 ↔ 𝑧𝑅𝑦) → 𝑥 = 𝑦) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | nregmodel 45444 | The Axiom of Regularity ax-reg 9507 is false in the permutation model defined from 𝐹. Since the other axioms of ZFC hold in all permutation models (permaxext 45432 through permac8prim 45441), we can conclude that Regularity does not follow from those axioms, assuming ZFC is consistent. (If we could prove Regularity from the other axioms, we could prove it in the permutation model and thus obtain a contradiction with this theorem.) Since we also know that Regularity is consistent with the other axioms (wfaxext 45420 through wfac8prim 45429), Regularity is neither provable nor disprovable from the other axioms; i.e., it is independent of them. (Contributed by Eric Schmidt, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹 = (( I ↾ (V ∖ {∅, {∅}})) ∪ {〈∅, {∅}〉, 〈{∅}, ∅〉}) & ⊢ 𝑅 = (◡𝐹 ∘ E ) ⇒ ⊢ ¬ ∀𝑥(∃𝑦 𝑦𝑅𝑥 → ∃𝑦(𝑦𝑅𝑥 ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧𝑅𝑦 → ¬ 𝑧𝑅𝑥))) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | nregmodellem 45443 | Lemma for nregmodel 45444. (Contributed by Eric Schmidt, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹 = (( I ↾ (V ∖ {∅, {∅}})) ∪ {〈∅, {∅}〉, 〈{∅}, ∅〉}) & ⊢ 𝑅 = (◡𝐹 ∘ E ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑥𝑅∅ ↔ 𝑥 ∈ {∅}) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | nregmodelf1o 45442 | Define a permutation 𝐹 used to produce a model in which ax-reg 9507 is false. The permutation swaps ∅ and {∅} and leaves the rest of 𝑉 fixed. This is an example given after Exercise II.9.2 of [Kunen2] p. 148. (Contributed by Eric Schmidt, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹 = (( I ↾ (V ∖ {∅, {∅}})) ∪ {〈∅, {∅}〉, 〈{∅}, ∅〉}) ⇒ ⊢ 𝐹:V–1-1-onto→V | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | permac8prim 45441 | The Axiom of Choice ac8prim 45418 holds in permutation models. Part of Exercise II.9.3 of [Kunen2] p. 149. Note that ax-ac 10381 requires Regularity for its derivation from the usual Axiom of Choice and does not necessarily hold in permutation models. (Contributed by Eric Schmidt, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹:V–1-1-onto→V & ⊢ 𝑅 = (◡𝐹 ∘ E ) ⇒ ⊢ ((∀𝑧(𝑧𝑅𝑥 → ∃𝑤 𝑤𝑅𝑧) ∧ ∀𝑧∀𝑤((𝑧𝑅𝑥 ∧ 𝑤𝑅𝑥) → (¬ 𝑧 = 𝑤 → ∀𝑦(𝑦𝑅𝑧 → ¬ 𝑦𝑅𝑤)))) → ∃𝑦∀𝑧(𝑧𝑅𝑥 → ∃𝑤∀𝑣((𝑣𝑅𝑧 ∧ 𝑣𝑅𝑦) ↔ 𝑣 = 𝑤))) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofidfth 49637 | If "𝐹 is a section of 𝐺 " in a category of small categories (in a universe), then 𝐹 is faithful. Combined with cofidf1 49596, this theorem proves that 𝐹 is an embedding (a faithful functor injective on objects, remark 3.28(1) of [Adamek] p. 34). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾(𝐸 Func 𝐷)𝐿) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 𝐼) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐷 Faith 𝐸)𝐺) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofidf1 49596 | If "〈𝐹, 𝐺〉 is a section of 〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 " in a category of small categories (in a universe), then 𝐹 is injective, and 𝐾 is surjective. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾(𝐸 Func 𝐷)𝐿) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (Base‘𝐸) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐹:𝐵–1-1→𝐶 ∧ 𝐾:𝐶–onto→𝐵)) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofidf2 49595 | If "𝐹 is a section of 𝐺 " in a category of small categories (in a universe), then the morphism part of 𝐹 is injective, and the morphism part of 𝐺 is surjective in the image of 𝐹. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾(𝐸 Func 𝐷)𝐿) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Hom ‘𝐸) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋𝐺𝑌):(𝑋𝐻𝑌)–1-1→((𝐹‘𝑋)𝐽(𝐹‘𝑌)) ∧ ((𝐹‘𝑋)𝐿(𝐹‘𝑌)):((𝐹‘𝑋)𝐽(𝐹‘𝑌))–onto→(𝑋𝐻𝑌))) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofidval 49594 | The property "〈𝐹, 𝐺〉 is a section of 〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 " in a category of small categories (in a universe); expressed explicitly. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾(𝐸 Func 𝐷)𝐿) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐷) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐾 ∘ 𝐹) = ( I ↾ 𝐵) ∧ (𝑥 ∈ 𝐵, 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ (((𝐹‘𝑥)𝐿(𝐹‘𝑦)) ∘ (𝑥𝐺𝑦))) = (𝑧 ∈ (𝐵 × 𝐵) ↦ ( I ↾ (𝐻‘𝑧))))) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofidf1a 49593 | If "𝐹 is a section of 𝐺 " in a category of small categories (in a universe), then the object part of 𝐹 is injective, and the object part of 𝐺 is surjective. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐸 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (Base‘𝐸) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐹):𝐵–1-1→𝐶 ∧ (1st ‘𝐺):𝐶–onto→𝐵)) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofidf2a 49592 | If "𝐹 is a section of 𝐺 " in a category of small categories (in a universe), then the morphism part of 𝐹 is injective, and the morphism part of 𝐺 is surjective in the image of 𝐹. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐸 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Hom ‘𝐸) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋(2nd ‘𝐹)𝑌):(𝑋𝐻𝑌)–1-1→(((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑋)𝐽((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑌)) ∧ (((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑋)(2nd ‘𝐺)((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑌)):(((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑋)𝐽((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑌))–onto→(𝑋𝐻𝑌))) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofidvala 49591 | The property "𝐹 is a section of 𝐺 " in a category of small categories (in a universe); expressed explicitly. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐸 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐷) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (((1st ‘𝐺) ∘ (1st ‘𝐹)) = ( I ↾ 𝐵) ∧ (𝑥 ∈ 𝐵, 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ ((((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑥)(2nd ‘𝐺)((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑦)) ∘ (𝑥(2nd ‘𝐹)𝑦))) = (𝑧 ∈ (𝐵 × 𝐵) ↦ ( I ↾ (𝐻‘𝑧))))) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofid2 49590 | Express the morphism part of (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐼 explicitly. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾(𝐸 Func 𝐷)𝐿) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ (𝑋𝐻𝑌)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (((𝐹‘𝑋)𝐿(𝐹‘𝑌))‘((𝑋𝐺𝑌)‘𝑅)) = 𝑅) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofid1 49589 | Express the object part of (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐼 explicitly. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾(𝐸 Func 𝐷)𝐿) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 𝐼) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐾‘(𝐹‘𝑋)) = 𝑋) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofid2a 49588 | Express the morphism part of (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐼 explicitly. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐸 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ (𝑋𝐻𝑌)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑋)(2nd ‘𝐺)((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑌))‘((𝑋(2nd ‘𝐹)𝑌)‘𝑅)) = 𝑅) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofid1a 49587 | Express the object part of (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐼 explicitly. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐸 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐼) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐺)‘((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑋)) = 𝑋) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofu1st2nd 49567 | Rewrite the functor composition with separated functor parts. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = (〈(1st ‘𝐺), (2nd ‘𝐺)〉 ∘func 〈(1st ‘𝐹), (2nd ‘𝐹)〉)) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | initc 49566 | Sets with empty base are the only initial objects in the category of small categories. Example 7.2(3) of [Adamek] p. 101. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐶 ∈ V ∧ ∅ = (Base‘𝐶)) ↔ ∀𝑑 ∈ Cat ∃!𝑓 𝑓 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝑑)) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | func2nd 49553 | Extract the second member of a functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐶 Func 𝐷)𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (2nd ‘〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 𝐺) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | func1st 49552 | Extract the first member of a functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐶 Func 𝐷)𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (1st ‘〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 𝐹) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem1 48589 | Lemma 1 for pgnbgreunbgr 48601. (Contributed by AV, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐿 = 〈0, (((2nd ‘𝑋) + 1) mod 5)〉 ∨ 𝐿 = 〈1, (2nd ‘𝑋)〉 ∨ 𝐿 = 〈0, (((2nd ‘𝑋) − 1) mod 5)〉) → ((𝐾 = 〈0, (((2nd ‘𝑋) + 1) mod 5)〉 ∨ 𝐾 = 〈1, (2nd ‘𝑋)〉 ∨ 𝐾 = 〈0, (((2nd ‘𝑋) − 1) mod 5)〉) → ((𝑋 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝑋 = 〈0, 𝑦〉) → ((𝐾 ≠ 𝐿 ∧ (𝑏 ∈ (0..^5) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ (0..^5))) → (({𝐾, 〈0, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸 ∧ {〈0, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) → 𝑋 = 〈0, 𝑏〉))))) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | gpgedg2ov 48542 | The edges of the generalized Petersen graph GPG(N,K) between two outside vertices. (Contributed by AV, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐽 = (1..^(⌈‘(𝑁 / 2))) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑁 gPetersenGr 𝐾) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘5) ∧ 𝐾 ∈ 𝐽) ∧ (𝑋 ∈ 𝐼 ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼)) → (({〈0, ((𝑌 − 1) mod 𝑁)〉, 〈0, 𝑋〉} ∈ 𝐸 ∧ {〈0, 𝑋〉, 〈0, ((𝑌 + 1) mod 𝑁)〉} ∈ 𝐸) ↔ 𝑋 = 𝑌)) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | modm1p1ne 47824 | If an integer minus one equals another integer plus one modulo an integer greater than 4, then the first integer plus one is not equal to the second integer minus one modulo the same modulus. (Contributed by AV, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘5) ∧ 𝑋 ∈ 𝐼 ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) → (((𝑌 − 1) mod 𝑁) = ((𝑋 + 1) mod 𝑁) → ((𝑌 + 1) mod 𝑁) ≠ ((𝑋 − 1) mod 𝑁))) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | modm1nep1 47819 | A nonnegative integer less than a modulus greater than 2 plus/minus one are not equal modulo the modulus. (Contributed by AV, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘3) ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) → ((𝑌 − 1) mod 𝑁) ≠ ((𝑌 + 1) mod 𝑁)) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | mod2addne 47818 | The sums of a nonnegative integer less than the modulus and two integers whose difference is less than the modulus are not equal modulo the modulus. (Contributed by AV, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ ℕ ∧ (𝑋 ∈ 𝐼 ∧ 𝐴 ∈ ℤ ∧ 𝐵 ∈ ℤ) ∧ (abs‘(𝐴 − 𝐵)) ∈ (1..^𝑁)) → ((𝑋 + 𝐴) mod 𝑁) ≠ ((𝑋 + 𝐵) mod 𝑁)) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | modmknepk 47816 | A nonnegative integer less than the modulus plus/minus a positive integer less than (the ceiling of) half of the modulus are not equal modulo the modulus. For this theorem, it is essential that 𝐾 < (𝑁 / 2)! (Contributed by AV, 3-Sep-2025.) (Revised by AV, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐽 = (1..^(⌈‘(𝑁 / 2))) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘3) ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼 ∧ 𝐾 ∈ 𝐽) → ((𝑌 − 𝐾) mod 𝑁) ≠ ((𝑌 + 𝐾) mod 𝑁)) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | modmkpkne 47815 | If an integer minus a constant equals another integer plus the constant modulo 𝑁, then the first integer plus the constant equals the second integer minus the constant modulo 𝑁 iff the fourfold of the constant is a multiple of 𝑁. (Contributed by AV, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ ℕ ∧ (𝑋 ∈ ℤ ∧ 𝑌 ∈ ℤ ∧ 𝐾 ∈ ℤ)) → (((𝑌 − 𝐾) mod 𝑁) = ((𝑋 + 𝐾) mod 𝑁) → (((𝑌 + 𝐾) mod 𝑁) = ((𝑋 − 𝐾) mod 𝑁) ↔ ((4 · 𝐾) mod 𝑁) = 0))) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | trisecnconstr 33936 | Not all angles can be trisected. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ¬ ∀𝑜 ∈ Constr (𝑜↑𝑐(1 / 3)) ∈ Constr | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cos9thpinconstr 33935 | Trisecting an angle is an impossible construction. Given for example 𝑂 = (exp‘((i · (2 · π)) / 3)), which represents an angle of ((2 · π) / 3), the cube root of 𝑂 is not constructible with straightedge and compass, while 𝑂 itself is constructible. This is the second part of Metamath 100 proof #8. Theorem 7.14 of [Stewart] p. 99. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux and Saveliy Skresanov, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (exp‘((i · (2 · π)) / 3)) & ⊢ 𝑍 = (𝑂↑𝑐(1 / 3)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑂 ∈ Constr ∧ 𝑍 ∉ Constr) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cos9thpinconstrlem2 33934 | The complex number 𝐴 is not constructible. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (exp‘((i · (2 · π)) / 3)) & ⊢ 𝑍 = (𝑂↑𝑐(1 / 3)) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (𝑍 + (1 / 𝑍)) ⇒ ⊢ ¬ 𝐴 ∈ Constr | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | difmod0 16256 | The difference of two integers modulo a positive integer equals zero iff the two integers are equal modulo the positive integer. (Contributed by AV, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℤ ∧ 𝐵 ∈ ℤ ∧ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ) → (((𝐴 − 𝐵) mod 𝑁) = 0 ↔ (𝐴 mod 𝑁) = (𝐵 mod 𝑁))) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | uzuzle35 12837 | An integer greater than or equal to 5 is an integer greater than or equal to 3. (Contributed by AV, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ (ℤ≥‘5) → 𝐴 ∈ (ℤ≥‘3)) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | addsubsub23 11558 | Swap the second and the third terms in a difference of a sum and a difference (or, vice versa, in a sum of a difference and a sum). (Contributed by AV, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℂ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℂ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ℂ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ ℂ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 + 𝐵) − (𝐶 − 𝐷)) = ((𝐴 − 𝐶) + (𝐵 + 𝐷))) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | subsubadd23 11557 | Swap the second and the third terms in a difference of a difference and a sum. (Contributed by AV, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℂ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℂ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ℂ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ ℂ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 − 𝐵) − (𝐶 + 𝐷)) = ((𝐴 − 𝐶) − (𝐵 + 𝐷))) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | islmd 50140 | The universal property of limits of a diagram. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐷 Nat 𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ · = (comp‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑋((𝐶 Limit 𝐷)‘𝐹)𝑅 ↔ ((𝑋 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ 𝑅 ∈ (((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑋)𝑁𝐹)) ∧ ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∀𝑎 ∈ (((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑥)𝑁𝐹)∃!𝑚 ∈ (𝑥𝐻𝑋)𝑎 = (𝑗 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ ((𝑅‘𝑗)(〈𝑥, 𝑋〉 · ((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑗))𝑚)))) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | rellmd 50134 | The set of limits of a diagram is a relation. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ Rel ((𝐶 Limit 𝐷)‘𝐹) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | lmdfval2 50130 | The set of limits of a diagram. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐶 Limit 𝐷)‘𝐹) = (( oppFunc ‘(𝐶Δfunc𝐷))((oppCat‘𝐶) UP (oppCat‘(𝐷 FuncCat 𝐶)))𝐹) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | reldmlmd2 50128 | The domain of (𝐶 Limit 𝐷) is a relation. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ Rel dom (𝐶 Limit 𝐷) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | lmdfval 50124 | Function value of Limit. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐶 Limit 𝐷) = (𝑓 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐶) ↦ (( oppFunc ‘(𝐶Δfunc𝐷))((oppCat‘𝐶) UP (oppCat‘(𝐷 FuncCat 𝐶)))𝑓)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | catcinv 49874 | The property "𝐹 is an inverse of 𝐺 " in a category of small categories (in a universe). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐶 = (CatCat‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (Inv‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝑋) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (idfunc‘𝑌) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐹(𝑋𝑁𝑌)𝐺 ↔ ((𝐹 ∈ (𝑋𝐻𝑌) ∧ 𝐺 ∈ (𝑌𝐻𝑋)) ∧ ((𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐼 ∧ (𝐹 ∘func 𝐺) = 𝐽))) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | catcsect 49873 | The property "𝐹 is a section of 𝐺 " in a category of small categories (in a universe). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐶 = (CatCat‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝑋) & ⊢ 𝑆 = (Sect‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐹(𝑋𝑆𝑌)𝐺 ↔ ((𝐹 ∈ (𝑋𝐻𝑌) ∧ 𝐺 ∈ (𝑌𝐻𝑋)) ∧ (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐼)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | elcatchom 49872 | A morphism of the category of categories (in a universe) is a functor. See df-catc 18066 for the definition of the category Cat, which consists of all categories in the universe 𝑢 (i.e., "𝑢-small categories", see Definition 3.44. of [Adamek] p. 39), with functors as the morphisms (catchom 18070). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐶 = (CatCat‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑋𝐻𝑌)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑋 Func 𝑌)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | catcrcl2 49871 | Reverse closure for the category of categories (in a universe) (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐶 = (CatCat‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑋𝐻𝑌)) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | catcrcl 49870 | Reverse closure for the category of categories (in a universe) (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐶 = (CatCat‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑋𝐻𝑌)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑈 ∈ V) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | oppfuprcl2 49680 | Reverse closure for the class of universal property for opposite functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋(𝐺(𝑂 UP 𝑃)𝑊)𝑀) & ⊢ 𝐺 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) & ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐸) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑈) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = 〈𝐴, 𝐵〉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐵) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | oppfuprcl 49679 | Reverse closure for the class of universal property for opposite functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋(𝐺(𝑂 UP 𝑃)𝑊)𝑀) & ⊢ 𝐺 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) & ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐸) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑈) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | uprcl2a 49678 | Reverse closure for the class of universal property. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋(𝐺(𝑂 UP 𝑃)𝑊)𝑀) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝑂 Func 𝑃)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | funcoppc5 49620 | A functor on opposite categories yields a functor on the original categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) ∈ (𝑂 Func 𝑃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | funcoppc4 49619 | A functor on opposite categories yields a functor on the original categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐹 oppFunc 𝐺) ∈ (𝑂 Func 𝑃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐶 Func 𝐷)𝐺) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | oppfoppc2 49617 | The opposite functor is a functor on opposite categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) ∈ (𝑂 Func 𝑃)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | 2oppf 49607 | The double opposite functor is the original functor. Remark 3.42 of [Adamek] p. 39. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ 𝑅) & ⊢ Rel 𝑅 & ⊢ 𝐺 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘𝐺) = 𝐹) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | oppf1st2nd 49606 | Rewrite the opposite functor into its components (eqopi 7978). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ 𝑅) & ⊢ Rel 𝑅 & ⊢ 𝐺 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = 〈𝐴, 𝐵〉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 ∈ (V × V) ∧ ((1st ‘𝐺) = 𝐴 ∧ (2nd ‘𝐺) = tpos 𝐵))) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | oppfrcl3 49605 | If an opposite functor of a class is a functor, then the second component of the original class must be a relation whose domain is a relation as well. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ 𝑅) & ⊢ Rel 𝑅 & ⊢ 𝐺 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = 〈𝐴, 𝐵〉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (Rel 𝐵 ∧ Rel dom 𝐵)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | oppfrcl2 49604 | If an opposite functor of a class is a functor, then the two components of the original class must be sets. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ 𝑅) & ⊢ Rel 𝑅 & ⊢ 𝐺 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = 〈𝐴, 𝐵〉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 ∈ V ∧ 𝐵 ∈ V)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | oppfrcl 49603 | If an opposite functor of a class is a functor, then the original class must be an ordered pair. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ 𝑅) & ⊢ Rel 𝑅 & ⊢ 𝐺 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (V × V)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | oppfrcllem 49602 | Lemma for oppfrcl 49603. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ 𝑅) & ⊢ Rel 𝑅 ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ≠ ∅) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | isinv2 49501 | The property "𝐹 is an inverse of 𝐺". (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 = (Inv‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑆 = (Sect‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐹(𝑋𝑁𝑌)𝐺 ↔ (𝐹(𝑋𝑆𝑌)𝐺 ∧ 𝐺(𝑌𝑆𝑋)𝐹)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | invrcl2 49500 | Reverse closure for inverse relations. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 = (Inv‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝑋𝑁𝑌)𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | invrcl 49499 | Reverse closure for inverse relations. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 = (Inv‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝑋𝑁𝑌)𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | sectrcl2 49498 | Reverse closure for section relations. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (Sect‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝑋𝑆𝑌)𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | sectrcl 49497 | Reverse closure for section relations. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (Sect‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝑋𝑆𝑌)𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | cos9thpinconstrlem1 33933 | The complex number 𝑂, representing an angle of (2 · π) / 3, is constructible. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (exp‘((i · (2 · π)) / 3)) ⇒ ⊢ 𝑂 ∈ Constr | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | cos9thpiminply 33932 | The polynomial ((𝑋↑3) + ((-3 · 𝑋) + 1)) is the minimal polynomial for 𝐴 over ℚ, and its degree is 3. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (exp‘((i · (2 · π)) / 3)) & ⊢ 𝑍 = (𝑂↑𝑐(1 / 3)) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (𝑍 + (1 / 𝑍)) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (ℂfld ↾s ℚ) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝑃) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑃) & ⊢ ↑ = (.g‘(mulGrp‘𝑃)) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Poly1‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝐾 = (algSc‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑋 = (var1‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝐷 = (deg1‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝐹 = ((3 ↑ 𝑋) + (((𝐾‘-3) · 𝑋) + (𝐾‘1))) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (ℂfld minPoly ℚ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐹 = (𝑀‘𝐴) ∧ (𝐷‘𝐹) = 3) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | cos9thpiminplylem6 33931 | Evaluation of the polynomial ((𝑋↑3) + ((-3 · 𝑋) + 1)). (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (exp‘((i · (2 · π)) / 3)) & ⊢ 𝑍 = (𝑂↑𝑐(1 / 3)) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (𝑍 + (1 / 𝑍)) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (ℂfld ↾s ℚ) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝑃) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑃) & ⊢ ↑ = (.g‘(mulGrp‘𝑃)) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Poly1‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝐾 = (algSc‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑋 = (var1‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝐷 = (deg1‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝐹 = ((3 ↑ 𝑋) + (((𝐾‘-3) · 𝑋) + (𝐾‘1))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ ℂ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (((ℂfld evalSub1 ℚ)‘𝐹)‘𝑌) = ((𝑌↑3) + ((-3 · 𝑌) + 1))) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | cos9thpiminplylem5 33930 | The constructed complex number 𝐴 is a root of the polynomial ((𝑋↑3) + ((-3 · 𝑋) + 1)). (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (exp‘((i · (2 · π)) / 3)) & ⊢ 𝑍 = (𝑂↑𝑐(1 / 3)) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (𝑍 + (1 / 𝑍)) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐴↑3) + ((-3 · 𝐴) + 1)) = 0 | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | cos9thpiminplylem4 33929 | Lemma for cos9thpiminply 33932. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (exp‘((i · (2 · π)) / 3)) & ⊢ 𝑍 = (𝑂↑𝑐(1 / 3)) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑍↑6) + (𝑍↑3)) = -1 | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | cos9thpiminplylem3 33928 | Lemma for cos9thpiminply 33932. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (exp‘((i · (2 · π)) / 3)) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑂↑2) + (𝑂 + 1)) = 0 | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | vr1nz 33653 | A univariate polynomial variable cannot be the zero polynomial. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑋 = (var1‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝑍 = (0g‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑈 = (𝑆 ↾s 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Poly1‘𝑈) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑆 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑆 ∈ NzRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ (SubRing‘𝑆)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ≠ 𝑍) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | ressply1evls1 33625 | Subring evaluation of a univariate polynomial is the same as the subring evaluation in the bigger ring. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝐸 ↾s 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑂 = (𝐸 evalSub1 𝑆) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐺 evalSub1 𝑆) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Poly1‘𝐾) & ⊢ 𝐾 = (𝐸 ↾s 𝑆) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ (SubRing‘𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑆 ∈ (SubRing‘𝐺)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑄‘𝐹) = ((𝑂‘𝐹) ↾ 𝑅)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | efne0 16063 | The exponential of a complex number is nonzero. Corollary 15-4.3 of [Gleason] p. 309. (Contributed by NM, 13-Jan-2006.) (Revised by Mario Carneiro, 29-Apr-2014.) (Proof shortened by TA, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℂ → (exp‘𝐴) ≠ 0) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | modaddid 13869 | The sums of two nonnegative integers less than the modulus and an integer are equal iff the two nonnegative integers are equal. (Contributed by AV, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘3) ∧ (𝑋 ∈ 𝐼 ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) ∧ 𝐾 ∈ ℤ) → (((𝑋 + 𝐾) mod 𝑁) = ((𝑌 + 𝐾) mod 𝑁) ↔ 𝑋 = 𝑌)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | modaddb 13868 | Addition property of the modulo operation. Biconditional version of modadd1 13867 by applying modadd1 13867 twice. (Contributed by AV, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (((𝐴 ∈ ℝ ∧ 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) ∧ (𝐶 ∈ ℝ ∧ 𝐷 ∈ ℝ+)) → ((𝐴 mod 𝐷) = (𝐵 mod 𝐷) ↔ ((𝐴 + 𝐶) mod 𝐷) = ((𝐵 + 𝐶) mod 𝐷))) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | iscmd 50141 | The universal property of colimits of a diagram. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐷 Nat 𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ · = (comp‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑋((𝐶 Colimit 𝐷)‘𝐹)𝑅 ↔ ((𝑋 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ 𝑅 ∈ (𝐹𝑁((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑋))) ∧ ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∀𝑎 ∈ (𝐹𝑁((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑥))∃!𝑚 ∈ (𝑋𝐻𝑥)𝑎 = (𝑗 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ (𝑚(〈((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑗), 𝑋〉 · 𝑥)(𝑅‘𝑗))))) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | coccom 50139 | A co-cone to a diagram commutes with the diagram. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐷 Nat 𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐾 = ((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑋) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 ∈ (𝑌𝐽𝑍)) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ · = (comp‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ (𝐹𝑁𝐾)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑅‘𝑌) = ((𝑅‘𝑍)(〈((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑌), ((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑍)〉 · 𝑋)((𝑌(2nd ‘𝐹)𝑍)‘𝑀))) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | concom 50138 | A cone to a diagram commutes with the diagram. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐷 Nat 𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐾 = ((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑋) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 ∈ (𝑌𝐽𝑍)) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ · = (comp‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ (𝐾𝑁𝐹)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑅‘𝑍) = (((𝑌(2nd ‘𝐹)𝑍)‘𝑀)(〈𝑋, ((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑌)〉 · ((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑍))(𝑅‘𝑌))) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | coccl 50137 | A natural transformation to a constant functor of an object maps to morphisms whose codomain is the object. Therefore, the range of the second component of a co-cone are morphisms with a common codomain. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐷 Nat 𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐾 = ((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑋) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ (𝐹𝑁𝐾)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑅‘𝑌) ∈ (((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑌)𝐻𝑋)) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | concl 50136 | A natural transformation from a constant functor of an object maps to morphisms whose domain is the object. Therefore, the range of the second component of a cone are morphisms with a common domain. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐷 Nat 𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐾 = ((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑋) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ (𝐾𝑁𝐹)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑅‘𝑌) ∈ (𝑋𝐻((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑌))) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | relcmd 50135 | The set of colimits of a diagram is a relation. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ Rel ((𝐶 Colimit 𝐷)‘𝐹) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | reldmcmd2 50129 | The domain of (𝐶 Colimit 𝐷) is a relation. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ Rel dom (𝐶 Colimit 𝐷) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | oppfval2 49612 | Value of the opposite functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷) → ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) = 〈(1st ‘𝐹), tpos (2nd ‘𝐹)〉) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | oppfvallem 49610 | Lemma for oppfval 49611. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐹(𝐶 Func 𝐷)𝐺 → (Rel 𝐺 ∧ Rel dom 𝐺)) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | oppfvalg 49601 | Value of the opposite functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐹 ∈ V ∧ 𝐺 ∈ V) → (𝐹 oppFunc 𝐺) = if((Rel 𝐺 ∧ Rel dom 𝐺), 〈𝐹, tpos 𝐺〉, ∅)) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | reldmoppf 49600 | The domain of oppFunc is a relation. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ Rel dom oppFunc | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | df-oppf 49598 | Definition of the operation generating opposite functors. Definition 3.41 of [Adamek] p. 39. The object part of the functor is unchanged while the morphism part is transposed due to reversed direction of arrows in the opposite category. The opposite functor is a functor on opposite categories (oppfoppc 49616). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 4-Nov-2025.) Better reverse closure. (Revised by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ oppFunc = (𝑓 ∈ V, 𝑔 ∈ V ↦ if((Rel 𝑔 ∧ Rel dom 𝑔), 〈𝑓, tpos 𝑔〉, ∅)) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | lamberte 47336 | A value of Lambert W (product logarithm) function at e. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑅 = ◡(𝑥 ∈ ℂ ↦ (𝑥 · (exp‘𝑥))) ⇒ ⊢ e𝑅1 | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | lambert0 47335 | A value of Lambert W (product logarithm) function at zero. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑅 = ◡(𝑥 ∈ ℂ ↦ (𝑥 · (exp‘𝑥))) ⇒ ⊢ 0𝑅0 | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | sbralie 3315 | Implicit to explicit substitution that swaps variables in a restrictedly universally quantified expression. (Contributed by NM, 5-Sep-2004.) Avoid ax-ext 2708, df-cleq 2728, df-clel 2811. (Revised by Wolf Lammen, 10-Mar-2025.) Avoid ax-10 2147, ax-12 2185. (Revised by SN, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝑦 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓)) ⇒ ⊢ (∀𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 𝜑 ↔ [𝑦 / 𝑥]∀𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 𝜓) | ||
| 12-Nov-2025 | cmdfval2 50131 | The set of colimits of a diagram. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 12-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐶 Colimit 𝐷)‘𝐹) = ((𝐶Δfunc𝐷)(𝐶 UP (𝐷 FuncCat 𝐶))𝐹) | ||
| 12-Nov-2025 | cmdfval 50125 | Function value of Colimit. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 12-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐶 Colimit 𝐷) = (𝑓 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐶) ↦ ((𝐶Δfunc𝐷)(𝐶 UP (𝐷 FuncCat 𝐶))𝑓)) | ||
| 12-Nov-2025 | reldmcmd 50123 | The domain of Colimit is a relation. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 12-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ Rel dom Colimit | ||
| 12-Nov-2025 | reldmlmd 50122 | The domain of Limit is a relation. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 12-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ Rel dom Limit | ||
| 12-Nov-2025 | df-cmd 50121 |
A co-cone (or cocone) to a diagram (see df-lmd 50120 for definition), or a
natural sink for a diagram in a category 𝐶 is a pair of an object
𝑋 in 𝐶 and a natural
transformation from the diagram to the
constant functor (or constant diagram) of the object 𝑋. The
second
component associates each object in the index category with a morphism
in 𝐶 whose codomain is 𝑋 (coccl 50137). The naturality guarantees
that the combination of the diagram with the co-cone must commute
(coccom 50139). Definition 11.27(1) of [Adamek] p. 202.
A colimit of a diagram 𝐹:𝐷⟶𝐶 of type 𝐷 in category 𝐶 is a universal pair from the diagram to the diagonal functor (𝐶Δfunc𝐷). The universal pair is a co-cone to the diagram satisfying the universal property, that each co-cone to the diagram uniquely factors through the colimit. (iscmd 50141). Definition 11.27(2) of [Adamek] p. 202. Initial objects (initocmd 50144), coproducts, coequalizers, pushouts, and direct limits can be considered as colimits of some diagram; colimits can be further generalized as left Kan extensions (cmdlan 50147). "cmd" is short for "colimit of a diagram". See df-lmd 50120 for the dual concept (lmddu 50142, cmddu 50143). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 12-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ Colimit = (𝑐 ∈ V, 𝑑 ∈ V ↦ (𝑓 ∈ (𝑑 Func 𝑐) ↦ ((𝑐Δfunc𝑑)(𝑐 UP (𝑑 FuncCat 𝑐))𝑓))) | ||
| 12-Nov-2025 | df-lmd 50120 |
A diagram of type 𝐷 or a 𝐷-shaped diagram in a
category 𝐶,
is a functor 𝐹:𝐷⟶𝐶 where the source category 𝐷,
usually
small or even finite, is called the index category or the scheme of the
diagram. The actual objects and morphisms in 𝐷 are largely
irrelevant; only the way in which they are interrelated matters. The
diagram is thought of as indexing a collection of objects and morphisms
in 𝐶 patterned on 𝐷. Definition 11.1(1) of
[Adamek] p. 193.
A cone to a diagram, or a natural source for a diagram in a category 𝐶 is a pair of an object 𝑋 in 𝐶 and a natural transformation from the constant functor (or constant diagram) of the object 𝑋 to the diagram. The second component associates each object in the index category with a morphism in 𝐶 whose domain is 𝑋 (concl 50136). The naturality guarantees that the combination of the diagram with the cone must commute (concom 50138). Definition 11.3(1) of [Adamek] p. 193. A limit of a diagram 𝐹:𝐷⟶𝐶 of type 𝐷 in category 𝐶 is a universal pair from the diagonal functor (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) to the diagram. The universal pair is a cone to the diagram satisfying the universal property, that each cone to the diagram uniquely factors through the limit (islmd 50140). Definition 11.3(2) of [Adamek] p. 194. Terminal objects (termolmd 50145), products, equalizers, pullbacks, and inverse limits can be considered as limits of some diagram; limits can be further generalized as right Kan extensions (lmdran 50146). "lmd" is short for "limit of a diagram". See df-cmd 50121 for the dual concept (lmddu 50142, cmddu 50143). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 12-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ Limit = (𝑐 ∈ V, 𝑑 ∈ V ↦ (𝑓 ∈ (𝑑 Func 𝑐) ↦ (( oppFunc ‘(𝑐Δfunc𝑑))((oppCat‘𝑐) UP (oppCat‘(𝑑 FuncCat 𝑐)))𝑓))) | ||
| 12-Nov-2025 | upfval 49651 | Function value of the class of universal properties. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 24-Sep-2025.) (Proof shortened by Zhi Wang, 12-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (Base‘𝐸) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Hom ‘𝐸) & ⊢ 𝑂 = (comp‘𝐸) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐷 UP 𝐸) = (𝑓 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸), 𝑤 ∈ 𝐶 ↦ {〈𝑥, 𝑚〉 ∣ ((𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ 𝑚 ∈ (𝑤𝐽((1st ‘𝑓)‘𝑥))) ∧ ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ∀𝑔 ∈ (𝑤𝐽((1st ‘𝑓)‘𝑦))∃!𝑘 ∈ (𝑥𝐻𝑦)𝑔 = (((𝑥(2nd ‘𝑓)𝑦)‘𝑘)(〈𝑤, ((1st ‘𝑓)‘𝑥)〉𝑂((1st ‘𝑓)‘𝑦))𝑚))}) | ||
| 12-Nov-2025 | reldmfunc 49550 | The domain of Func is a relation. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 12-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ Rel dom Func | ||
| 11-Nov-2025 | discthing 49936 | A discrete category, i.e., a category where all morphisms are identity morphisms, is thin. Example 3.26(1) of [Adamek] p. 33. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 11-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ (𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵)) → (𝑥𝐻𝑦) = if(𝑥 = 𝑦, {𝐼}, ∅)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ThinCat) | ||
| 11-Nov-2025 | indcthing 49935 | An indiscrete category, i.e., a category where all hom-sets have exactly one morphism, is thin. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 11-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ (𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵)) → (𝑥𝐻𝑦) = {𝐹}) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ThinCat) | ||
| 11-Nov-2025 | idfullsubc 49636 | The source category of an inclusion functor is a full subcategory of the target category if the inclusion functor is full. Remark 4.4(2) in [Adamek] p. 49. See also ressffth 17907. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 11-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Homf ‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Homf ‘𝐸) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (Base‘𝐸) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐼 ∈ (𝐷 Full 𝐸) → (𝐵 ⊆ 𝐶 ∧ (𝐽 ↾ (𝐵 × 𝐵)) = 𝐻)) | ||
| 11-Nov-2025 | gpgedgiov 48541 | The edges of the generalized Petersen graph GPG(N,K) between an inside and an outside vertex. (Contributed by AV, 11-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐽 = (1..^(⌈‘(𝑁 / 2))) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑁 gPetersenGr 𝐾) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘3) ∧ 𝐾 ∈ 𝐽) ∧ (𝑋 ∈ 𝐼 ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼)) → ({〈0, 𝑋〉, 〈1, 𝑌〉} ∈ 𝐸 ↔ 𝑋 = 𝑌)) | ||
| 11-Nov-2025 | pw2cutp1 28453 | Simplify pw2cut 28452 in the case of successors of surreal integers. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℤs) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ({(𝐴 /su (2s↑s𝑁))} |s {((𝐴 +s 1s ) /su (2s↑s𝑁))}) = (((2s ·s 𝐴) +s 1s ) /su (2s↑s(𝑁 +s 1s )))) | ||
| 10-Nov-2025 | idsubc 49635 | The source category of an inclusion functor is a subcategory of the target category. See also Remark 4.4 in [Adamek] p. 49. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 10-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Homf ‘𝐷) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐼 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸) → 𝐻 ∈ (Subcat‘𝐸)) | ||
| 10-Nov-2025 | idfth 49633 | The inclusion functor is a faithful functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 10-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐼 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸) → 𝐼 ∈ (𝐷 Faith 𝐸)) | ||
| 10-Nov-2025 | fthcomf 49632 | Source categories of a faithful functor have the same base, hom-sets and composition operation if the composition is compatible in images of the functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 10-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐴 Faith 𝐶)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐵 Func 𝐷)𝐺) & ⊢ (((𝜑 ∧ (𝑥 ∈ (Base‘𝐴) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ (Base‘𝐴) ∧ 𝑧 ∈ (Base‘𝐴))) ∧ (𝑓 ∈ (𝑥(Hom ‘𝐴)𝑦) ∧ 𝑔 ∈ (𝑦(Hom ‘𝐴)𝑧))) → (((𝑦𝐺𝑧)‘𝑔)(〈(𝐹‘𝑥), (𝐹‘𝑦)〉(comp‘𝐶)(𝐹‘𝑧))((𝑥𝐺𝑦)‘𝑓)) = (((𝑦𝐺𝑧)‘𝑔)(〈(𝐹‘𝑥), (𝐹‘𝑦)〉(comp‘𝐷)(𝐹‘𝑧))((𝑥𝐺𝑦)‘𝑓))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐴) = (compf‘𝐵)) | ||
| 10-Nov-2025 | imaidfu2 49586 | The image of the identity functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 10-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Homf ‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐾 = (𝑥 ∈ 𝑆, 𝑦 ∈ 𝑆 ↦ ∪ 𝑝 ∈ ((◡(1st ‘𝐼) “ {𝑥}) × (◡(1st ‘𝐼) “ {𝑦}))(((2nd ‘𝐼)‘𝑝) “ (𝐻‘𝑝))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑆 = (Base‘𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐽 = 𝐾) | ||
| 10-Nov-2025 | imaidfu 49585 | The image of the identity functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 10-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Homf ‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐾 = (𝑥 ∈ 𝑆, 𝑦 ∈ 𝑆 ↦ ∪ 𝑝 ∈ ((◡(1st ‘𝐼) “ {𝑥}) × (◡(1st ‘𝐼) “ {𝑦}))(((2nd ‘𝐼)‘𝑝) “ (𝐻‘𝑝))) & ⊢ 𝑆 = ((1st ‘𝐼) “ 𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐽 ↾ (𝑆 × 𝑆)) = 𝐾) | ||
| 10-Nov-2025 | imaidfu2lem 49584 | Lemma for imaidfu2 49586. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 10-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐼) “ (Base‘𝐷)) = (Base‘𝐷)) | ||
| 10-Nov-2025 | idfu2nda 49578 | Value of the morphism part of the identity functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 10-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐻 = (𝑋(Hom ‘𝐷)𝑌)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋(2nd ‘𝐼)𝑌) = ( I ↾ 𝐻)) | ||
| 10-Nov-2025 | idfu1a 49577 | Value of the object part of the identity functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 10-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐼)‘𝑋) = 𝑋) | ||
| 10-Nov-2025 | idfu1sta 49576 | Value of the object part of the identity functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 10-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (1st ‘𝐼) = ( I ↾ 𝐵)) | ||
| 10-Nov-2025 | idfu1stalem 49575 | Lemma for idfu1sta 49576. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 10-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶)) | ||
| 10-Nov-2025 | idfurcl 49573 | Reverse closure for an identity functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 10-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((idfunc‘𝐶) ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸) → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) | ||
| 10-Nov-2025 | funchomf 49572 | Source categories of a functor have the same set of objects and morphisms. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 10-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐴 Func 𝐶)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐵 Func 𝐷)𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐴) = (Homf ‘𝐵)) | ||
| 10-Nov-2025 | pgjsgr 48568 | A Petersen graph is a simple graph. (Contributed by AV, 10-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (5 gPetersenGr 2) ∈ USGraph | ||
| 10-Nov-2025 | pglem 48567 | Lemma for theorems about Petersen graphs. (Contributed by AV, 10-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 2 ∈ (1..^(⌈‘(5 / 2))) | ||
| 10-Nov-2025 | ndmfvrcl 6873 | Reverse closure law for function with the empty set not in its domain (if 𝑅 = 𝑆). (Contributed by NM, 26-Apr-1996.) The class containing the function value does not have to be the domain. (Revised by Zhi Wang, 10-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ dom 𝐹 = 𝑆 & ⊢ ¬ ∅ ∈ 𝑅 ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐹‘𝐴) ∈ 𝑅 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑆) | ||
| 9-Nov-2025 | pgn4cyclex 48602 | A cycle in a Petersen graph G(5,2) does not have length 4. (Contributed by AV, 9-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐹(Cycles‘𝐺)𝑃 → (♯‘𝐹) ≠ 4) | ||
| 9-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgr 48601 | In a Petersen graph, two different neighbors of a vertex have exactly one common neighbor, which is the vertex itself. (Contributed by AV, 9-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐾 ∈ 𝑁 ∧ 𝐿 ∈ 𝑁 ∧ 𝐾 ≠ 𝐿) → ∃!𝑥 ∈ 𝑉 {{𝐾, 𝑥}, {𝑥, 𝐿}} ⊆ 𝐸) | ||
| 9-Nov-2025 | cos9thpiminplylem2 33927 | The polynomial ((𝑋↑3) + ((-3 · 𝑋) + 1)) has no rational roots. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 9-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ ℚ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋↑3) + ((-3 · 𝑋) + 1)) ≠ 0) | ||
| 9-Nov-2025 | cos9thpiminplylem1 33926 | The polynomial ((𝑋↑3) + ((-3 · (𝑋↑2)) + 1)) has no integer roots. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 9-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ ℤ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋↑3) + ((-3 · (𝑋↑2)) + 1)) ≠ 0) | ||
| 9-Nov-2025 | oexpled 32920 | Odd power monomials are monotonic. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 9-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ¬ 2 ∥ 𝑁) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ≤ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴↑𝑁) ≤ (𝐵↑𝑁)) | ||
| 9-Nov-2025 | expevenpos 32919 | Even powers are positive. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 9-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 2 ∥ 𝑁) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 0 ≤ (𝐴↑𝑁)) | ||
| 9-Nov-2025 | elq2 32885 | Elementhood in the rational numbers, providing the canonical representation. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 9-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑄 ∈ ℚ → ∃𝑝 ∈ ℤ ∃𝑞 ∈ ℕ (𝑄 = (𝑝 / 𝑞) ∧ (𝑝 gcd 𝑞) = 1)) | ||
| 9-Nov-2025 | receqid 32817 | Real numbers equal to their own reciprocal have absolute value 1. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 9-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1 / 𝐴) = 𝐴 ↔ (abs‘𝐴) = 1)) | ||
| 9-Nov-2025 | sgnval2 32808 | Value of the signum of a real number, expresssed using absolute value. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 9-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℝ ∧ 𝐴 ≠ 0) → (sgn‘𝐴) = (𝐴 / (abs‘𝐴))) | ||
| 9-Nov-2025 | z12negsclb 28473 | A surreal is a dyadic fraction iff its negative is. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 9-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ No → (𝐴 ∈ ℤs[1/2] ↔ ( -us ‘𝐴) ∈ ℤs[1/2])) | ||
| 9-Nov-2025 | z12negscl 28470 | The dyadics are closed under negation. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 9-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℤs[1/2] → ( -us ‘𝐴) ∈ ℤs[1/2]) | ||
| 8-Nov-2025 | gpgedgel 48526 | An edge in a generalized Petersen graph 𝐺. (Contributed by AV, 29-Aug-2025.) (Proof shortened by AV, 8-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (1..^(⌈‘(𝑁 / 2))) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑁 gPetersenGr 𝐾) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘3) ∧ 𝐾 ∈ 𝐽) → (𝑌 ∈ 𝐸 ↔ ∃𝑥 ∈ 𝐼 (𝑌 = {〈0, 𝑥〉, 〈0, ((𝑥 + 1) mod 𝑁)〉} ∨ 𝑌 = {〈0, 𝑥〉, 〈1, 𝑥〉} ∨ 𝑌 = {〈1, 𝑥〉, 〈1, ((𝑥 + 𝐾) mod 𝑁)〉}))) | ||
| 8-Nov-2025 | z12sge0 28475 | An expression for non-negative dyadic rationals. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 8-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ No ∧ 0s ≤s 𝐴) → (𝐴 ∈ ℤs[1/2] ↔ ∃𝑥 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑦 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑝 ∈ ℕ0s (𝐴 = (𝑥 +s (𝑦 /su (2s↑s𝑝))) ∧ 𝑦 <s (2s↑s𝑝)))) | ||
| 8-Nov-2025 | pw2divsnegd 28441 | Move negative sign inside of a power of two division. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 8-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( -us ‘(𝐴 /su (2s↑s𝑁))) = (( -us ‘𝐴) /su (2s↑s𝑁))) | ||
| 8-Nov-2025 | nnexpscl 28425 | Closure law for positive surreal integer exponentiation. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 8-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℕs ∧ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) → (𝐴↑s𝑁) ∈ ℕs) | ||
| 8-Nov-2025 | eucliddivs 28368 | Euclid's division lemma for surreal numbers. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 8-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℕ0s ∧ 𝐵 ∈ ℕs) → ∃𝑝 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑞 ∈ ℕ0s (𝐴 = ((𝐵 ·s 𝑝) +s 𝑞) ∧ 𝑞 <s 𝐵)) | ||
| 8-Nov-2025 | nnm1n0s 28367 | A positive surreal integer minus one is a non-negative surreal integer. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 8-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ ℕs → (𝑁 -s 1s ) ∈ ℕ0s) | ||
| 8-Nov-2025 | nn1m1nns 28366 | Every positive surreal integer is either one or a successor. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 8-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℕs → (𝐴 = 1s ∨ (𝐴 -s 1s ) ∈ ℕs)) | ||
| 8-Nov-2025 | n0lesm1lt 28359 | Non-negative surreal ordering relation. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 8-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑀 ∈ ℕ0s ∧ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) → (𝑀 ≤s 𝑁 ↔ (𝑀 -s 1s ) <s 𝑁)) | ||
| 8-Nov-2025 | oniso 28263 | The birthday function restricted to the surreal ordinals forms an order-preserving isomorphism with the regular ordinals. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 8-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ( bday ↾ Ons) Isom <s , E (Ons, On) | ||
| 7-Nov-2025 | imasubc3 49631 | An image of a functor injective on objects is a subcategory. Remark 4.2(3) of [Adamek] p. 48. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 7-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (𝐹 “ 𝐴) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐾 = (𝑥 ∈ 𝑆, 𝑦 ∈ 𝑆 ↦ ∪ 𝑝 ∈ ((◡𝐹 “ {𝑥}) × (◡𝐹 “ {𝑦}))((𝐺‘𝑝) “ (𝐻‘𝑝))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → Fun ◡𝐹) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (Subcat‘𝐸)) | ||
| 7-Nov-2025 | imaf1co 49630 | An image of a functor whose object part is injective preserves the composition. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 7-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (𝐹 “ 𝐴) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐾 = (𝑥 ∈ 𝑆, 𝑦 ∈ 𝑆 ↦ ∪ 𝑝 ∈ ((◡𝐹 “ {𝑥}) × (◡𝐹 “ {𝑦}))((𝐺‘𝑝) “ (𝐻‘𝑝))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (Base‘𝐸) & ⊢ ∙ = (comp‘𝐸) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝐵–1-1→𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍 ∈ 𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 ∈ (𝑋𝐾𝑌)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ (𝑌𝐾𝑍)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑁(〈𝑋, 𝑌〉 ∙ 𝑍)𝑀) ∈ (𝑋𝐾𝑍)) | ||
(29-Jul-2020) Mario Carneiro presented MM0 at the CICM conference. See this Google Group post which includes a YouTube link.
(20-Jul-2020) Rohan Ridenour found 5 shorter D-proofs in our Shortest known proofs... file. In particular, he reduced *4.39 from 901 to 609 steps. A note on the Metamath Solitaire page mentions a tool that he worked with.
(19-Jul-2020) David A. Wheeler posted a video (https://youtu.be/3R27Qx69jHc) on how to (re)prove Schwabh�user 4.6 for the Metamath Proof Explorer. See also his older videos.
(19-Jul-2020) In version 0.184 of the metamath program, "verify markup" now checks that mathboxes are independent i.e. do not cross-reference each other. To turn off this check, use "/mathbox_skip"
(30-Jun-2020) In version 0.183 of the metamath program, (1) "verify markup" now has checking for (i) underscores in labels, (ii) that *ALT and *OLD theorems have both discouragement tags, and (iii) that lines don't have trailing spaces. (2) "save proof.../rewrap" no longer left-aligns $p/$a comments that contain the string "<HTML>"; see this note.
(5-Apr-2020) Glauco Siliprandi added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, e is Transcendental etransc, bringing the Metamath total to 74.
(12-Feb-2020) A bug in the 'minimize' command of metamath.exe versions 0.179 (29-Nov-2019) and 0.180 (10-Dec-2019) may incorrectly bring in the use of new axioms. Version 0.181 fixes it.
(20-Jan-2020) David A. Wheeler created a video called Walkthrough of the tutorial in mmj2. See the Google Group announcement for more details. (All of his videos are listed on the Other Metamath-Related Topics page.)
(18-Jan-2020) The FOMM 2020 talks are on youtube now. Mario Carneiro's talk is Metamath Zero, or: How to Verify a Verifier. Since they are washed out in the video, the PDF slides are available separately.
(14-Dec-2019) Glauco Siliprandi added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Fourier series convergence fourier, bringing the Metamath total to 73.
(25-Nov-2019) Alexander van der Vekens added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, The Cayley-Hamilton Theorem cayleyhamilton, bringing the Metamath total to 72.
(25-Oct-2019) Mario Carneiro's paper "Metamath Zero: The Cartesian Theorem Prover" (submitted to CPP 2020) is now available on arXiv: https://arxiv.org/abs/1910.10703. There is a related discussion on Hacker News.
(30-Sep-2019) Mario Carneiro's talk about MM0 at ITP 2019 is available on YouTube: x86 verification from scratch (24 minutes). Google Group discussion: Metamath Zero.
(29-Sep-2019) David Wheeler created a fascinating Gource video that animates the construction of set.mm, available on YouTube: Metamath set.mm contributions viewed with Gource through 2019-09-26 (4 minutes). Google Group discussion: Gource video of set.mm contributions.
(24-Sep-2019) nLab added a page for Metamath. It mentions Stefan O'Rear's Busy Beaver work using the set.mm axiomatization (and fails to mention Mario's definitional soundness checker)
(1-Sep-2019) Xuanji Li published a Visual Studio Code extension to support metamath syntax highlighting.
(10-Aug-2019) (revised 21-Sep-2019) Version 0.178 of the metamath program has the following changes: (1) "minimize_with" will now prevent dependence on new $a statements unless the new qualifier "/allow_new_axioms" is specified. For routine usage, it is suggested that you use "minimize_with * /allow_new_axioms * /no_new_axioms_from ax-*" instead of just "minimize_with *". See "help minimize_with" and this Google Group post. Also note that the qualifier "/allow_growth" has been renamed to "/may_grow". (2) "/no_versioning" was added to "write theorem_list".
(8-Jul-2019) Jon Pennant announced the creation of a Metamath search engine. Try it and feel free to comment on it at https://groups.google.com/d/msg/metamath/cTeU5AzUksI/5GesBfDaCwAJ.
(16-May-2019) Set.mm now has a major new section on elementary geometry. This begins with definitions that implement Tarski's axioms of geometry (including concepts such as congruence and betweenness). This uses set.mm's extensible structures, making them easier to use for many circumstances. The section then connects Tarski geometry with geometry in Euclidean places. Most of the work in this section is due to Thierry Arnoux, with earlier work by Mario Carneiro and Scott Fenton. [Reported by DAW.]
(9-May-2019) We are sad to report that long-time contributor Alan Sare passed away on Mar. 23. There is some more information at the top of his mathbox (click on "Mathbox for Alan Sare") and his obituary. We extend our condolences to his family.
(10-Mar-2019) Jon Pennant and Mario Carneiro added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Heron's formula heron, bringing the Metamath total to 71.
(22-Feb-2019) Alexander van der Vekens added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Cramer's rule cramer, bringing the Metamath total to 70.
(6-Feb-2019) David A. Wheeler has made significant improvements and updates to the Metamath book. Any comments, errors found, or suggestions are welcome and should be turned into an issue or pull request at https://github.com/metamath/metamath-book (or sent to me if you prefer).
(26-Dec-2018) I added Appendix 8 to the MPE Home Page that cross-references new and old axiom numbers.
(20-Dec-2018) The axioms have been renumbered according to this Google Groups post.
(24-Nov-2018) Thierry Arnoux created a new page on topological structures. The page along with its SVG files are maintained on GitHub.
(11-Oct-2018) Alexander van der Vekens added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, the Friendship Theorem friendship, bringing the Metamath total to 69.
(1-Oct-2018) Naip Moro has written gramm, a Metamath proof verifier written in Antlr4/Java.
(16-Sep-2018) The definition df-riota has been simplified so that it evaluates to the empty set instead of an Undef value. This change affects a significant part of set.mm.
(2-Sep-2018) Thierry Arnoux added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Euler's partition theorem eulerpart, bringing the Metamath total to 68.
(1-Sep-2018) The Kate editor now has Metamath syntax highlighting built in. (Communicated by Wolf Lammen.)
(15-Aug-2018) The Intuitionistic Logic Explorer now has a Most Recent Proofs page.
(4-Aug-2018) Version 0.163 of the metamath program now indicates (with an asterisk) which Table of Contents headers have associated comments.
(10-May-2018) George Szpiro, journalist and author of several books on popular mathematics such as Poincare's Prize and Numbers Rule, used a genetic algorithm to find shorter D-proofs of "*3.37" and "meredith" in our Shortest known proofs... file.
(19-Apr-2018) The EMetamath Eclipse plugin has undergone many improvements since its initial release as the change log indicates. Thierry uses it as his main proof assistant and writes, "I added support for mmj2's auto-transformations, which allows it to infer several steps when building proofs. This added a lot of comfort for writing proofs.... I can now switch back and forth between the proof assistant and editing the Metamath file.... I think no other proof assistant has this feature."
(11-Apr-2018) Benoît Jubin solved an open problem about the "Axiom of Twoness," showing that it is necessary for completeness. See item 14 on the "Open problems and miscellany" page.
(25-Mar-2018) Giovanni Mascellani has announced mmpp, a new proof editing environment for the Metamath language.
(27-Feb-2018) Bill Hale has released an app for the Apple iPad and desktop computer that allows you to browse Metamath theorems and their proofs.
(17-Jan-2018) Dylan Houlihan has kindly provided a new mirror site. He has also provided an rsync server; type "rsync uk.metamath.org::" in a bash shell to check its status (it should return "metamath metamath").
(15-Jan-2018) The metamath program, version 0.157, has been updated to implement the file inclusion conventions described in the 21-Dec-2017 entry of mmnotes.txt.
(11-Dec-2017) I added a paragraph, suggested by Gérard Lang, to the distinct variable description here.
(10-Dec-2017) Per FL's request, his mathbox will be removed from set.mm. If you wish to export any of his theorems, today's version (master commit 1024a3a) is the last one that will contain it.
(11-Nov-2017) Alan Sare updated his completeusersproof program.
(3-Oct-2017) Sean B. Palmer created a web page that runs the metamath program under emulated Linux in JavaScript. He also wrote some programs to work with our shortest known proofs of the PM propositional calculus theorems.
(28-Sep-2017) Ivan Kuckir wrote a tutorial blog entry, Introduction to Metamath, that summarizes the language syntax. (It may have been written some time ago, but I was not aware of it before.)
(26-Sep-2017) The default directory for the Metamath Proof Explorer (MPE) has been changed from the GIF version (mpegif) to the Unicode version (mpeuni) throughout the site. Please let me know if you find broken links or other issues.
(24-Sep-2017) Saveliy Skresanov added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Ceva's Theorem cevath, bringing the Metamath total to 67.
(3-Sep-2017) Brendan Leahy added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Area of a Circle areacirc, bringing the Metamath total to 66.
(7-Aug-2017) Mario Carneiro added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Principle of Inclusion/Exclusion incexc, bringing the Metamath total to 65.
(1-Jul-2017) Glauco Siliprandi added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Stirling's Formula stirling, bringing the Metamath total to 64. Related theorems include 2 versions of Wallis' formula for π (wallispi and wallispi2).
(7-May-2017) Thierry Arnoux added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Betrand's Ballot Problem ballotth, bringing the Metamath total to 63.
(20-Apr-2017) Glauco Siliprandi added a new proof in the supplementary list on the 100 theorem list, Stone-Weierstrass Theorem stowei.
(28-Feb-2017) David Moews added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Product of Segments of Chords chordthm, bringing the Metamath total to 62.
(1-Jan-2017) Saveliy Skresanov added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Isosceles triangle theorem isosctr, bringing the Metamath total to 61.
(1-Jan-2017) Mario Carneiro added 2 new proofs to the 100 theorem list, L'Hôpital's Rule lhop and Taylor's Theorem taylth, bringing the Metamath total to 60.
(28-Dec-2016) David A. Wheeler is putting together a page on Metamath (specifically set.mm) conventions. Comments are welcome on the Google Group thread.
(24-Dec-2016) Mario Carneiro introduced the abbreviation "F/ x ph" (symbols: turned F, x, phi) in df-nf to represent the "effectively not free" idiom "A. x ( ph -> A. x ph )". Theorem nf2 shows a version without nested quantifiers.
(22-Dec-2016) Naip Moro has developed a Metamath database for G. Spencer-Brown's Laws of Form. You can follow the Google Group discussion here.
(20-Dec-2016) In metamath program version 0.137, 'verify markup *' now checks that ax-XXX $a matches axXXX $p when the latter exists, per the discussion at https://groups.google.com/d/msg/metamath/Vtz3CKGmXnI/Fxq3j1I_EQAJ.
(24-Nov-2016) Mingl Yuan has kindly provided a mirror site in Beijing, China. He has also provided an rsync server; type "rsync cn.metamath.org::" in a bash shell to check its status (it should return "metamath metamath").
(14-Aug-2016) All HTML pages on this site should now be mobile-friendly and pass the Mobile-Friendly Test. If you find one that does not, let me know.
(14-Aug-2016) Daniel Whalen wrote a paper describing the use of using deep learning to prove 14% of test theorems taken from set.mm: Holophrasm: a neural Automated Theorem Prover for higher-order logic. The associated program is called Holophrasm.
(14-Aug-2016) David A. Wheeler created a video called Metamath Proof Explorer: A Modern Principia Mathematica
(12-Aug-2016) A Gitter chat room has been created for Metamath.
(9-Aug-2016) Mario Carneiro wrote a Metamath proof verifier in the Scala language as part of the ongoing Metamath -> MMT import project
(9-Aug-2016) David A. Wheeler created a GitHub project called metamath-test (last execution run) to check that different verifiers both pass good databases and detect errors in defective ones.
(4-Aug-2016) Mario gave two presentations at CICM 2016.
(17-Jul-2016) Thierry Arnoux has written EMetamath, a Metamath plugin for the Eclipse IDE.
(16-Jul-2016) Mario recovered Chris Capel's collapsible proof demo.
(13-Jul-2016) FL sent me an updated version of PDF (LaTeX source) developed with Lamport's pf2 package. See the 23-Apr-2012 entry below.
(12-Jul-2016) David A. Wheeler produced a new video for mmj2 called "Creating functions in Metamath". It shows a more efficient approach than his previous recent video "Creating functions in Metamath" (old) but it can be of interest to see both approaches.
(10-Jul-2016) Metamath program version 0.132 changes the command 'show restricted' to 'show discouraged' and adds a new command, 'set discouragement'. See the mmnotes.txt entry of 11-May-2016 (updated 10-Jul-2016).
(12-Jun-2016) Dan Getz has written Metamath.jl, a Metamath proof verifier written in the Julia language.
(10-Jun-2016) If you are using metamath program versions 0.128, 0.129, or 0.130, please update to version 0.131. (In the bad versions, 'minimize_with' ignores distinct variable violations.)
(1-Jun-2016) Mario Carneiro added new proofs to the 100 theorem list, the Prime Number Theorem pnt and the Perfect Number Theorem perfect, bringing the Metamath total to 58.
(12-May-2016) Mario Carneiro added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Dirichlet's theorem dirith, bringing the Metamath total to 56. (Added 17-May-2016) An informal exposition of the proof can be found at http://metamath-blog.blogspot.com/2016/05/dirichlets-theorem.html
(10-Mar-2016) Metamath program version 0.125 adds a new qualifier, /fast, to 'save proof'. See the mmnotes.txt entry of 10-Mar-2016.
(6-Mar-2016) The most recent set.mm has a large update converting variables from letters to symbols. See this Google Groups post.
(16-Feb-2016) Mario Carneiro's new paper "Models for Metamath" can be found here and on arxiv.org.
(6-Feb-2016) There are now 22 math symbols that can be used as variable names. See mmascii.html near the 50th table row, starting with "./\".
(29-Jan-2016) Metamath program version 0.123 adds /packed and /explicit qualifiers to 'save proof' and 'show proof'. See this Google Groups post.
(13-Jan-2016) The Unicode math symbols now provide for external CSS and use the XITS web font. Thanks to David A. Wheeler, Mario Carneiro, Cris Perdue, Jason Orendorff, and Frédéric Liné for discussions on this topic. Two commands, htmlcss and htmlfont, were added to the $t comment in set.mm and are recognized by Metamath program version 0.122.
(21-Dec-2015) Axiom ax-12, now renamed ax-12o, was replaced by a new shorter equivalent, ax-12. The equivalence is provided by theorems ax12o and ax12.
(13-Dec-2015) A new section on the theory of classes was added to the MPE Home Page. Thanks to Gérard Lang for suggesting this section and improvements to it.
(17-Nov-2015) Metamath program version 0.121: 'verify markup' was added to check comment markup consistency; see 'help verify markup'. You are encouraged to make sure 'verify markup */f' has no warnings prior to mathbox submissions. The date consistency rules are given in this Google Groups post.
(23-Sep-2015) Drahflow wrote, "I am currently working on yet another proof assistant, main reason being: I understand stuff best if I code it. If anyone is interested: https://github.com/Drahflow/Igor (but in my own programming language, so expect a complicated build process :P)"
(23-Aug-2015) Ivan Kuckir created MM Tool, a Metamath proof verifier and editor written in JavaScript that runs in a browser.
(25-Jul-2015) Axiom ax-10 is shown to be redundant by theorem ax10 , so it was removed from the predicate calculus axiom list.
(19-Jul-2015) Mario Carneiro gave two talks related to Metamath at CICM 2015, which are linked to at Other Metamath-Related Topics.
(18-Jul-2015) The metamath program has been updated to version 0.118. 'show trace_back' now has a '/to' qualifier to show the path back to a specific axiom such as ax-ac. See 'help show trace_back'.
(12-Jul-2015) I added the HOL Explorer for Mario Carneiro's hol.mm database. Although the home page needs to be filled out, the proofs can be accessed.
(11-Jul-2015) I started a new page, Other Metamath-Related Topics, that will hold miscellaneous material that doesn't fit well elsewhere (or is hard to find on this site). Suggestions welcome.
(23-Jun-2015) Metamath's mascot, Penny the cat (2007 photo), passed away today. She was 18 years old.
(21-Jun-2015) Mario Carneiro added 3 new proofs to the 100 theorem list: All Primes (1 mod 4) Equal the Sum of Two Squares 2sq, The Law of Quadratic Reciprocity lgsquad and the AM-GM theorem amgm, bringing the Metamath total to 55.
(13-Jun-2015) Stefan O'Rear's smm, written in JavaScript, can now be used as a standalone proof verifier. This brings the total number of independent Metamath verifiers to 8, written in just as many languages (C, Java. JavaScript, Python, Haskell, Lua, C#, C++).
(12-Jun-2015) David A. Wheeler added 2 new proofs to the 100 theorem list: The Law of Cosines lawcos and Ptolemy's Theorem ptolemy, bringing the Metamath total to 52.
(30-May-2015) The metamath program has been updated to version 0.117. (1) David A. Wheeler provided an enhancement to speed up the 'improve' command by 28%; see README.TXT for more information. (2) In web pages with proofs, local hyperlinks on step hypotheses no longer clip the Expression cell at the top of the page.
(9-May-2015) Stefan O'Rear has created an archive of older set.mm releases back to 1998: https://github.com/sorear/set.mm-history/.
(7-May-2015) The set.mm dated 7-May-2015 is a major revision, updated by Mario, that incorporates the new ordered pair definition df-op that was agreed upon. There were 700 changes, listed at the top of set.mm. Mathbox users are advised to update their local mathboxes. As usual, if any mathbox user has trouble incorporating these changes into their mathbox in progress, Mario or I will be glad to do them for you.
(7-May-2015) Mario has added 4 new theorems to the 100 theorem list: Ramsey's Theorem ramsey, The Solution of a Cubic cubic, The Solution of the General Quartic Equation quart, and The Birthday Problem birthday. In the Supplementary List, Stefan O'Rear added the Hilbert Basis Theorem hbt.
(28-Apr-2015) A while ago, Mario Carneiro wrote up a proof of the unambiguity of set.mm's grammar, which has now been added to this site: grammar-ambiguity.txt.
(22-Apr-2015) The metamath program has been updated to version 0.114. In MM-PA, 'show new_proof/unknown' now shows the relative offset (-1, -2,...) used for 'assign' arguments, suggested by Stefan O'Rear.
(20-Apr-2015) I retrieved an old version of the missing "Metamath 100" page from archive.org and updated it to what I think is the current state: mm_100.html. Anyone who wants to edit it can email updates to this page to me.
(19-Apr-2015) The metamath program has been updated to version 0.113, mostly with patches provided by Stefan O'Rear. (1) 'show statement %' (or any command allowing label wildcards) will select statements whose proofs were changed in current session. ('help search' will show all wildcard matching rules.) (2) 'show statement =' will select the statement being proved in MM-PA. (3) The proof date stamp is now created only if the proof is complete.
(18-Apr-2015) There is now a section for Scott Fenton's NF database: New Foundations Explorer.
(16-Apr-2015) Mario describes his recent additions to set.mm at https://groups.google.com/forum/#!topic/metamath/VAGNmzFkHCs. It include 2 new additions to the Formalizing 100 Theorems list, Leibniz' series for pi (leibpi) and the Konigsberg Bridge problem (konigsberg)
(10-Mar-2015) Mario Carneiro has written a paper, "Arithmetic in Metamath, Case Study: Bertrand's Postulate," for CICM 2015. A preprint is available at arXiv:1503.02349.
(23-Feb-2015) Scott Fenton has created a Metamath formalization of NF set theory: https://github.com/sctfn/metamath-nf/. For more information, see the Metamath Google Group posting.
(28-Jan-2015) Mario Carneiro added Wilson's Theorem (wilth), Ascending or Descending Sequences (erdsze, erdsze2), and Derangements Formula (derangfmla, subfaclim), bringing the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 44.
(19-Jan-2015) Mario Carneiro added Sylow's Theorem (sylow1, sylow2, sylow2b, sylow3), bringing the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 41.
(9-Jan-2015) The hypothesis order of mpbi*an* was changed. See the Notes entry of 9-Jan-2015.
(1-Jan-2015) Mario Carneiro has written a paper, "Conversion of HOL Light proofs into Metamath," that has been submitted to the Journal of Formalized Reasoning. A preprint is available on arxiv.org.
(22-Nov-2014) Stefan O'Rear added the Solutions to Pell's Equation (rmxycomplete) and Liouville's Theorem and the Construction of Transcendental Numbers (aaliou), bringing the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 40.
(22-Nov-2014) The metamath program has been updated with version 0.111. (1) Label wildcards now have a label range indicator "~" so that e.g. you can show or search all of the statements in a mathbox. See 'help search'. (Stefan O'Rear added this to the program.) (2) A qualifier was added to 'minimize_with' to prevent the use of any axioms not already used in the proof e.g. 'minimize_with * /no_new_axioms_from ax-*' will prevent the use of ax-ac if the proof doesn't already use it. See 'help minimize_with'.
(10-Oct-2014) Mario Carneiro has encoded the axiomatic basis for the HOL theorem prover into a Metamath source file, hol.mm.
(24-Sep-2014) Mario Carneiro added the Sum of the Angles of a Triangle (ang180), bringing the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 38.
(15-Sep-2014) Mario Carneiro added the Fundamental Theorem of Algebra (fta), bringing the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 37.
(3-Sep-2014) Mario Carneiro added the Fundamental Theorem of Integral Calculus (ftc1, ftc2). This brings the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 35. (added 14-Sep-2014) Along the way, he added the Mean Value Theorem (mvth), bringing the total to 36.
(16-Aug-2014) Mario Carneiro started a Metamath blog at http://metamath-blog.blogspot.com/.
(10-Aug-2014) Mario Carneiro added Erdős's proof of the divergence of the inverse prime series (prmrec). This brings the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 34.
(31-Jul-2014) Mario Carneiro added proofs for Euler's Summation of 1 + (1/2)^2 + (1/3)^2 + .... (basel) and The Factor and Remainder Theorems (facth, plyrem). This brings the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 33.
(16-Jul-2014) Mario Carneiro added proofs for Four Squares Theorem (4sq), Formula for the Number of Combinations (hashbc), and Divisibility by 3 Rule (3dvds). This brings the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 31.
(11-Jul-2014) Mario Carneiro added proofs for Divergence of the Harmonic Series (harmonic), Order of a Subgroup (lagsubg), and Lebesgue Measure and Integration (itgcl). This brings the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 28.
(7-Jul-2014) Mario Carneiro presented a talk, "Natural Deduction in the Metamath Proof Language," at the 6PCM conference. Slides Audio
(25-Jun-2014) In version 0.108 of the metamath program, the 'minimize_with' command is now more automated. It now considers compressed proof length; it scans the statements in forward and reverse order and chooses the best; and it avoids $d conflicts. The '/no_distinct', '/brief', and '/reverse' qualifiers are obsolete, and '/verbose' no longer lists all statements scanned but gives more details about decision criteria.
(12-Jun-2014) To improve naming uniformity, theorems about operation values now use the abbreviation "ov". For example, df-opr, opreq1, oprabval5, and oprvres are now called df-ov, oveq1, ov5, and ovres respectively.
(11-Jun-2014) Mario Carneiro finished a major revision of set.mm. His notes are under the 11-Jun-2014 entry in the Notes
(4-Jun-2014) Mario Carneiro provided instructions and screenshots for syntax highlighting for the jEdit editor for use with Metamath and mmj2 source files.
(19-May-2014) Mario Carneiro added a feature to mmj2, in the build at
https://github.com/digama0/mmj2/raw/dev-build/mmj2jar/mmj2.jar, which
tests all but 5 definitions in set.mm for soundness. You can turn on
the test by adding
SetMMDefinitionsCheckWithExclusions,ax-*,df-bi,df-clab,df-cleq,df-clel,df-sbc
to your RunParms.txt file.
(17-May-2014) A number of labels were changed in set.mm, listed at the top of set.mm as usual. Note in particular that the heavily-used visset, elisseti, syl11anc, syl111anc were changed respectively to vex, elexi, syl2anc, syl3anc.
(16-May-2014) Scott Fenton formalized a proof for "Sum of kth powers": fsumkthpow. This brings the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 25.
(9-May-2014) I (Norm Megill) presented an overview of Metamath at the "Formalization of mathematics in proof assistants" workshop at the Institut Henri Poincar� in Paris. The slides for this talk are here.
(22-Jun-2014) Version 0.107 of the metamath program adds a "PART" indention level to the Statement List table of contents, adds 'show proof ... /size' to show source file bytes used, and adds 'show elapsed_time'. The last one is helpful for measuring the run time of long commands. See 'help write theorem_list', 'help show proof', and 'help show elapsed_time' for more information.
(2-May-2014) Scott Fenton formalized a proof of Sum of the Reciprocals of the Triangular Numbers: trirecip. This brings the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 24.
(19-Apr-2014) Scott Fenton formalized a proof of the Formula for Pythagorean Triples: pythagtrip. This brings the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 23.
(11-Apr-2014) David A. Wheeler produced a much-needed and well-done video for mmj2, called "Introduction to Metamath & mmj2". Thanks, David!
(15-Mar-2014) Mario Carneiro formalized a proof of Bertrand's postulate: bpos. This brings the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 22.
(18-Feb-2014) Mario Carneiro proved that complex number axiom ax-cnex is redundant (theorem cnex). See also Real and Complex Numbers.
(11-Feb-2014) David A. Wheeler has created a theorem compilation that tracks those theorems in Freek Wiedijk's Formalizing 100 Theorems list that have been proved in set.mm. If you find a error or omission in this list, let me know so it can be corrected. (Update 1-Mar-2014: Mario has added eulerth and bezout to the list.)
(4-Feb-2014) Mario Carneiro writes:
The latest commit on the mmj2 development branch introduced an exciting new feature, namely syntax highlighting for mmp files in the main window. (You can pick up the latest mmj2.jar at https://github.com/digama0/mmj2/blob/develop/mmj2jar/mmj2.jar .) The reason I am asking for your help at this stage is to help with design for the syntax tokenizer, which is responsible for breaking down the input into various tokens with names like "comment", "set", and "stephypref", which are then colored according to the user's preference. As users of mmj2 and metamath, what types of highlighting would be useful to you?One limitation of the tokenizer is that since (for performance reasons) it can be started at any line in the file, highly contextual coloring, like highlighting step references that don't exist previously in the file, is difficult to do. Similarly, true parsing of the formulas using the grammar is possible but likely to be unmanageably slow. But things like checking theorem labels against the database is quite simple to do under the current setup.
That said, how can this new feature be optimized to help you when writing proofs?
(13-Jan-2014) Mathbox users: the *19.21a*, *19.23a* series of theorems have been renamed to *alrim*, *exlim*. You can update your mathbox with a global replacement of string '19.21a' with 'alrim' and '19.23a' with 'exlim'.
(5-Jan-2014) If you downloaded mmj2 in the past 3 days, please update it with the current version, which fixes a bug introduced by the recent changes that made it unable to read in most of the proofs in the textarea properly.
(4-Jan-2014) I added a list of "Allowed substitutions" under the "Distinct variable groups" list on the theorem web pages, for example axsep. This is an experimental feature and comments are welcome.
(3-Jan-2014) Version 0.102 of the metamath program produces more space-efficient compressed proofs (still compatible with the specification in Appendix B of the Metamath book) using an algorithm suggested by Mario Carneiro. See 'help save proof' in the program. Also, mmj2 now generates proofs in the new format. The new mmj2 also has a mandatory update that fixes a bug related to the new format; you must update your mmj2 copy to use it with the latest set.mm.
(23-Dec-2013) Mario Carneiro has updated many older definitions to use the maps-to notation. If you have difficulty updating your local mathbox, contact him or me for assistance.
(1-Nov-2013) 'undo' and 'redo' commands were added to the Proof Assistant in metamath program version 0.07.99. See 'help undo' in the program.
(8-Oct-2013) Today's Notes entry describes some proof repair techniques.
(5-Oct-2013) Today's Notes entry explains some recent extensible structure improvements.
(8-Sep-2013) Mario Carneiro has revised the square root and sequence generator definitions. See today's Notes entry.
(3-Aug-2013) Mario Carneiro writes: "I finally found enough time to create a GitHub repository for development at https://github.com/digama0/mmj2. A permalink to the latest version plus source (akin to mmj2.zip) is https://github.com/digama0/mmj2/zipball/, and the jar file on its own (mmj2.jar) is at https://github.com/digama0/mmj2/blob/master/mmj2jar/mmj2.jar?raw=true. Unfortunately there is no easy way to automatically generate mmj2jar.zip, but this is available as part of the zip distribution for mmj2.zip. History tracking will be handled by the repository now. Do you have old versions of the mmj2 directory? I could add them as historical commits if you do."
(18-Jun-2013) Mario Carneiro has done a major revision and cleanup of the construction of real and complex numbers. In particular, rather than using equivalence classes as is customary for the construction of the temporary rationals, he used only "reduced fractions", so that the use of the axiom of infinity is avoided until it becomes necessary for the construction of the temporary reals.
(18-May-2013) Mario Carneiro has added the ability to produce compressed proofs to mmj2. This is not an official release but can be downloaded here if you want to try it: mmj2.jar. If you have any feedback, send it to me (NM), and I will forward it to Mario. (Disclaimer: this release has not been endorsed by Mel O'Cat. If anyone has been in contact with him, please let me know.)
(29-Mar-2013) Charles Greathouse reduced the size of our PNG symbol images using the pngout program.
(8-Mar-2013) Wolf Lammen has reorganized the theorems in the "Logical negation" section of set.mm into a more orderly, less scattered arrangement.
(27-Feb-2013) Scott Fenton has done a large cleanup of set.mm, eliminating *OLD references in 144 proofs. See the Notes entry for 27-Feb-2013.
(21-Feb-2013) *ATTENTION MATHBOX USERS* The order of hypotheses of many syl* theorems were changed, per a suggestion of Mario Carneiro. You need to update your local mathbox copy for compatibility with the new set.mm, or I can do it for you if you wish. See the Notes entry for 21-Feb-2013.
(16-Feb-2013) Scott Fenton shortened the direct-from-axiom proofs of *3.1, *3.43, *4.4, *4.41, *4.5, *4.76, *4.83, *5.33, *5.35, *5.36, and meredith in the "Shortest known proofs of the propositional calculus theorems from Principia Mathematica" (pmproofs.txt).
(27-Jan-2013) Scott Fenton writes, "I've updated Ralph Levien's mmverify.py. It's now a Python 3 program, and supports compressed proofs and file inclusion statements. This adds about fifty lines to the original program. Enjoy!"
(10-Jan-2013) A new mathbox was added for Mario Carneiro, who has contributed a number of cardinality theorems without invoking the Axiom of Choice. This is nice work, and I will be using some of these (those suffixed with "NEW") to replace the existing ones in the main part of set.mm that currently invoke AC unnecessarily.
(4-Jan-2013) As mentioned in the 19-Jun-2012 item below, Eric Schmidt discovered that the complex number axioms axaddcom (now addcom) and ax0id (now addid1) are redundant (schmidt-cnaxioms.pdf, .tex). In addition, ax1id (now mulid1) can be weakened to ax1rid. Scott Fenton has now formalized this work, so that now there are 23 instead of 25 axioms for real and complex numbers in set.mm. The Axioms for Complex Numbers page has been updated with these results. An interesting part of the proof, showing how commutativity of addition follows from other laws, is in addcomi.
(27-Nov-2012) The frequently-used theorems "an1s", "an1rs", "ancom13s", "ancom31s" were renamed to "an12s", "an32s", "an13s", "an31s" to conform to the convention for an12 etc.
(4-Nov-2012) The changes proposed in the Notes, renaming Grp to GrpOp etc., have been incorporated into set.mm. See the list of changes at the top of set.mm. If you want me to update your mathbox with these changes, send it to me along with the version of set.mm that it works with.
(20-Sep-2012) Mel O'Cat updated https://us.metamath.org/ocat/mmj2/TESTmmj2jar.zip. See the README.TXT for a description of the new features.
(21-Aug-2012) Mel O'Cat has uploaded SearchOptionsMockup9.zip, a mockup for the new search screen in mmj2. See the README.txt file for instructions. He will welcome feedback via x178g243 at yahoo.com.
(19-Jun-2012) Eric Schmidt has discovered that in our axioms for complex numbers, axaddcom and ax0id are redundant. (At some point these need to be formalized for set.mm.) He has written up these and some other nice results, including some independence results for the axioms, in schmidt-cnaxioms.pdf (schmidt-cnaxioms.tex).
(23-Apr-2012) Frédéric Liné sent me a PDF (LaTeX source) developed with Lamport's pf2 package. He wrote: "I think it works well with Metamath since the proofs are in a tree form. I use it to have a sketch of a proof. I get this way a better understanding of the proof and I can cut down its size. For instance, inpreima5 was reduced by 50% when I wrote the corresponding proof with pf2."
(5-Mar-2012) I added links to Wikiproofs and its recent changes in the "Wikis" list at the top of this page.
(12-Jan-2012) Thanks to William Hoza who sent me a ZFC T-shirt, and thanks to the ZFC models (courtesy of the Inaccessible Cardinals agency).
| Front | Back | Detail |
|
|
|
|
(24-Nov-2011) In metamath program version 0.07.71, the 'minimize_with' command by default now scans from bottom to top instead of top to bottom, since empirically this often (although not always) results in a shorter proof. A top to bottom scan can be specified with a new qualifier '/reverse'. You can try both methods (starting from the same original proof, of course) and pick the shorter proof.
(15-Oct-2011) From Mel O'Cat:
I just uploaded mmj2.zip containing the 1-Nov-2011 (20111101)
release:
https://us.metamath.org/ocat/mmj2/mmj2.zip
https://us.metamath.org/ocat/mmj2/mmj2.md5
A few last minute tweaks:
1. I now bless double-click starting of mmj2.bat (MacMMJ2.command in Mac OS-X)!
See mmj2\QuickStart.html
2. Much improved support of Mac OS-X systems.
See mmj2\QuickStart.html
3. I tweaked the Command Line Argument Options report to
a) print every time;
b) print as much as possible even if
there are errors in the command line arguments -- and the
last line printed corresponds to the argument in error;
c) removed Y/N argument on the command line to enable/disable
the report. this simplifies things.
4) Documentation revised, including the PATutorial.
See CHGLOG.TXT for list of all changes.
Good luck. And thanks for all of your help!
(15-Sep-2011) MATHBOX USERS: I made a large number of label name changes to set.mm to improve naming consistency. There is a script at the top of the current set.mm that you can use to update your mathbox or older set.mm. Or if you wish, I can do the update on your next mathbox submission - in that case, please include a .zip of the set.mm version you used.
(30-Aug-2011) Scott Fenton shortened the direct-from-axiom proofs of *3.33, *3.45, *4.36, and meredith in the "Shortest known proofs of the propositional calculus theorems from Principia Mathematica" (pmproofs.txt).
(21-Aug-2011) A post on reddit generated 60,000 hits (and a TOS violation notice from my provider...),
(18-Aug-2011) The Metamath Google Group has a discussion of my canonical conjunctions proposal. Any feedback directly to me (Norm Megill) is also welcome.
(4-Jul-2011) John Baker has provided (metamath_kindle.zip) "a modified version of [the] metamath.tex [Metamath] book source that is formatted for the Kindle. If you compile the document the resulting PDF can be loaded into into a Kindle and easily read." (Update: the PDF file is now included also.)
(3-Jul-2011) Nested 'submit' calls are now allowed, in metamath program version 0.07.68. Thus you can create or modify a command file (script) from within a command file then 'submit' it. While 'submit' cannot pass arguments (nor are there plans to add this feature), you can 'substitute' strings in the 'submit' target file before calling it in order to emulate this.
(28-Jun-2011)The metamath program version 0.07.64 adds the '/include_mathboxes' qualifier to 'minimize_with'; by default, 'minimize_with *' will now skip checking user mathboxes. Since mathboxes should be independent from each other, this will help prevent accidental cross-"contamination". Also, '/rewrap' was added to 'write source' to automatically wrap $a and $p comments so as to conform to the current formatting conventions used in set.mm. This means you no longer have to be concerned about line length < 80 etc.
(19-Jun-2011) ATTENTION MATHBOX USERS: The wff variables et, ze, si, and rh are now global. This change was made primarily to resolve some conflicts between mathboxes, but it will also let you avoid having to constantly redeclare these locally in the future. Unfortunately, this change can affect the $f hypothesis order, which can cause proofs referencing theorems that use these variables to fail. All mathbox proofs currently in set.mm have been corrected for this, and you should refresh your local copy for further development of your mathbox. You can correct your proofs that are not in set.mm as follows. Only the proofs that fail under the current set.mm (using version 0.07.62 or later of the metamath program) need to be modified.
To fix a proof that references earlier theorems using et, ze, si, and rh, do the following (using a hypothetical theorem 'abc' as an example): 'prove abc' (ignore error messages), 'delete floating', 'initialize all', 'unify all/interactive', 'improve all', 'save new_proof/compressed'. If your proof uses dummy variables, these must be reassigned manually.
To fix a proof that uses et, ze, si, and rh as local variables, make sure the proof is saved in 'compressed' format. Then delete the local declarations ($v and $f statements) and follow the same steps above to correct the proof.
I apologize for the inconvenience. If you have trouble fixing your proofs, you can contact me for assistance.
Note: Versions of the metamath program before 0.07.62 did not flag an error when global variables were redeclared locally, as it should have according to the spec. This caused these spec violations to go unnoticed in some older set.mm versions. The new error messages are in fact just informational and can be ignored when working with older set.mm versions.
(7-Jun-2011) The metamath program version 0.07.60 fixes a bug with the 'minimize_with' command found by Andrew Salmon.
(12-May-2010) Andrew Salmon shortened many proofs, shown above. For comparison, I have temporarily kept the old version, which is suffixed with OLD, such as oridmOLD for oridm.
(9-Dec-2010) Eric Schmidt has written a Metamath proof verifier in C++, called checkmm.cpp.
(3-Oct-2010) The following changes were made to the tokens in set.mm. The subset and proper subset symbol changes to C_ and C. were made to prevent defeating the parenthesis matching in Emacs. Other changes were made so that all letters a-z and A-Z are now available for variable names. One-letter constants such as _V, _e, and _i are now shown on the web pages with Roman instead of italic font, to disambiguate italic variable names. The new convention is that a prefix of _ indicates Roman font and a prefix of ~ indicates a script (curly) font. Thanks to Stefan Allan and Frédéric Liné for discussions leading to this change.
| Old | New | Description |
|---|---|---|
| C. | _C | binomial coefficient |
| E | _E | epsilon relation |
| e | _e | Euler's constant |
| I | _I | identity relation |
| i | _i | imaginary unit |
| V | _V | universal class |
| (_ | C_ | subset |
| (. | C. | proper subset |
| P~ | ~P | power class |
| H~ | ~H | Hilbert space |
(25-Sep-2010) The metamath program (version 0.07.54) now implements the current Metamath spec, so footnote 2 on p. 92 of the Metamath book can be ignored.
(24-Sep-2010) The metamath program (version 0.07.53) fixes bug 2106, reported by Michal Burger.
(14-Sep-2010) The metamath program (version 0.07.52) has a revamped LaTeX output with 'show statement xxx /tex', which produces the combined statement, description, and proof similar to the web page generation. Also, 'show proof xxx /lemmon/renumber' now matches the web page step numbers. ('show proof xxx/renumber' still has the indented form conforming to the actual RPN proof, with slightly different numbering.)
(9-Sep-2010) The metamath program (version 0.07.51) was updated with a modification by Stefan Allan that adds hyperlinks the the Ref column of proofs.
(12-Jun-2010) Scott Fenton contributed a D-proof (directly from axioms) of Meredith's single axiom (see the end of pmproofs.txt). A description of Meredith's axiom can be found in theorem meredith.
(11-Jun-2010) A new Metamath mirror was added in Austria, courtesy of Kinder-Enduro.
(28-Feb-2010) Raph Levien's Ghilbert project now has a new Ghilbert site and a Google Group.
(26-Jan-2010) Dmitri Vlasov writes, "I admire the simplicity and power of the metamath language, but still I see its great disadvantage - the proofs in metamath are completely non-manageable by humans without proof assistants. Therefore I decided to develop another language, which would be a higher-level superstructure language towards metamath, and which will support human-readable/writable proofs directly, without proof assistants. I call this language mdl (acronym for 'mathematics development language')." The latest version of Dmitri's translators from metamath to mdl and back can be downloaded from http://mathdevlanguage.sourceforge.net/. Currently only Linux is supported, but Dmitri says is should not be difficult to port it to other platforms that have a g++ compiler.
(11-Sep-2009) The metamath program (version 0.07.48) has been updated to enforce the whitespace requirement of the current spec.
(10-Sep-2009) Matthew Leitch has written an nice article, "How to write mathematics clearly", that briefly mentions Metamath. Overall it makes some excellent points. (I have written to him about a few things I disagree with.)
(28-May-2009) AsteroidMeta is back on-line. Note the URL change.
(12-May-2009) Charles Greathouse wrote a Greasemonkey script to reformat the axiom list on Metamath web site proof pages. This is a beta version; he will appreciate feedback.
(11-May-2009) Stefan Allan modified the metamath program to add the command "show statement xxx /mnemonics", which produces the output file Mnemosyne.txt for use with the Mnemosyne project. The current Metamath program download incorporates this command. Instructions: Create the file mnemosyne.txt with e.g. "show statement ax-* /mnemonics". In the Mnemosyne program, load the file by choosing File->Import then file format "Q and A on separate lines". Notes: (1) Don't try to load all of set.mm, it will crash the program due to a bug in Mnemosyne. (2) On my computer, the arrows in ax-1 don't display. Stefan reports that they do on his computer. (Both are Windows XP.)
(3-May-2009) Steven Baldasty wrote a Metamath syntax highlighting file for the gedit editor. Screenshot.
(1-May-2009) Users on a gaming forum discuss our 2+2=4 proof. Notable comments include "Ew math!" and "Whoever wrote this has absolutely no life."
(12-Mar-2009) Chris Capel has created a Javascript theorem viewer demo that (1) shows substitutions and (2) allows expanding and collapsing proof steps. You are invited to take a look and give him feedback at his Metablog.
(28-Feb-2009) Chris Capel has written a Metamath proof verifier in C#, available at http://pdf23ds.net/bzr/MathEditor/Verifier/Verifier.cs and weighing in at 550 lines. Also, that same URL without the file on it is a Bazaar repository.
(2-Dec-2008) A new section was added to the Deduction Theorem page, called Logic, Metalogic, Metametalogic, and Metametametalogic.
(24-Aug-2008) (From ocat): The 1-Aug-2008 version of mmj2 is ready (mmj2.zip), size = 1,534,041 bytes. This version contains the Theorem Loader enhancement which provides a "sandboxing" capability for user theorems and dynamic update of new theorems to the Metamath database already loaded in memory by mmj2. Also, the new "mmj2 Service" feature enables calling mmj2 as a subroutine, or having mmj2 call your program, and provides access to the mmj2 data structures and objects loaded in memory (i.e. get started writing those Jython programs!) See also mmj2 on AsteroidMeta.
(23-May-2008) Gérard Lang pointed me to Bob Solovay's note on AC and strongly inaccessible cardinals. One of the eventual goals for set.mm is to prove the Axiom of Choice from Grothendieck's axiom, like Mizar does, and this note may be helpful for anyone wanting to attempt that. Separately, I also came across a history of the size reduction of grothprim (viewable in Firefox and some versions of Internet Explorer).
(14-Apr-2008) A "/join" qualifier was added to the "search" command in the metamath program (version 0.07.37). This qualifier will join the $e hypotheses to the $a or $p for searching, so that math tokens in the $e's can be matched as well. For example, "search *com* +v" produces no results, but "search *com* +v /join" yields commutative laws involving vector addition. Thanks to Stefan Allan for suggesting this idea.
(8-Apr-2008) The 8,000th theorem, hlrel, was added to the Metamath Proof Explorer part of the database.
(2-Mar-2008) I added a small section to the end of the Deduction Theorem page.
(17-Feb-2008) ocat has uploaded the "1-Mar-2008" mmj2: mmj2.zip. See the description.
(16-Jan-2008) O'Cat has written mmj2 Proof Assistant Quick Tips.
(30-Dec-2007) "How to build a library of formalized mathematics".
(22-Dec-2007) The Metamath Proof Explorer was included in the top 30 science resources for 2007 by the University at Albany Science Library.
(17-Dec-2007) Metamath's Wikipedia entry says, "This article may require cleanup to meet Wikipedia's quality standards" (see its discussion page). Volunteers are welcome. :) (In the interest of objectivity, I don't edit this entry.)
(20-Nov-2007) Jeff Hoffman created nicod.mm and posted it to the Google Metamath Group.
(19-Nov-2007) Reinder Verlinde suggested adding tooltips to the hyperlinks on the proof pages, which I did for proof step hyperlinks. Discussion.
(5-Nov-2007) A Usenet challenge. :)
(4-Aug-2007) I added a "Request for comments on proposed 'maps to' notation" at the bottom of the AsteroidMeta set.mm discussion page.
(21-Jun-2007) A preprint (PDF file) describing Kurt Maes' axiom of choice with 5 quantifiers, proved in set.mm as ackm.
(20-Jun-2007) The 7,000th theorem, ifpr, was added to the Metamath Proof Explorer part of the database.
(29-Apr-2007) Blog mentions of Metamath: here and here.
(21-Mar-2007) Paul Chapman is working on a new proof browser, which has highlighting that allows you to see the referenced theorem before and after the substitution was made. Here is a screenshot of theorem 0nn0 and a screenshot of theorem 2p2e4.
(15-Mar-2007) A picture of Penny the cat guarding the us.metamath.org server and making the rounds.
(16-Feb-2007) For convenience, the program "drule.c" (pronounced "D-rule", not "drool") mentioned in pmproofs.txt can now be downloaded (drule.c) without having to ask me for it. The same disclaimer applies: even though this program works and has no known bugs, it was not intended for general release. Read the comments at the top of the program for instructions.
(28-Jan-2007) Jason Orendorff set up a new mailing list for Metamath: http://groups.google.com/group/metamath.
(20-Jan-2007) Bob Solovay provided a revised version of his Metamath database for Peano arithmetic, peano.mm.
(2-Jan-2007) Raph Levien has set up a wiki called Barghest for the Ghilbert language and software.
(26-Dec-2006) I posted an explanation of theorem ecoprass on Usenet.
(2-Dec-2006) Berislav Žarnić translated the Metamath Solitaire applet to Croatian.
(26-Nov-2006) Dan Getz has created an RSS feed for new theorems as they appear on this page.
(6-Nov-2006) The first 3 paragraphs in Appendix 2: Note on the Axioms were rewritten to clarify the connection between Tarski's axiom system and Metamath.
(31-Oct-2006) ocat asked for a do-over due to a bug in mmj2 -- if you downloaded the mmj2.zip version dated 10/28/2006, then download the new version dated 10/30.
(29-Oct-2006) ocat has announced that the
long-awaited 1-Nov-2006 release of mmj2 is available now.
The new "Unify+Get Hints" is quite
useful, and any proof can be generated as follows. With "?" in the Hyp
field and Ref field blank, select "Unify+Get Hints". Select a hint from
the list and put it in the Ref field. Edit any $n dummy variables to
become the desired wffs. Rinse and repeat for the new proof steps
generated, until the proof is done.
The new tutorial, mmj2PATutorial.bat,
explains this in detail. One way to reduce or avoid dummy $n's is to
fill in the Hyp field with a comma-separated list of any known
hypothesis matches to earlier proof steps, keeping a "?" in the list to
indicate that the remaining hypotheses are unknown. Then "Unify+Get
Hints" can be applied. The tutorial page
\mmj2\data\mmp\PATutorial\Page405.mmp has an example.
Don't forget that the eimm
export/import program lets you go back and forth between the mmj2 and
the metamath program proof assistants, without exiting from either one,
to exploit the best features of each as required.
(21-Oct-2006) Martin Kiselkov has written a Metamath proof verifier in the Lua scripting language, called verify.lua. While it is not practical as an everyday verifier - he writes that it takes about 40 minutes to verify set.mm on a a Pentium 4 - it could be useful to someone learning Lua or Metamath, and importantly it provides another independent way of verifying the correctness of Metamath proofs. His code looks like it is nicely structured and very readable. He is currently working on a faster version in C++.
(19-Oct-2006) New AsteroidMeta page by Raph, Distinctors_vs_binders.
(13-Oct-2006) I put a simple Metamath browser on my PDA (Palm Tungsten E) so that I don't have to lug around my laptop. Here is a screenshot. It isn't polished, but I'll provide the file + instructions if anyone wants it.
(3-Oct-2006) A blog entry, Principia for Reverse Mathematics.
(28-Sep-2006) A blog entry, Metamath responds.
(26-Sep-2006) A blog entry, Metamath isn't hygienic.
(11-Aug-2006) A blog entry, Metamath and the Peano Induction Axiom.
(26-Jul-2006) A new open problem in predicate calculus was added.
(18-Jun-2006) The 6,000th theorem, mt4d, was added to the Metamath Proof Explorer part of the database.
(9-May-2006) Luca Ciciriello has upgraded the t2mf program, which is a C
program used to create the MIDI files on the
Metamath Music Page, so
that it works on MacOS X. This is a nice accomplishment, since the
original program was written before C was standardized by ANSI and will
not compile on modern compilers.
Unfortunately, the original program source states no copyright terms.
The main author, Tim Thompson, has kindly agreed to release his code to
public domain, but two other authors have also contributed to the code,
and so far I have been unable to contact them for copyright clearance.
Therefore I cannot offer the MacOS X version for public download on this
site until this is resolved. Update 10-May-2006: Another author,
M. Czeiszperger, has released his contribution to public domain.
If you are interested in Luca's modified source code,
please contact me directly.
(18-Apr-2006) Incomplete proofs in progress can now be interchanged between the Metamath program's CLI Proof Assistant and mmj2's GUI Proof Assistant, using a new export-import program called eimm. This can be done without exiting either proof assistant, so that the strengths of each approach can be exploited during proof development. See "Use Case 5a" and "Use Case 5b" at mmj2ProofAssistantFeedback.
(28-Mar-2006) Scott Fenton updated his second version of Metamath Solitaire (the one that uses external axioms). He writes: "I've switched to making it a standalone program, as it seems silly to have an applet that can't be run in a web browser. Check the README file for further info." The download is mmsol-0.5.tar.gz.
(27-Mar-2006) Scott Fenton has updated the Metamath Solitaire Java
applet to Java 1.5: (1) QSort has been stripped out: its functionality
is in the Collections class that Sun ships; (2) all Vectors have been
replaced by ArrayLists; (3) generic types have been tossed in wherever
they fit: this cuts back drastically on casting; and (4) any warnings
Eclipse spouted out have been dealt with. I haven't yet updated it
officially, because I don't know if it will work with Microsoft's JVM in
older versions of Internet Explorer. The current official version is
compiled with Java 1.3, because it won't work with Microsoft's JVM if it
is compiled with Java 1.4. (As distasteful as that seems,
I will get complaints from users if it
doesn't work with Microsoft's JVM.) If anyone can verify that Scott's new
version runs on Microsoft's JVM, I would be grateful. Scott's new
version is mm.java-1.5.gz; after
uncompressing it, rename it to mm.java,
use it to replace the existing mm.java file in the
Metamath Solitaire download, and recompile according to instructions
in the mm.java comments.
Scott has also created a second version, mmsol-0.2.tar.gz, that reads
the axioms from ASCII files, instead of having the axioms hard-coded in
the program. This can be very useful if you want to play with custom
axioms, and you can also add a collection of starting theorems as
"axioms" to work from. However, it must be run from the local directory
with appletviewer, since the default Java security model doesn't allow
reading files from a browser. It works with the JDK 5 Update 6
Java download.
To compile (from Windows Command Prompt): C:\Program
Files\Java\jdk1.5.0_06\bin\javac.exe mm.java
To run (from Windows Command Prompt): C:\Program
Files\Java\jdk1.5.0_06\bin\appletviewer.exe mms.html
(21-Jan-2006) Juha Arpiainen proved the independence of axiom ax-11 from the others. This was published as an open problem in my 1995 paper (Remark 9.5 on PDF page 17). See Item 9a on the Workshop Miscellany for his seven-line proof. See also the Asteroid Meta metamathMathQuestions page under the heading "Axiom of variable substitution: ax-11". Congratulations, Juha!
(20-Oct-2005) Juha Arpiainen is working on a proof verifier in Common Lisp called Bourbaki. Its proof language has its roots in Metamath, with the goal of providing a more powerful syntax and definitional soundness checking. See its documentation and related discussion.
(17-Oct-2005) Marnix Klooster has written a Metamath proof verifier in Haskell, called Hmm. Also see his Announcement. The complete program (Hmm.hs, HmmImpl.hs, and HmmVerify.hs) has only 444 lines of code, excluding comments and blank lines. It verifies compressed as well as regular proofs; moreover, it transparently verifies both per-spec compressed proofs and the flawed format he uncovered (see comment below of 16-Oct-05).
(16-Oct-2005) Marnix Klooster noticed that for large proofs, the compressed proof format did not match the spec in the book. His algorithm to correct the problem has been put into the Metamath program (version 0.07.6). The program still verifies older proofs with the incorrect format, but the user will be nagged to update them with 'save proof *'. In set.mm, 285 out of 6376 proofs are affected. (The incorrect format did not affect proof correctness or verification, since the compression and decompression algorithms matched each other.)
(13-Sep-2005) Scott Fenton found an interesting axiom, ax46, which could be used to replace both ax-4 and ax-6.
(29-Jul-2005) Metamath was selected as site of the week by American Scientist Online.
(8-Jul-2005) Roy Longton has contributed 53 new theorems to the Quantum Logic Explorer. You can see them in the Theorem List starting at lem3.3.3lem1. He writes, "If you want, you can post an open challenge to see if anyone can find shorter proofs of the theorems I submitted."
(10-May-2005) A Usenet post I posted about the infinite prime proof; another one about indexed unions.
(3-May-2005) The theorem divexpt is the 5,000th theorem added to the Metamath Proof Explorer database.
(12-Apr-2005) Raph Levien solved the open problem in item 16 on the Workshop Miscellany page and as a corollary proved that axiom ax-9 is independent from the other axioms of predicate calculus and equality. This is the first such independence proof so far; a goal is to prove all of them independent (or to derive any redundant ones from the others).
(8-Mar-2005) I added a paragraph above our complex number axioms table, summarizing the construction and indicating where Dedekind cuts are defined. Thanks to Andrew Buhr for comments on this.
(16-Feb-2005) The Metamath Music Page is mentioned as a reference or resource for a university course called Math, Mind, and Music. .
(28-Jan-2005) Steven Cullinane parodied the Metamath Music Page in his blog.
(18-Jan-2005) Waldek Hebisch upgraded the Metamath program to run on the AMD64 64-bit processor.
(17-Jan-2005) A symbol list summary was added to the beginning of the Hilbert Space Explorer Home Page. Thanks to Mladen Pavicic for suggesting this.
(6-Jan-2005) Someone assembled an amazon.com list of some of the books in the Metamath Proof Explorer Bibliography.
(4-Jan-2005) The definition of ordinal exponentiation was decided on after this Usenet discussion.
(19-Dec-2004) A bit of trivia: my Erdös number is 2, as you can see from this list.
(20-Oct-2004) I started this Usenet discussion about the "reals are uncountable" proof (127 comments; last one on Nov. 12).
(12-Oct-2004) gch-kn shows the equivalence of the Generalized Continuum Hypothesis and Prof. Nambiar's Axiom of Combinatorial Sets. This proof answers his Open Problem 2 (PDF file).
(5-Aug-2004) I gave a talk on "Hilbert Lattice Equations" at the Argonne workshop.
(25-Jul-2004) The theorem nthruz is the 4,000th theorem added to the Metamath Proof Explorer database.
(27-May-2004) Josiah Burroughs contributed the proofs u1lemn1b, u1lem3var1, oi3oa3lem1, and oi3oa3 to the Quantum Logic Explorer database ql.mm.
(23-May-2004) Some minor typos found by Josh Purinton were corrected in the Metamath book. In addition, Josh simplified the definition of the closure of a pre-statement of a formal system in Appendix C.
(5-May-2004) Gregory Bush has found shorter proofs for 67 of the 193 propositional calculus theorems listed in Principia Mathematica, thus establishing 67 new records. (This was challenge #4 on the open problems page.)
| Copyright terms: Public domain | W3C HTML validation [external] |